Update Back-Cover Text as per maintain.info.
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @documentencoding ISO-8859-1
10
11 @copying
12 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
13 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14
15 @quotation
16 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
17 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
18 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
19 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
20 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
21 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
22 License'' in the Emacs manual.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
26 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
27
28 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
29 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
30 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
31 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
32 @end quotation
33 @end copying
34
35 @iftex
36 @iflatex
37 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
38 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
39 \usepackage{pagestyle}
40 \usepackage{epsfig}
41 \usepackage{pixidx}
42 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
43
44 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
45 \else
46 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
47 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
48 \pdfcompresslevel=9
49 \fi
50
51 \makeindex
52 \begin{document}
53
54 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
55 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
56 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
57 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
60
61 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
64 \else
65 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
66 \fi
67 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
69
70 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
72
73 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
80 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
83 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
84 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
95 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
96 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
97
98 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
100 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
101 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
102 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
103 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
106 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
109 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
110 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
111
112 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
113 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
114 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
115 }
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
118
119 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
120 {\mbox{}}
121 }
122
123 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
124 \gnusdimen 0pt
125
126 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
127 \gnuscleardoublepage
128 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
129 \chapter{#2}
130 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
131 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
132 \thispagestyle{empty}
133 \hspace*{-2cm}
134 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
135 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
136 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
137 \end{picture}
138 \clearpage
139 }
140
141 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
142 \begin{figure}
143 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
144 #3
145 \end{picture}
146 \caption{#1}
147 \end{figure}
148 }
149
150 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
151 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
152 }
153
154 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
155 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
156 }
157
158 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
159 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
160 }
161
162 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
163 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
164 }
165
166 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
167
168 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
169 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
170 \section{#1}
171 }
172
173 \newenvironment{codelist}%
174 {\begin{list}{}{
175 }
176 }{\end{list}}
177
178 \newenvironment{asislist}%
179 {\begin{list}{}{
180 }
181 }{\end{list}}
182
183 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
184 {\begin{list}{}{
185 \labelwidth=0cm
186 }
187 }{\end{list}}
188
189 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
190 {\begin{list}{}{
191 }
192 }{\end{list}}
193
194 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
195 {\begin{list}{}{
196 }
197 }{\end{list}}
198
199 \newenvironment{samplist}%
200 {\begin{list}{}{
201 }
202 }{\end{list}}
203
204 \newenvironment{varlist}%
205 {\begin{list}{}{
206 }
207 }{\end{list}}
208
209 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
210 {\begin{list}{}{
211 }
212 }{\end{list}}
213
214 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
215 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
216 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
217
218 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
219 {
220 {
221 \ifodd\count0
222 {
223 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
224 }
225 \else
226 {
227 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
228 }
229 }
230 \fi
231 }
232 }
233 {
234 \ifodd\count0
235 \mbox{} \hfill
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \else
238 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
239 \hfill \mbox{}
240 \fi
241 }
242
243 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
244 {
245 {
246 \ifodd\count0
247 {
248 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
249 }
250 \else
251 {
252 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
253 }
254 \fi
255 }
256 }
257 {
258 \ifodd\count0
259 \mbox{} \hfill
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \else
262 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
263 \hfill \mbox{}
264 \fi
265 }
266
267 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
268 {
269 {
270 \ifodd\count0
271 {
272 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
273 }
274 \else
275 {
276 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
277 }
278 \fi
279 }
280 }
281 {
282 \ifodd\count0
283 \mbox{} \hfill
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \else
286 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
287 \hfill \mbox{}
288 \fi
289 }
290
291 \pagenumbering{roman}
292 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
293
294 @end iflatex
295 @end iftex
296
297 @iftex
298 @iflatex
299
300 \begin{titlepage}
301 {
302
303 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
304 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
305 \parindent=0cm
306 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
307
308 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
309 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
310 \vfill
311 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
312 \vfill
313 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
314 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
315 \newpage
316 }
317
318 \mbox{}
319 \vfill
320
321 \thispagestyle{empty}
322
323 @c @insertcopying
324 \newpage
325 \end{titlepage}
326 @end iflatex
327 @end iftex
328
329 @ifnottex
330 @insertcopying
331 @end ifnottex
332
333 @dircategory Emacs
334 @direntry
335 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
336 @end direntry
337 @iftex
338 @finalout
339 @end iftex
340 @setchapternewpage odd
341
342
343
344 @titlepage
345 @title Gnus Manual
346
347 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
348 @page
349 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
350 @insertcopying
351 @end titlepage
352
353
354 @node Top
355 @top The Gnus Newsreader
356
357 @ifinfo
358
359 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
360 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
361 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
362 luck.
363
364 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
365 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
366
367 @end ifinfo
368
369 @iftex
370
371 @iflatex
372 \tableofcontents
373 \gnuscleardoublepage
374 @end iflatex
375
376 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380 being accused of plagiarism:
381
382 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385 can even read news with it!
386
387 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392 the program.
393
394 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
395 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
396
397 @heading Other related manuals
398 @itemize
399 @item Message manual: Composing messages
400 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
401 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
402 @item PGG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
403 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
404 @end itemize
405
406 @end iftex
407
408 @menu
409 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
410 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
411 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
412 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
413 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
414 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
415 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
416 * Various:: General purpose settings.
417 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421 * Key Index:: Key Index.
422
423 Other related manuals
424
425 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
426 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
427 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
428 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
429 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
430
431 @detailmenu
432 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
433
434 Starting Gnus
435
436 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
437 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
438 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
439 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
440 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
441 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
442 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
443 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
444 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
445 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
446 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
447
448 New Groups
449
450 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
451 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
452 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
453
454 Group Buffer
455
456 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
457 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
458 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
459 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
460 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
461 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
462 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
463 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
464 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
465 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
466 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
467 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
468 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
469 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
470 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
471 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
472 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
473 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
474
475 Group Buffer Format
476
477 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
478 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
479 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
480
481 Group Topics
482
483 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
484 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
485 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
486 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
487 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
488
489 Misc Group Stuff
490
491 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
492 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
493 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
494 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
495 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
496
497 Summary Buffer
498
499 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
500 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
501 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
502 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
503 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
504 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
505 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
506 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
507 * Threading:: How threads are made.
508 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
509 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
510 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
511 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
512 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
513 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
514 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
515 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
516 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
517 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
518 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
519 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
520 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
521 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
522 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
523 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
524 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
525 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
526 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
527 or reselecting the current group.
528 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
529 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
530 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
531 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
532
533 Summary Buffer Format
534
535 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
536 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
537 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
538 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
539
540 Choosing Articles
541
542 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
543 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
544
545 Reply, Followup and Post
546
547 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
548 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
549 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
550 * Canceling and Superseding::
551
552 Marking Articles
553
554 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
555 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
556 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
557 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
558 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
559 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
560
561 Threading
562
563 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
564 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
565
566 Customizing Threading
567
568 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
569 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
570 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
571 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
572
573 Decoding Articles
574
575 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
576 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
577 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
578 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
579 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
580 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
581
582 Decoding Variables
583
584 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
585 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
586 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
587
588 Article Treatment
589
590 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
591 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
592 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
593 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
594 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
595 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
596 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
597 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
598 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
599 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
600 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
601
602 Alternative Approaches
603
604 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
605 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
606
607 Various Summary Stuff
608
609 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
610 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
611 * Summary Generation Commands::
612 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
613
614 Article Buffer
615
616 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
617 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
618 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
619 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
620 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
621
622 Composing Messages
623
624 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
625 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
626 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
627 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
628 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
629 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
630 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
631 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
632 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
633
634 Select Methods
635
636 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
637 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
638 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
639 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
640 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
641 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
642 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
643 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
644 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
645
646 Server Buffer
647
648 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
649 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
650 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
651 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
652 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
653 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
654 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
655
656 Getting News
657
658 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
659 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
660
661 @acronym{NNTP}
662
663 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
664 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
665 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
666 * NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
667
668 Getting Mail
669
670 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
671 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
672 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
673 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
674 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
675 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
676 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
677 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
678 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
679 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
680 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
681 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
682 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
683
684 Mail Sources
685
686 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
687 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
688 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
689
690 Choosing a Mail Back End
691
692 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
693 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
694 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
695 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
696 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
697 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
698 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
699
700 Browsing the Web
701
702 * Archiving Mail::
703 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
704 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
705 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
706 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
707 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
708 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
709
710 @acronym{IMAP}
711
712 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
713 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
714 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
715 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
716 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
717 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
718
719 Other Sources
720
721 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
722 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
723 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
724 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
725 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
726
727 Document Groups
728
729 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
730
731 SOUP
732
733 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
734 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
735 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
736
737 Combined Groups
738
739 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
740 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
741
742 Email Based Diary
743
744 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
745 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
746 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
747
748 The NNDiary Back End
749
750 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
751 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
752 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
753
754 The Gnus Diary Library
755
756 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
757 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
758 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
759 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
760
761 Gnus Unplugged
762
763 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
764 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
765 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
766 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
767 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
768 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
769 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
770 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
771 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
772 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
773 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
774 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
775 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
776 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
777
778 Agent Categories
779
780 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
781 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
782 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
783
784 Agent Commands
785
786 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
787 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
788 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
789
790 Scoring
791
792 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
793 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
794 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
795 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
796 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
797 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
798 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
799 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
800 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
801 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
802 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
803 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
804 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
805 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
806 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
807 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
808
809 Advanced Scoring
810
811 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
812 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
813 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
814
815 Various
816
817 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
818 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
819 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
820 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
821 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
822 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
823 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
824 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
825 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
826 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
827 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
828 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
829 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
830 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
831 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
832 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
833 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
834 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
835 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
836 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
837 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
838
839 Formatting Variables
840
841 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
842 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
843 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
844 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
845 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
846 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
847 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
848 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
849
850 Image Enhancements
851
852 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
853 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
854 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
855 meant to be shown.
856 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
857 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
858
859 Thwarting Email Spam
860
861 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
862 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
863 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
864 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
865
866 Spam Package
867
868 * Spam Package Introduction::
869 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
870 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
871 * Spam and Ham Processors::
872 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
873 * Spam Back Ends::
874 * Extending the Spam package::
875 * Spam Statistics Package::
876
877 Spam Statistics Package
878
879 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
880 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
881 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
882
883 Appendices
884
885 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
886 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
887 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
888 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
889 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
890 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
891 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
892 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
893 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
894
895 History
896
897 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
898 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
899 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
900 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
901 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
902 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
903 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
904 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
905 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
906
907 New Features
908
909 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
910 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
911 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
912 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
913 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
914 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
915 * No Gnus:: Very punny.
916
917 Customization
918
919 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
920 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
921 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
922 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
923
924 Gnus Reference Guide
925
926 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
927 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
928 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
929 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
930 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
931 * Group Info:: The group info format.
932 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
933 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
934 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
935
936 Back End Interface
937
938 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
939 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
940 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
941 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
942 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
943 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
944
945 Various File Formats
946
947 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
948 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
949
950 Emacs for Heathens
951
952 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
953 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
954
955 @end detailmenu
956 @end menu
957
958 @node Starting Up
959 @chapter Starting Gnus
960 @cindex starting up
961
962 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
963 Heathens} first.
964
965 @kindex M-x gnus
966 @findex gnus
967 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
968 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
969 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
970 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
971 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
972 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
973
974 @findex gnus-other-frame
975 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
976 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
977 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
978
979 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
980 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
981 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
982
983 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
984 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
985
986 @menu
987 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
988 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
989 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
990 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
991 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
992 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
993 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
994 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
995 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
996 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
997 @end menu
998
999
1000 @node Finding the News
1001 @section Finding the News
1002 @cindex finding news
1003
1004 @vindex gnus-select-method
1005 @c @head
1006 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1007 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1008 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1009 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1010 foreign groups.
1011
1012 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1013 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1014
1015 @lisp
1016 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1017 @end lisp
1018
1019 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1020
1021 @lisp
1022 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1023 @end lisp
1024
1025 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1026 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1027 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1028 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1029
1030 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1031 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1032 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1033 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1034 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1035 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1036 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1037 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1038 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1039
1040 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1041 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1042 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1043 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1044
1045 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1046 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1047 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1048 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1049 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1050 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1051 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1052 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1053 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1054 server.)
1055
1056 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1057 @kindex B (Group)
1058 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1059 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1060 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1061 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1062 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1063 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1064
1065 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1066 @c @head
1067 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1068 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1069 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1070 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1071 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1072 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1073 groups are.
1074
1075 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1076 you would typically set this variable to
1077
1078 @lisp
1079 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1080 @end lisp
1081
1082 Note: the @acronym{NNTP} back end stores marks in marks files
1083 (@pxref{NNTP marks}). This feature makes it easy to share marks between
1084 several Gnus installations, but may slow down things a bit when fetching
1085 new articles. @xref{NNTP marks}, for more information.
1086
1087
1088 @node The First Time
1089 @section The First Time
1090 @cindex first time usage
1091
1092 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1093 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1094
1095 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1096 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1097 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1098 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1099 something useful.
1100
1101 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1102 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1103 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1104
1105 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1106 help you with most common problems.
1107
1108 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1109 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1110 special.
1111
1112
1113 @node The Server is Down
1114 @section The Server is Down
1115 @cindex server errors
1116
1117 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1118 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1119 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1120
1121 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1122 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1123 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1124 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1125 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1126 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1127 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1128
1129 @findex gnus-no-server
1130 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1131 @c @head
1132 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1133 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1134 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1135 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1136 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1137 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1138 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1139
1140
1141 @node Slave Gnusae
1142 @section Slave Gnusae
1143 @cindex slave
1144
1145 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1146 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1147 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1148 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1149
1150 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1151 @file{.newsrc} file.
1152
1153 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1154 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1155 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1156 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1157 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1158 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1159 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1160
1161 @findex gnus-slave
1162 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1163 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1164 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1165 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1166 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1167 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1168 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1169 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1170
1171 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1172 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1173
1174 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1175 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1176 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1177 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1178 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1179
1180
1181
1182 @node New Groups
1183 @section New Groups
1184 @cindex new groups
1185 @cindex subscription
1186
1187 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1188 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1189 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1190 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1191 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1192 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1193 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1194 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1195 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1196
1197 @menu
1198 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1199 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1200 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1201 @end menu
1202
1203
1204 @node Checking New Groups
1205 @subsection Checking New Groups
1206
1207 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1208 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1209 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1210 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1211 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1212 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1213 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1214 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1215 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1216 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1217
1218 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1219 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1220 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1221 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1222 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1223 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1224 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1225 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1226 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1227 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1228 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1229
1230 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1231 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1232 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1233 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1234 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1235 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1236
1237
1238 @node Subscription Methods
1239 @subsection Subscription Methods
1240
1241 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1242 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1243 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1244
1245 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1246 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1247
1248 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1249
1250 @table @code
1251
1252 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1253 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1254 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1255 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1256 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1257
1258 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1259 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1260 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1261 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1262
1263 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1264 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1265 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1266
1267 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1268 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1269 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1270 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1271 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1272 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1273 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1274 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1275 up. Or something like that.
1276
1277 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1278 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1279 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1280 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1281 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1282
1283 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1284 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1285 Kill all new groups.
1286
1287 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1289 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1290 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1291 topic parameter that looks like
1292
1293 @example
1294 "nnslashdot"
1295 @end example
1296
1297 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1298 that topic.
1299
1300 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1301 top-level topic.
1302
1303 @end table
1304
1305 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1306 A closely related variable is
1307 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1308 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1309 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1310 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1311 hierarchy or not.
1312
1313 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1314 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1315 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1316 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1317
1318
1319 @node Filtering New Groups
1320 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1321
1322 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1323 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1324 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1325
1326 @example
1327 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1328 @end example
1329
1330 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1331 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1332 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1333 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1334 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1335 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1336 subscribing these groups.
1337 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1338 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1339
1340 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1341 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1342 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1343 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1344 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1345 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1346 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1347 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1348
1349 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1350 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1351 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1352 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1353 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1354 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1355 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1356 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1357 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1358 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1359 @code{nil}.
1360
1361 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1362 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1363
1364
1365 @node Changing Servers
1366 @section Changing Servers
1367 @cindex changing servers
1368
1369 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1370 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1371 very flaky and you want to use another.
1372
1373 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1374 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1375
1376 @emph{Wrong!}
1377
1378 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1379 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1380 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1381 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1382 worthless.
1383
1384 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1385 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1386 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1387 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1388
1389 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1390 @findex gnus-change-server
1391 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1392 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1393 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1394 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1395 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1396
1397 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1398 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1399 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1400 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1401 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1402
1403 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1404 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1405 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1406 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1407 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1408 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1409
1410 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1411 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1412 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1413 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1414
1415 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1416 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1417 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1418 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1419 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1420 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1421 cache for all groups).
1422
1423
1424 @node Startup Files
1425 @section Startup Files
1426 @cindex startup files
1427 @cindex .newsrc
1428 @cindex .newsrc.el
1429 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1430
1431 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1432 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1433 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1434 read.
1435
1436 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1437 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1438 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1439 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1440 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1441 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1442 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1443
1444 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1445 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1446 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1447 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1448 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1449 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1450
1451 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1452 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1453 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1454 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1455 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1456 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1457 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1458 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1459 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1460 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1461 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1462 news reader.
1463
1464 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1465 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1466 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1467 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1468 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1469 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1470 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1471 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1472 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1473 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1474 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1475 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1476
1477 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1478 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1479 @vindex version-control
1480 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1481 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1482 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1483 If you want version control for this file, set
1484 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1485 @code{version-control} variable.
1486
1487 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1488 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1489 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1490 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1491 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1492 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1493 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1494 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1495 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1496 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1497
1498 @lisp
1499 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1500 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1501
1502 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1503 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1504 @end lisp
1505
1506 @vindex gnus-init-file
1507 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1508 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1509 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1510 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1511 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1512 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1513 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1514 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1515 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1516 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1517 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1518 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1519 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1520
1521
1522 @node Auto Save
1523 @section Auto Save
1524 @cindex dribble file
1525 @cindex auto-save
1526
1527 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1528 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1529 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1530 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1531 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1532 this file.
1533
1534 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1535 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1536 saved.
1537
1538 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1539 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1540 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1541
1542 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1543 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1544 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1545 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1546 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1547 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1548
1549 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1550 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1551 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1552
1553
1554 @node The Active File
1555 @section The Active File
1556 @cindex active file
1557 @cindex ignored groups
1558
1559 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1560 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1561 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1562
1563 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1564 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1565 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1566 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1567 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1568 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1569 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1570
1571 @c This variable is
1572 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1573 @c if you set it to anything else.
1574
1575 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1576 @c @head
1577 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1578 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1579 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1580
1581 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1582 you actually subscribe to.
1583
1584 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1585 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1586 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1587 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1588
1589 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1590 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1591 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1592 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1593 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1594 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1595
1596 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1597 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1598 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1599 variable.
1600
1601 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1602 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1603 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1604 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1605 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1606 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1607
1608 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1609 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1610
1611 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1612 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1613
1614 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1615 secondary select methods.
1616
1617
1618 @node Startup Variables
1619 @section Startup Variables
1620
1621 @table @code
1622
1623 @item gnus-load-hook
1624 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1625 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1626 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1627 times you start Gnus.
1628
1629 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1630 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1631 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1632
1633 @item gnus-startup-hook
1634 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1635 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1636
1637 @item gnus-started-hook
1638 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1639 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1640 successfully.
1641
1642 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1643 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1644 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1645 generating the group buffer.
1646
1647 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1648 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1649 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1650 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1651 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1652 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1653 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1654 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1655
1656 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1657 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1658 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1659 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1660 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1661 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1662
1663 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1664 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1665 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1666
1667 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1668 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1669 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1670
1671 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1672 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1673 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1674 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1675
1676 @end table
1677
1678
1679 @node Group Buffer
1680 @chapter Group Buffer
1681 @cindex group buffer
1682
1683 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1684 @c
1685 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1686 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1687 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1688 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1689 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1690 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1691 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1692 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1693 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1694 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1695 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1696 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1697 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1698 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1699 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1700 @c human rights at 9...
1701
1702
1703 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1704 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1705 long as Gnus is active.
1706
1707 @iftex
1708 @iflatex
1709 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1710 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1711 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1712 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1713 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1714 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1715 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1716 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1717 }
1718 @end iflatex
1719 @end iftex
1720
1721 @menu
1722 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1723 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1724 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1725 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1726 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1727 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1728 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1729 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1730 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1731 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1732 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1733 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1734 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1735 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1736 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1737 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1738 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1739 * Searching:: Mail search engines.
1740 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1741 @end menu
1742
1743
1744 @node Group Buffer Format
1745 @section Group Buffer Format
1746
1747 @menu
1748 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1749 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1750 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1751 @end menu
1752
1753 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1754 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1755 available in Emacs.
1756
1757 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1758 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1759 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1760 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1761 Emacs version.
1762
1763 @node Group Line Specification
1764 @subsection Group Line Specification
1765 @cindex group buffer format
1766
1767 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1768 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1769
1770 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1771
1772 @example
1773 25: news.announce.newusers
1774 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1775 @end example
1776
1777 Quite simple, huh?
1778
1779 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1780 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1781 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1782 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1783
1784 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1785 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1786 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1787 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1788 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1789 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1790
1791 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1792
1793 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1794 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1795 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1796 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1797 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1798
1799 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1800 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1801 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1802
1803 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1804
1805 @table @samp
1806
1807 @item M
1808 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1809
1810 @item S
1811 Whether the group is subscribed.
1812
1813 @item L
1814 Level of subscribedness.
1815
1816 @item N
1817 Number of unread articles.
1818
1819 @item I
1820 Number of dormant articles.
1821
1822 @item T
1823 Number of ticked articles.
1824
1825 @item R
1826 Number of read articles.
1827
1828 @item U
1829 Number of unseen articles.
1830
1831 @item t
1832 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1833 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1834
1835 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1836 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1837 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1838 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1839 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1840 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1841 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1842
1843 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1844 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1845 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1846 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1847 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1848 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1849 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1850
1851 @item y
1852 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1853
1854 @item i
1855 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1856
1857 @item g
1858 Full group name.
1859
1860 @item G
1861 Group name.
1862
1863 @item C
1864 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1865 comment element in the group parameters.
1866
1867 @item D
1868 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1869 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1870 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1871 command.
1872
1873 @item o
1874 @samp{m} if moderated.
1875
1876 @item O
1877 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1878
1879 @item s
1880 Select method.
1881
1882 @item B
1883 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1884
1885 @item n
1886 Select from where.
1887
1888 @item z
1889 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1890 used.
1891
1892 @item P
1893 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1894
1895 @item c
1896 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1897 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1898 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1899 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1900 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1901
1902 @item m
1903 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1904 @cindex %
1905 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1906 the group lately.
1907
1908 @item p
1909 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1910
1911 @item d
1912 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1913 Timestamp}).
1914
1915 @item F
1916 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1917 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1918 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1919 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1920
1921 @item u
1922 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1923 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1924 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1925 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1926 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1927 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1928 specifier.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 @cindex *
1932 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1933 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1934 group, or a bogus native group.
1935
1936
1937 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1938 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1939 @cindex group mode line
1940
1941 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1942 The mode line can be changed by setting
1943 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1944 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1945
1946 @table @samp
1947 @item S
1948 The native news server.
1949 @item M
1950 The native select method.
1951 @end table
1952
1953
1954 @node Group Highlighting
1955 @subsection Group Highlighting
1956 @cindex highlighting
1957 @cindex group highlighting
1958
1959 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1960 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1961 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1962 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1963 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1964
1965 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1966 background is dark:
1967
1968 @lisp
1969 (cond (window-system
1970 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1971 (defface my-group-face-1
1972 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1973 (defface my-group-face-2
1974 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1975 "Second group face")
1976 (defface my-group-face-3
1977 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1978 (defface my-group-face-4
1979 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1980 (defface my-group-face-5
1981 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1982
1983 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1984 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1985 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1986 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1987 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1988 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1989 @end lisp
1990
1991 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1992
1993 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1994 include:
1995
1996 @table @code
1997 @item group
1998 The group name.
1999 @item unread
2000 The number of unread articles in the group.
2001 @item method
2002 The select method.
2003 @item mailp
2004 Whether the group is a mail group.
2005 @item level
2006 The level of the group.
2007 @item score
2008 The score of the group.
2009 @item ticked
2010 The number of ticked articles in the group.
2011 @item total
2012 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
2013 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
2014 @item topic
2015 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
2016 topic being inserted.
2017 @end table
2018
2019 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
2020 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
2021 functions for snarfing info on the group.
2022
2023 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
2024 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
2025 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
2026 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
2027 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
2028
2029
2030 @node Group Maneuvering
2031 @section Group Maneuvering
2032 @cindex group movement
2033
2034 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2035 expected, hopefully.
2036
2037 @table @kbd
2038
2039 @item n
2040 @kindex n (Group)
2041 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2042 Go to the next group that has unread articles
2043 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2044
2045 @item p
2046 @itemx DEL
2047 @kindex DEL (Group)
2048 @kindex p (Group)
2049 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2050 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2051 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2052
2053 @item N
2054 @kindex N (Group)
2055 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2056 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2057
2058 @item P
2059 @kindex P (Group)
2060 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2061 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2062
2063 @item M-n
2064 @kindex M-n (Group)
2065 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2066 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2067 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2068
2069 @item M-p
2070 @kindex M-p (Group)
2071 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2072 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2073 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2074 @end table
2075
2076 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2077
2078 @table @kbd
2079
2080 @item j
2081 @kindex j (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2083 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2084 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2085 like living groups.
2086
2087 @item ,
2088 @kindex , (Group)
2089 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2090 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2091 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2092
2093 @item .
2094 @kindex . (Group)
2095 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2096 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2097 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2098 @end table
2099
2100 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2101 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2102 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2103 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2104 is @code{t}.
2105
2106 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2107 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2108 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2109 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2110 @code{t}.
2111
2112 @node Selecting a Group
2113 @section Selecting a Group
2114 @cindex group selection
2115
2116 @table @kbd
2117
2118 @item SPACE
2119 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2120 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2121 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2122 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2123 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2124 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2125 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2126 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2127 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2128 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2129
2130 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2131 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2132 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2133
2134 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2135 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2136 ones.
2137
2138 @item RET
2139 @kindex RET (Group)
2140 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2141 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2142 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2143 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2144 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2145 entry.
2146
2147 @item M-RET
2148 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2149 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2150 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2151 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2152 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2153 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2154 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2155 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2156 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2157 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2158
2159 @item M-SPACE
2160 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2161 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2162 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2163 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2164 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2165
2166 @item C-M-RET
2167 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2168 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2169 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2170 doing any processing of its contents
2171 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2172 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2173 manner will have no permanent effects.
2174
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2178 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2179 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2180 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2181 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2182 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2183 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2184 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2185 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2186 most recently will be fetched.
2187
2188 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2189 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2190 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2191 newsgroups.
2192
2193 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2194 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2195 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2196 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2197 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2198 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2199 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2200 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2201 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2202 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2203 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2204 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2205 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2206 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2207 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2208 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2209 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2210
2211 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2212 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2213 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2214 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2215 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2216 Which article this is is controlled by the
2217 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2218 variable are:
2219
2220 @table @code
2221
2222 @item unread
2223 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2224
2225 @item first
2226 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2227
2228 @item unseen
2229 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2230
2231 @item unseen-or-unread
2232 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2233 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2234 unread article.
2235
2236 @item best
2237 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2238
2239 @end table
2240
2241 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2242 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2243
2244 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2245 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2246 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2247 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2248 selected.
2249
2250
2251 @node Subscription Commands
2252 @section Subscription Commands
2253 @cindex subscription
2254
2255 @table @kbd
2256
2257 @item S t
2258 @itemx u
2259 @kindex S t (Group)
2260 @kindex u (Group)
2261 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2262 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2263 Toggle subscription to the current group
2264 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2265
2266 @item S s
2267 @itemx U
2268 @kindex S s (Group)
2269 @kindex U (Group)
2270 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2271 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2272 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2273 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2274
2275 @item S k
2276 @itemx C-k
2277 @kindex S k (Group)
2278 @kindex C-k (Group)
2279 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2280 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2281 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2282
2283 @item S y
2284 @itemx C-y
2285 @kindex S y (Group)
2286 @kindex C-y (Group)
2287 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2288 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2289
2290 @item C-x C-t
2291 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2292 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2293 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2294 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2295 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2296
2297 @item S w
2298 @itemx C-w
2299 @kindex S w (Group)
2300 @kindex C-w (Group)
2301 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2302 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2303
2304 @item S z
2305 @kindex S z (Group)
2306 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2307 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2308
2309 @item S C-k
2310 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2311 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2312 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2313 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2314 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2315 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2316 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2317 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2318 @file{.newsrc} file.
2319
2320 @end table
2321
2322 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2323
2324
2325 @node Group Data
2326 @section Group Data
2327
2328 @table @kbd
2329
2330 @item c
2331 @kindex c (Group)
2332 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2333 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2334 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2335 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2336 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2337 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2338 the group buffer.
2339
2340 @item C
2341 @kindex C (Group)
2342 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2343 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2344 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2345
2346 @item M-c
2347 @kindex M-c (Group)
2348 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2349 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2350 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2351
2352 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2353 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2354 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2355 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2356 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2357 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2358 caution.
2359
2360 @end table
2361
2362
2363 @node Group Levels
2364 @section Group Levels
2365 @cindex group level
2366 @cindex level
2367
2368 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2369 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2370 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2371 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2372 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2373
2374 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2375
2376 @table @kbd
2377
2378 @item S l
2379 @kindex S l (Group)
2380 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2381 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2382 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2383 prompted for a level.
2384 @end table
2385
2386 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2387 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2388 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2389 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2390 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2391 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2392 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2393 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2394 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2395 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2396 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2397 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2398 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2399 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2400 reasons of efficiency.
2401
2402 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2403 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2404
2405 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2406 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2407 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2408 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2409 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2410 groups are hidden, in a way.
2411
2412 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2413 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2414 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2415 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2416 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2417 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2418
2419 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2420 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2421 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2422 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2423 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2424 list of killed groups.)
2425
2426 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2427 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2428 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2429
2430 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2431 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2432 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2433 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2434 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2435 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2436 relevant valid ranges.
2437
2438 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2439 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2440 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2441 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2442 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2443 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2444 rest.
2445
2446 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2447 one with the best level.
2448
2449 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2450 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2451 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2452 by default.
2453
2454 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2455 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2456 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2457 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2458 listed.
2459
2460 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2461 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2462 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2463 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2464
2465 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2466 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2467 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2468 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2469 to 5. The default is 6.
2470
2471
2472 @node Group Score
2473 @section Group Score
2474 @cindex group score
2475 @cindex group rank
2476 @cindex rank
2477
2478 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2479 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2480 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2481 reason?
2482
2483 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2484 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2485 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2486 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2487 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2488 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2489 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2490 least significant part.))
2491
2492 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2493 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2494 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2495 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2496 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2497 action after each summary exit, you can add
2498 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2499 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2500 slow things down somewhat.
2501
2502
2503 @node Marking Groups
2504 @section Marking Groups
2505 @cindex marking groups
2506
2507 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2508 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2509 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2510 bidding on those groups.
2511
2512 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2513 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2514 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2515
2516 @table @kbd
2517
2518 @item #
2519 @kindex # (Group)
2520 @itemx M m
2521 @kindex M m (Group)
2522 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2523 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2524
2525 @item M-#
2526 @kindex M-# (Group)
2527 @itemx M u
2528 @kindex M u (Group)
2529 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2530 Remove the mark from the current group
2531 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2532
2533 @item M U
2534 @kindex M U (Group)
2535 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2536 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2537
2538 @item M w
2539 @kindex M w (Group)
2540 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2541 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2542
2543 @item M b
2544 @kindex M b (Group)
2545 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2546 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2547
2548 @item M r
2549 @kindex M r (Group)
2550 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2551 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2552 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2553 @end table
2554
2555 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2556
2557 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2558 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2559 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2560 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2561 the command to be executed.
2562
2563
2564 @node Foreign Groups
2565 @section Foreign Groups
2566 @cindex foreign groups
2567
2568 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2569 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2570 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2571 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2572 consulted.
2573
2574 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2575 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2576 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2577
2578 @table @kbd
2579
2580 @item G m
2581 @kindex G m (Group)
2582 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2583 @cindex making groups
2584 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2585 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2586 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2587
2588 @item G M
2589 @kindex G M (Group)
2590 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2591 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2592 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2593
2594 @item G r
2595 @kindex G r (Group)
2596 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2597 @cindex renaming groups
2598 Rename the current group to something else
2599 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2600 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2601 on some back ends.
2602
2603 @item G c
2604 @kindex G c (Group)
2605 @cindex customizing
2606 @findex gnus-group-customize
2607 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2608
2609 @item G e
2610 @kindex G e (Group)
2611 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2612 @cindex renaming groups
2613 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2614 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2615
2616 @item G p
2617 @kindex G p (Group)
2618 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2619 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2620 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2621
2622 @item G E
2623 @kindex G E (Group)
2624 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2625 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2626 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2627
2628 @item G d
2629 @kindex G d (Group)
2630 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2631 @cindex nndir
2632 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2633 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2634
2635 @item G h
2636 @kindex G h (Group)
2637 @cindex help group
2638 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2639 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2640
2641 @item G a
2642 @kindex G a (Group)
2643 @cindex (ding) archive
2644 @cindex archive group
2645 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2646 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2647 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2648 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2649 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2650 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2651 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2652
2653 @item G k
2654 @kindex G k (Group)
2655 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2656 @cindex nnkiboze
2657 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2658 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2659 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2660 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2661
2662 @item G D
2663 @kindex G D (Group)
2664 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2665 @cindex nneething
2666 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2667 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2668 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2669
2670 @item G f
2671 @kindex G f (Group)
2672 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2673 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2674 @cindex nndoc
2675 Make a group based on some file or other
2676 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2677 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2678 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2679 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2680 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2681 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2682 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2683 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2684 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2685
2686 @item G u
2687 @kindex G u (Group)
2688 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2689 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2690 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2691 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2692
2693 @item G w
2694 @kindex G w (Group)
2695 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2696 @cindex Google
2697 @cindex nnweb
2698 @cindex gmane
2699 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2700 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2701 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2702 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2703 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2704 @xref{Web Searches}.
2705
2706 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2707 to a particular group by using a match string like
2708 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2709
2710 @item G R
2711 @kindex G R (Group)
2712 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2713 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2714 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2715 @xref{RSS}.
2716
2717 @item G DEL
2718 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2719 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2720 This function will delete the current group
2721 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2722 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2723 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2724 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2725 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2726
2727 @item G V
2728 @kindex G V (Group)
2729 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2730 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2731 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2732
2733 @item G v
2734 @kindex G v (Group)
2735 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2736 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2737 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2738 @end table
2739
2740 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2741 methods.
2742
2743 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2744 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2745 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2746 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2747 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2748 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2749 newsgroups.
2750
2751
2752 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2753 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2754
2755 @table @code
2756 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2757 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2758 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2759 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2760 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2761 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2762 the article range.
2763
2764 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2765 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2766 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2767 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2768 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include e.g.
2769 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2770 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2771 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2772 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2773 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2774
2775 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2776 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2777 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2778 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2779 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2780
2781 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2782 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2783 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2784 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2785 @end table
2786
2787 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2788 Buttons}.
2789
2790 Here is an example:
2791 @lisp
2792 (require 'gnus-art)
2793 (add-to-list
2794 'gnus-button-alist
2795 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2796 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2797 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2798 @end lisp
2799
2800
2801 @node Group Parameters
2802 @section Group Parameters
2803 @cindex group parameters
2804
2805 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2806
2807 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2808 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2809 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2810 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2811 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2812 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2813 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2814
2815 Here's an example group parameter list:
2816
2817 @example
2818 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2819 (auto-expire . t))
2820 @end example
2821
2822 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2823 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2824 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2825 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2826
2827 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2828 is an alist of regexps and values.
2829
2830 The following group parameters can be used:
2831
2832 @table @code
2833 @item to-address
2834 @cindex to-address
2835 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2836
2837 @example
2838 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2839 @end example
2840
2841 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2842 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2843 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2844 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2845 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2846
2847 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2848 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2849 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2850 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2851 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2852 list address instead.
2853
2854 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2855
2856 @item to-list
2857 @cindex to-list
2858 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2859
2860 @example
2861 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2862 @end example
2863
2864 It is totally ignored
2865 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2866 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2867
2868 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2869 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2870 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2871 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2872 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2873
2874 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2875 @cindex mail list groups
2876 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2877 entering summary buffer.
2878
2879 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2880
2881 @anchor{subscribed}
2882 @item subscribed
2883 @cindex subscribed
2884 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2885 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2886 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2887 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2888 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2889 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2890 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2891 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2892
2893 @lisp
2894 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2895 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2896 @end lisp
2897
2898 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2899 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2900
2901 @item visible
2902 @cindex visible
2903 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2904 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2905 of whether it has any unread articles.
2906
2907 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2908 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2909
2910 @item broken-reply-to
2911 @cindex broken-reply-to
2912 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2913 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2914 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2915 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2916 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2917 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2918
2919 @item to-group
2920 @cindex to-group
2921 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2922 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2923
2924 @item newsgroup
2925 @cindex newsgroup
2926 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2927 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2928 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2929 news group.
2930
2931 @item gcc-self
2932 @cindex gcc-self
2933 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2934 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2935 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2936 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2937 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2938 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2939 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2940
2941 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2942 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2943 doesn't accept articles.
2944
2945 @item auto-expire
2946 @cindex auto-expire
2947 @cindex expiring mail
2948 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2949 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2950 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2951
2952 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2953
2954 @item total-expire
2955 @cindex total-expire
2956 @cindex expiring mail
2957 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2958 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2959 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2960 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2961 expiry.
2962
2963 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2964
2965 @item expiry-wait
2966 @cindex expiry-wait
2967 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2968 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2969 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2970 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2971 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2972 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2973 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2974
2975 @item expiry-target
2976 @cindex expiry-target
2977 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2978 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2979
2980 @item score-file
2981 @cindex score file group parameter
2982 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2983 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2984 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2985
2986 @item adapt-file
2987 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2988 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2989 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2990 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2991
2992 @item admin-address
2993 @cindex admin-address
2994 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2995 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2996 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2997 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2998
2999 @item display
3000 @cindex display
3001 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
3002 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
3003
3004 @table @code
3005 @item all
3006 Display all articles, both read and unread.
3007
3008 @item an integer
3009 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
3010 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
3011
3012 @item default
3013 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
3014 ticked articles.
3015
3016 @item an array
3017 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
3018
3019 Here are some examples:
3020
3021 @table @code
3022 @item [unread]
3023 Display only unread articles.
3024
3025 @item [not expire]
3026 Display everything except expirable articles.
3027
3028 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
3029 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
3030 responded to.
3031 @end table
3032
3033 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
3034 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
3035 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
3036 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
3037 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
3038
3039 @end table
3040
3041 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
3042 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
3043 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
3044
3045 @item comment
3046 @cindex comment
3047 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
3048 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3049 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3050
3051 @item charset
3052 @cindex charset
3053 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3054 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3055 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3056
3057 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3058
3059 @item ignored-charsets
3060 @cindex ignored-charset
3061 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3062 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3063 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3064
3065 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3066
3067 @item posting-style
3068 @cindex posting-style
3069 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3070 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3071 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3072 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3073 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3074
3075 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3076 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3077 like this in the group parameters:
3078
3079 @example
3080 (posting-style
3081 (name "Funky Name")
3082 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3083 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3084 @end example
3085
3086 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3087 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3088 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3089 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3090 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3091 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3092 to.
3093
3094
3095 @item post-method
3096 @cindex post-method
3097 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3098 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3099
3100 @item mail-source
3101 @cindex mail-source
3102 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3103 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3104 mail source for this group.
3105
3106 @item banner
3107 @cindex banner
3108 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3109 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3110 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3111 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3112 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3113
3114 @item sieve
3115 @cindex sieve
3116 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3117 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3118 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3119 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3120
3121 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3122 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3123 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3124 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3125
3126 @example
3127 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3128 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3129 @}
3130 @end example
3131
3132 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3133 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3134 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3135 like the following is generated:
3136
3137 @example
3138 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3139 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3140 @}
3141 @end example
3142
3143 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3144 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3145
3146 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3147 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3148
3149 @item (agent parameters)
3150 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3151 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3152 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3153 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3154 minimize the configuration effort.
3155
3156 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3157 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3158 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3159 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3160 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3161 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3162 @code{eval}ed there.
3163
3164 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3165 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3166 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3167 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3168 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3169 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3170 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3171 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3172
3173 @lisp
3174 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3175 @end lisp
3176
3177 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3178 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3179 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3180
3181 @example
3182 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3183 @end example
3184
3185 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3186 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3187 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3188 into the group parameters for the group.
3189
3190 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3191 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3192 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3193 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3194 @code{(ding)} form.
3195
3196 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3197 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3198 following is added to a group parameter
3199
3200 @lisp
3201 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3202 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3203 @end lisp
3204
3205 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3206 expired.
3207
3208 @end table
3209
3210 @vindex gnus-parameters
3211 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3212 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3213 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @lisp
3217 (setq gnus-parameters
3218 '(("mail\\..*"
3219 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3220 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3221 (gnus-summary-line-format
3222 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3223 (gcc-self . t)
3224 (display . all))
3225
3226 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3227 (to-group . "\\1"))
3228
3229 ("mail\\.me"
3230 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3231
3232 ("list\\..*"
3233 (total-expire . t)
3234 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3235 @end lisp
3236
3237 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3238 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3239
3240 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3241 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3242 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3243 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3244 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3245 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3246 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3247 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3248 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3249 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3250 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3251 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3252
3253 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3254 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3255 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3256 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3257 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3258 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3259 weekly news RSS feed
3260 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3261 @xref{RSS}.
3262
3263 @lisp
3264 (setq
3265 gnus-parameters
3266 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3267 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3268 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3269 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3270 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3271 ("nnrss.*debian"
3272 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3273 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3274 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3275 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3276 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3277 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3278 @end lisp
3279
3280
3281 @node Listing Groups
3282 @section Listing Groups
3283 @cindex group listing
3284
3285 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3286
3287 @table @kbd
3288
3289 @item l
3290 @itemx A s
3291 @kindex A s (Group)
3292 @kindex l (Group)
3293 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3294 List all groups that have unread articles
3295 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3296 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3297 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3298 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3299 groups).
3300
3301 @item L
3302 @itemx A u
3303 @kindex A u (Group)
3304 @kindex L (Group)
3305 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3306 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3307 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3308 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3309 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3310 unsubscribed groups).
3311
3312 @item A l
3313 @kindex A l (Group)
3314 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3315 List all unread groups on a specific level
3316 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3317 with no unread articles.
3318
3319 @item A k
3320 @kindex A k (Group)
3321 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3322 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3323 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3324 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3325 from the server.
3326
3327 @item A z
3328 @kindex A z (Group)
3329 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3330 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3331
3332 @item A m
3333 @kindex A m (Group)
3334 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3335 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3336 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3337
3338 @item A M
3339 @kindex A M (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3341 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3342
3343 @item A A
3344 @kindex A A (Group)
3345 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3346 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3347 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3348 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3349 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3350 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3351 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3352 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3353
3354 @item A a
3355 @kindex A a (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3357 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3358 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3359
3360 @item A d
3361 @kindex A d (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3363 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3364 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3365
3366 @item A c
3367 @kindex A c (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3369 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3370
3371 @item A ?
3372 @kindex A ? (Group)
3373 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3374 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3375
3376 @item A /
3377 @kindex A / (Group)
3378 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3379 List groups limited within the current selection
3380 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3381
3382 @item A f
3383 @kindex A f (Group)
3384 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3385 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3386
3387 @item A p
3388 @kindex A p (Group)
3389 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3390 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3391
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3395 @cindex visible group parameter
3396 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3397 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3398 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3399 get the same effect.
3400
3401 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3402 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3403 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3404 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3405 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3406
3407
3408 @node Sorting Groups
3409 @section Sorting Groups
3410 @cindex sorting groups
3411
3412 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3413 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3414 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3415 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3416 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3417 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3418 include:
3419
3420 @table @code
3421
3422 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3423 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3424 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3425
3426 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3427 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3428 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3429
3430 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3431 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3432 Sort by group level.
3433
3434 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3435 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3436 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3437
3438 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3439 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3440 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3441 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3442
3443 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3444 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3445 Sort by number of unread articles.
3446
3447 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3448 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3449 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3450
3451 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3452 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3453 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3454
3455
3456 @end table
3457
3458 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3459 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3460 the last one.
3461
3462
3463 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3464 some sorting criteria:
3465
3466 @table @kbd
3467 @item G S a
3468 @kindex G S a (Group)
3469 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3470 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3471 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3472
3473 @item G S u
3474 @kindex G S u (Group)
3475 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3476 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3477 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3478
3479 @item G S l
3480 @kindex G S l (Group)
3481 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3482 Sort the group buffer by group level
3483 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3484
3485 @item G S v
3486 @kindex G S v (Group)
3487 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3488 Sort the group buffer by group score
3489 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3490
3491 @item G S r
3492 @kindex G S r (Group)
3493 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3494 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3495 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3496
3497 @item G S m
3498 @kindex G S m (Group)
3499 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3500 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3501 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3502
3503 @item G S n
3504 @kindex G S n (Group)
3505 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3506 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3507 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3508
3509 @end table
3510
3511 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3512 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3513
3514 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3515 commands will sort in reverse order.
3516
3517 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3518
3519 @table @kbd
3520 @item G P a
3521 @kindex G P a (Group)
3522 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3523 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3524 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3525
3526 @item G P u
3527 @kindex G P u (Group)
3528 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3529 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3530 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3531
3532 @item G P l
3533 @kindex G P l (Group)
3534 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3535 Sort the groups by group level
3536 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3537
3538 @item G P v
3539 @kindex G P v (Group)
3540 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3541 Sort the groups by group score
3542 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3543
3544 @item G P r
3545 @kindex G P r (Group)
3546 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3547 Sort the groups by group rank
3548 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3549
3550 @item G P m
3551 @kindex G P m (Group)
3552 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3553 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3554 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3555
3556 @item G P n
3557 @kindex G P n (Group)
3558 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3559 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3560 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3561
3562 @item G P s
3563 @kindex G P s (Group)
3564 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3565 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3566
3567 @end table
3568
3569 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3570 move groups around.
3571
3572
3573 @node Group Maintenance
3574 @section Group Maintenance
3575 @cindex bogus groups
3576
3577 @table @kbd
3578 @item b
3579 @kindex b (Group)
3580 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3581 Find bogus groups and delete them
3582 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3583
3584 @item F
3585 @kindex F (Group)
3586 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3587 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3588 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3589 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3590 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3591 zombies.
3592
3593 @item C-c C-x
3594 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3595 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3596 @cindex expiring mail
3597 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3598 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3599 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3600 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3601
3602 @item C-c C-M-x
3603 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3604 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3605 @cindex expiring mail
3606 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3607 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3608
3609 @end table
3610
3611
3612 @node Browse Foreign Server
3613 @section Browse Foreign Server
3614 @cindex foreign servers
3615 @cindex browsing servers
3616
3617 @table @kbd
3618 @item B
3619 @kindex B (Group)
3620 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3621 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3622 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3623 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3624 @end table
3625
3626 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3627 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3628 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3629 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3630
3631 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3632
3633 @table @kbd
3634 @item n
3635 @kindex n (Browse)
3636 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3637 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3638
3639 @item p
3640 @kindex p (Browse)
3641 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3642 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3643
3644 @item SPACE
3645 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3646 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3647 Enter the current group and display the first article
3648 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3649
3650 @item RET
3651 @kindex RET (Browse)
3652 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3653 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3654
3655 @item u
3656 @kindex u (Browse)
3657 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3658 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3659 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3660
3661 @item l
3662 @itemx q
3663 @kindex q (Browse)
3664 @kindex l (Browse)
3665 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3666 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3667
3668 @item d
3669 @kindex d (Browse)
3670 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3671 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3672
3673 @item ?
3674 @kindex ? (Browse)
3675 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3676 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3677 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3678 @end table
3679
3680
3681 @node Exiting Gnus
3682 @section Exiting Gnus
3683 @cindex exiting Gnus
3684
3685 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3686
3687 @table @kbd
3688 @item z
3689 @kindex z (Group)
3690 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3691 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3692 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3693 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3694
3695 @item q
3696 @kindex q (Group)
3697 @findex gnus-group-exit
3698 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3699 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3700
3701 @item Q
3702 @kindex Q (Group)
3703 @findex gnus-group-quit
3704 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3705 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3706 @end table
3707
3708 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3709 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3710 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3711 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3712 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3713 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3714 exiting Gnus.
3715
3716 Note:
3717
3718 @quotation
3719 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3720 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3721 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3722 plastic chair.
3723 @end quotation
3724
3725
3726 @node Group Topics
3727 @section Group Topics
3728 @cindex topics
3729
3730 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3731 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3732 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3733 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3734 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3735 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3736
3737 @iftex
3738 @iflatex
3739 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3740 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3741 }
3742 @end iflatex
3743 @end iftex
3744
3745 Here's an example:
3746
3747 @example
3748 Gnus
3749 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3750 3: comp.emacs
3751 2: alt.religion.emacs
3752 Naughty Emacs
3753 452: alt.sex.emacs
3754 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3755 Misc
3756 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3757 13: comp.sources.unix
3758 @end example
3759
3760 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3761 @kindex t (Group)
3762 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3763 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3764 is a toggling command.)
3765
3766 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3767 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3768 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3769 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3770 Hot and bothered?
3771
3772 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3773 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3774 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3775
3776 @lisp
3777 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3778 @end lisp
3779
3780 @menu
3781 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3782 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3783 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3784 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3785 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3786 @end menu
3787
3788
3789 @node Topic Commands
3790 @subsection Topic Commands
3791 @cindex topic commands
3792
3793 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3794 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3795 definitions slightly.
3796
3797 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3798 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3799 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3800 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3801 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3802 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3803
3804 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3805 the way you like.
3806
3807 @table @kbd
3808
3809 @item T n
3810 @kindex T n (Topic)
3811 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3812 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3813 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3814
3815 @item T TAB
3816 @itemx TAB
3817 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3818 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3819 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3820 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3821 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3822 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3823
3824 @item M-TAB
3825 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3826 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3827 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3828 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3829
3830 @end table
3831
3832 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3833 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3834 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3835 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3836
3837 @table @kbd
3838
3839 @item C-k
3840 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3841 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3842 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3843 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3844
3845 @item C-y
3846 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3847 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3848 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3849 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3850 before all groups.
3851
3852 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3853 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3854 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3855 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3856 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3857
3858 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3859 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3860
3861 @end table
3862
3863 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3864 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3865 key.
3866
3867 @table @kbd
3868
3869 @item RET
3870 @kindex RET (Topic)
3871 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3872 @itemx SPACE
3873 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3874 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3875 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3876 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3877 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3878 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3879
3880 @end table
3881
3882 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3883
3884 @table @kbd
3885
3886 @item T m
3887 @kindex T m (Topic)
3888 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3889 Move the current group to some other topic
3890 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3891 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3892
3893 @item T j
3894 @kindex T j (Topic)
3895 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3896 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3897
3898 @item T c
3899 @kindex T c (Topic)
3900 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3901 Copy the current group to some other topic
3902 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3903 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3904
3905 @item T h
3906 @kindex T h (Topic)
3907 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3908 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3909 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3910
3911 @item T s
3912 @kindex T s (Topic)
3913 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3914 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3915 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3916
3917 @item T D
3918 @kindex T D (Topic)
3919 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3920 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3921 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3922 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3923 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3924 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3925 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3926 topic.
3927
3928 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3929 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3930
3931 @item T M
3932 @kindex T M (Topic)
3933 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3934 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3935 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3936
3937 @item T C
3938 @kindex T C (Topic)
3939 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3940 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3941 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3942
3943 @item T H
3944 @kindex T H (Topic)
3945 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3946 Toggle hiding empty topics
3947 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3948
3949 @item T #
3950 @kindex T # (Topic)
3951 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3952 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3953 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3954 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3955
3956 @item T M-#
3957 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3958 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3959 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3960 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3961 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3962
3963 @item C-c C-x
3964 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3965 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3966 @cindex expiring mail
3967 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3968 expiry process (if any)
3969 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3970
3971 @item T r
3972 @kindex T r (Topic)
3973 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3974 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3975
3976 @item T DEL
3977 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3978 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3979 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3980
3981 @item A T
3982 @kindex A T (Topic)
3983 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3984 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3985 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3986
3987 @item T M-n
3988 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3989 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3990 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3991
3992 @item T M-p
3993 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3994 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3995 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3996
3997 @item G p
3998 @kindex G p (Topic)
3999 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
4000 @cindex group parameters
4001 @cindex topic parameters
4002 @cindex parameters
4003 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
4004 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
4005
4006 @end table
4007
4008
4009 @node Topic Variables
4010 @subsection Topic Variables
4011 @cindex topic variables
4012
4013 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4014 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4015
4016 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4017 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4018 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4019 Valid elements are:
4020
4021 @table @samp
4022 @item i
4023 Indentation.
4024 @item n
4025 Topic name.
4026 @item v
4027 Visibility.
4028 @item l
4029 Level.
4030 @item g
4031 Number of groups in the topic.
4032 @item a
4033 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4034 @item A
4035 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4036 @end table
4037
4038 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4039 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4040 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4041 The default is 2.
4042
4043 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4044 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4045
4046 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4047 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4048 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4049
4050
4051 @node Topic Sorting
4052 @subsection Topic Sorting
4053 @cindex topic sorting
4054
4055 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4056 commands:
4057
4058
4059 @table @kbd
4060 @item T S a
4061 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4062 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4063 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4064 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4065
4066 @item T S u
4067 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4068 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4069 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4070 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4071
4072 @item T S l
4073 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4074 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4075 Sort the current topic by group level
4076 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4077
4078 @item T S v
4079 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4080 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4081 Sort the current topic by group score
4082 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4083
4084 @item T S r
4085 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4086 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4087 Sort the current topic by group rank
4088 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4089
4090 @item T S m
4091 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4092 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4093 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4094 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4095
4096 @item T S e
4097 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4098 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4099 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4100 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4101
4102 @item T S s
4103 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4104 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4105 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4106 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4107 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4108
4109 @end table
4110
4111 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4112 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4113 sorting.
4114
4115
4116 @node Topic Topology
4117 @subsection Topic Topology
4118 @cindex topic topology
4119 @cindex topology
4120
4121 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4122
4123 @example
4124 @group
4125 Gnus
4126 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4127 3: comp.emacs
4128 2: alt.religion.emacs
4129 Naughty Emacs
4130 452: alt.sex.emacs
4131 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4132 Misc
4133 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4134 13: comp.sources.unix
4135 @end group
4136 @end example
4137
4138 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4139 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4140 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4141 follows:
4142
4143 @lisp
4144 (("Gnus" visible)
4145 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4146 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4147 (("Misc" visible)))
4148 @end lisp
4149
4150 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4151 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4152 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4153 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4154 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4155 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4156
4157 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4158 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4159 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4160
4161
4162 @node Topic Parameters
4163 @subsection Topic Parameters
4164 @cindex topic parameters
4165
4166 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4167 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4168 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4169 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4170 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4171
4172 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4173 parameters:
4174
4175 @table @code
4176 @item subscribe
4177 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4178 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4179 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4180 topic.
4181
4182 @item subscribe-level
4183 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4184 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4185 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4186
4187 @end table
4188
4189 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4190 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4191 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4192 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4193
4194 @example
4195 @group
4196 Gnus
4197 Emacs
4198 3: comp.emacs
4199 2: alt.religion.emacs
4200 452: alt.sex.emacs
4201 Relief
4202 452: alt.sex.emacs
4203 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4204 Misc
4205 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4206 13: comp.sources.unix
4207 452: alt.sex.emacs
4208 @end group
4209 @end example
4210
4211 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4212 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4213 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4214 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4215 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4216 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4217
4218 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4219 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4220 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4221 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4222 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4223
4224 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4225 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4226 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4227 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4228 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4229 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4230 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4231 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4232
4233
4234 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4235 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4236 @cindex non-ascii group names
4237
4238 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4239 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4240 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4241 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4242 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4243 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4244 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4245 back end.
4246
4247 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4248 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4249 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4250 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4251 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4252 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4253 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4254 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4255
4256 @table @code
4257 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4258 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4259 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4260 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4261 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4262
4263 @lisp
4264 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4265 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4266 @end lisp
4267
4268 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4269 ones specified for the same groups with the
4270 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4271
4272 A select method can be very long, like:
4273
4274 @lisp
4275 (nntp "gmane"
4276 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4277 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4278 (nntp-open-connection-function
4279 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4280 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4281 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4282 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4283 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4284 @end lisp
4285
4286 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4287 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4288 the server name.
4289
4290 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4291 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4292 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4293 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4294 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4295 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4296
4297 @lisp
4298 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4299 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4300 (".*" . utf-8)))
4301 @end lisp
4302
4303 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4304 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4305 @end table
4306
4307 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4308 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4309 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4310 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4311 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4312 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4313
4314 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4315 names. @emph{XEmacs users must set this}. Emacs users necessarily need
4316 not do:
4317
4318 @table @code
4319 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4320 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}
4321 (which is the default). The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back
4322 end, the @acronym{NNTP} marks feature (@pxref{NNTP marks}), the agent,
4323 and the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4324 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4325 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4326 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4327
4328 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4329 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4330 file names. Therefore, @emph{you, XEmacs users, have to set it} to the
4331 coding system that is suitable to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII}
4332 group names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4333 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4334 is @code{nil}. Normally the value of
4335 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} is initialized according to the
4336 locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable to
4337 encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4338
4339 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4340 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4341 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4342 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4343
4344 If you want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese but
4345 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} is initialized by default to
4346 @code{iso-latin-1} for example, that is the most typical case where you
4347 have to set @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} even if you are an
4348 Emacs user. The @code{utf-8} coding system is a good candidate for it.
4349 Otherwise, you may change the locale in your system so that
4350 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} may be initialized to an
4351 appropriate value, instead of specifying this variable.
4352 @end table
4353
4354 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4355 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4356 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4357 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4358
4359
4360 @node Searching
4361 @section Searching
4362
4363 @menu
4364 * nnir:: Searching on IMAP, with swish, namazu, etc.
4365 * nnmairix:: Searching maildir, MH or mbox with Mairix.
4366 @end menu
4367
4368 @cindex Searching
4369
4370 FIXME: This node is a stub.
4371
4372 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
4373 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
4374 as well.
4375
4376 FIXME: Explain difference to @ref{Searching for Articles}, add reference
4377 and back-reference.
4378
4379 @node nnir
4380 @subsection nnir
4381
4382 FIXME: As a first step, convert the commentary of @file{nnir} to texi.
4383 @cindex nnir
4384
4385 @node nnmairix
4386 @subsection nnmairix
4387
4388 @cindex mairix
4389 @cindex nnmairix
4390 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
4391 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
4392 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
4393 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
4394
4395 @menu
4396 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
4397 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
4398 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
4399 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
4400 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
4401 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
4402 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
4403 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
4404 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
4405 @end menu
4406
4407 @c FIXME: The markup in this section needs improvement. E.g. add
4408 @c @sample{...}, maybe remove some @strong{...}, convert ` - ' to `---`,
4409 @c ...
4410
4411 @node About mairix
4412 @subsubsection About mairix
4413
4414 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
4415 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
4416 GPL. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
4417 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
4418 be found at
4419 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
4420
4421 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
4422 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
4423 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
4424 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
4425 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
4426 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
4427 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
4428 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
4429 up.
4430
4431 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
4432 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
4433 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
4434 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
4435 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
4436 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
4437 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
4438 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
4439 searches. This is similar to a Kiboze group (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}),
4440 but much faster.
4441
4442 @node nnmairix requirements
4443 @subsubsection nnmairix requirements
4444
4445 Mairix searches local mail - that means, mairix absolutely must have
4446 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
4447 server (e.g. an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
4448 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g. via ssh.
4449
4450 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
4451 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You
4452 @strong{must} use one of these back ends for using
4453 @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or
4454 @code{nnmh}, won't work.
4455
4456 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
4457 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
4458 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
4459 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already...
4460
4461 @node What nnmairix does
4462 @subsubsection What nnmairix does
4463
4464 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
4465 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
4466 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
4467 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g. to quickly
4468 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
4469 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
4470 mails are in different folders.
4471
4472 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
4473 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
4474 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
4475 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID. If you check for
4476 new mail in these folders (e.g. by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
4477 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
4478
4479 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
4480 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
4481 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
4482 does not - at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
4483 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
4484 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
4485 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
4486 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g. if you
4487 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
4488 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
4489 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
4490
4491 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end - it's actually more like a
4492 wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores the
4493 searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three different
4494 mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir} or
4495 @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix binary so that the
4496 search results are stored in folders named
4497 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
4498 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}. You
4499 can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail, but
4500 if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail groups
4501 alongside your other mail, you can also create e.g. a new
4502 @code{nnmaildir} server exclusively for mairix. However, a special case
4503 exists if you want to use mairix remotely on an IMAP server with
4504 @code{nnimap} - here the mairix folders and your other mail must be on
4505 the same @code{nnimap} back end.
4506
4507 @node Setting up mairix
4508 @subsubsection Setting up mairix
4509
4510 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
4511
4512 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
4513 (at least) the following entries:
4514
4515 @example
4516 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
4517 base=~/Maildir
4518 @end example
4519
4520 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following paths are
4521 relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix} with
4522 @code{nnimap}, this base path has to point to the mail path where the
4523 @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
4524
4525 @c FIXME: Add typical examples?
4526 @example
4527 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
4528 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
4529 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
4530 @end example
4531
4532 Specify all your maildir/nnml folders and mbox files (relative to the
4533 base path!) you want to index with mairix. See the man-page for
4534 mairixrc for details.
4535
4536 @example
4537 omit=zz_mairix-*
4538 @end example
4539
4540 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
4541 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
4542 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
4543 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4544
4545 @c FIXME: Add typical examples?
4546 @example
4547 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
4548 database= ... location of database file ...
4549 @end example
4550
4551 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
4552 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
4553 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
4554
4555 See the man pages for mairix and mairixrc for further options. Now
4556 simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
4557
4558 @node Configuring nnmairix
4559 @subsubsection Configuring nnmairix
4560
4561 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
4562 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
4563 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
4564 server. You will have to specify the following:
4565
4566 @itemize @bullet
4567
4568 @item
4569 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server - choose whatever you
4570 want.
4571
4572 @item
4573 The @strong{mail back end} where mairix should stores its
4574 searches. Currently @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and @code{nnml} are
4575 supported. As explained above, for locally stored mails, this can be an
4576 existing mail back end where you store your mails. However, you can also
4577 create e.g. a new @code{nnmaildir} server exclusively for
4578 @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods (@pxref{Finding the
4579 News}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an @acronym{IMAP} server,
4580 you have to choose the corresponding @code{nnimap} back end here.
4581
4582 @item
4583 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
4584 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
4585 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
4586 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g. on your
4587 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
4588 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
4589 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
4590
4591 @item
4592 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
4593 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e. all searches which
4594 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
4595 like.
4596
4597 @item
4598 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
4599 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e. with hidden maildir
4600 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
4601 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
4602 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
4603
4604 @end itemize
4605
4606 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4607 @subsubsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4608
4609 In group mode:
4610
4611 @table @kbd
4612
4613 @item G b c
4614 @kindex G b c (Group)
4615 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
4616 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
4617 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
4618 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
4619
4620 @item G b s
4621 @kindex G b s (Group)
4622 @findex nnmairix-search
4623 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
4624 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
4625 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
4626
4627 @item G b m
4628 @kindex G b m (Group)
4629 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
4630 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
4631 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
4632 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
4633
4634 @item G b i
4635 @kindex G b i (Group)
4636 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
4637 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
4638 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
4639
4640 @item G b g
4641 @kindex G b g (Group)
4642 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
4643 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
4644 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
4645 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
4646 @kbd{M-g}.
4647
4648 @item G b q
4649 @kindex G b q (Group)
4650 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
4651 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
4652 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
4653
4654 @item G b t
4655 @kindex G b t (Group)
4656 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
4657 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
4658 i.e. if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
4659 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
4660
4661 @item G b u
4662 @kindex G b u (Group)
4663 @findex nnmairix-update-database
4664 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
4665 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
4666 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
4667 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
4668 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
4669 options).
4670
4671 @item G b r
4672 @kindex G b r (Group)
4673 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
4674 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
4675 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
4676
4677 @item G b d
4678 @kindex G b d (Group)
4679 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
4680 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
4681 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
4682 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
4683
4684 @item G b a
4685 @kindex G b a (Group)
4686 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
4687 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
4688 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
4689 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
4690 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
4691 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
4692 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
4693 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
4694 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
4695
4696 @item G b p
4697 @kindex G b p (Group)
4698 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
4699 Toggle marks propagation for this group
4700 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
4701 marks}).
4702
4703 @item G b o
4704 @kindex G b o (Group)
4705 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
4706 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
4707 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
4708
4709 @end table
4710
4711 In summary mode:
4712
4713 @table @kbd
4714
4715 @item $ m
4716 @kindex $ m (Summary)
4717 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
4718 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
4719 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
4720 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
4721
4722 @item $ g
4723 @kindex $ g (Summary)
4724 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
4725 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
4726 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
4727 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
4728
4729 @item $ t
4730 @kindex $ t (Summary)
4731 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
4732 Searches thread for the current article
4733 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
4734 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
4735 current article and enabled threads.
4736
4737 @item $ f
4738 @kindex $ f (Summary)
4739 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
4740 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
4741 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
4742 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
4743
4744 @item $ o
4745 @kindex $ o (Summary)
4746 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
4747 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
4748 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that
4749 e.g. replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
4750 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
4751 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
4752 article file path as a fallback method.
4753
4754 @item $ u
4755 @kindex $ u (Summary)
4756 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
4757 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
4758 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
4759 tips and tricks}).
4760
4761 @end table
4762
4763 @node Propagating marks
4764 @subsubsection Propagating marks
4765
4766 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
4767 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
4768 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
4769
4770 @uref{http://m61s02.vlinux.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
4771
4772 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
4773 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
4774 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
4775 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
4776 be useful to you.
4777
4778 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
4779 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
4780 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
4781 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
4782 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
4783 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
4784 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
4785 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
4786 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
4787 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
4788
4789 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
4790 @samp{david@@foobar.com} - it will now show up in two groups, the
4791 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
4792 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
4793 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
4794 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group - in the ``real''
4795 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
4796
4797 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
4798 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
4799 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
4800 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
4801 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
4802 even more cumbersome.
4803
4804 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
4805 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
4806 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
4807
4808 Marks propagation is deactivated by default. You can activate it for a
4809 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
4810 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
4811 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
4812 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
4813 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
4814 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
4815
4816 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
4817 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
4818 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
4819 magically be set for the original article, too.
4820
4821 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
4822
4823 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
4824 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
4825 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
4826 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
4827 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
4828 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
4829 details).
4830
4831 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
4832 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
4833 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
4834 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
4835 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
4836 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
4837 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
4838
4839 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
4840 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
4841 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix search
4842 for determining the file path of the article. This, of course, is way
4843 slower than the registry - if you set hundreds or even thousands of
4844 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation
4845 by setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
4846
4847 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e. if you
4848 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
4849 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
4850 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
4851 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
4852 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
4853 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
4854 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
4855 maildir as its file format.
4856
4857 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
4858 If you work with this setup, just set
4859 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
4860 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
4861 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
4862 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
4863 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
4864 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
4865
4866 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
4867 @subsubsection nnmairix tips and tricks
4868
4869 @itemize
4870 @item
4871 Checking Mail
4872
4873 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
4874 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
4875 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
4876 Levels}).
4877
4878 I use the following to check for mails:
4879
4880 @lisp
4881 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
4882 (interactive "P")
4883 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
4884 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
4885 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
4886 (gnus-group-list-groups))
4887
4888 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
4889 @end lisp
4890
4891 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
4892 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
4893 details.
4894
4895 @item
4896 Example: search group for ticked articles
4897
4898 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
4899 articles always stay unread:
4900
4901 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g. @samp{important}), use
4902 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
4903
4904 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
4905 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
4906
4907 So far so good - but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
4908 group? There are two options: You may simply use
4909 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
4910 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
4911 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
4912 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
4913 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
4914 e.g. by marking an article as read.
4915
4916 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
4917 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
4918 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
4919 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
4920 snippet and the doc string for details.
4921
4922 @item
4923 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
4924
4925 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
4926 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
4927 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
4928 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
4929 usually get @strong{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
4930 @code{nnml}, i.e. you will suddenly see groups of the form
4931 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
4932 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
4933 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
4934 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
4935 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
4936 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
4937
4938 @lisp
4939 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
4940 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
4941 @end lisp
4942
4943 @end itemize
4944
4945 @node nnmairix caveats
4946 @subsubsection nnmairix caveats
4947
4948 @itemize
4949 @item
4950 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
4951 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
4952
4953 @item
4954 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
4955 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
4956 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}). Be @strong{extra careful} if
4957 you use @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} - mails which are
4958 split into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as
4959 you check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
4960
4961 @item
4962 Therefore: @strong{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
4963 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
4964
4965 @item
4966 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
4967
4968 @item
4969 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
4970 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
4971 called - it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
4972 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
4973 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
4974 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
4975 folders.
4976
4977 @item
4978 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
4979 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
4980 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
4981 it is gone for good.
4982
4983 @item
4984 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
4985 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
4986 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
4987 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
4988 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
4989 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
4990 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
4991 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
4992 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4993
4994 @item
4995 The following only applies if you @strong{don't} use the mentioned patch
4996 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
4997
4998 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
4999 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
5000 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
5001 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
5002 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
5003 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
5004 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
5005 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
5006 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
5007 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
5008 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
5009 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
5010
5011 @end itemize
5012
5013 @node Misc Group Stuff
5014 @section Misc Group Stuff
5015
5016 @menu
5017 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
5018 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
5019 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
5020 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
5021 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
5022 @end menu
5023
5024 @table @kbd
5025
5026 @item v
5027 @kindex v (Group)
5028 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
5029 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5030 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5031
5032 @lisp
5033 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
5034 (lambda ()
5035 (interactive)
5036 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
5037 @end lisp
5038
5039 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
5040 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
5041
5042 @item ^
5043 @kindex ^ (Group)
5044 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
5045 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
5046 @xref{Server Buffer}.
5047
5048 @item a
5049 @kindex a (Group)
5050 @findex gnus-group-post-news
5051 Start composing a message (a news by default)
5052 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
5053 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5054 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
5055 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
5056 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5057
5058 @item m
5059 @kindex m (Group)
5060 @findex gnus-group-mail
5061 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
5062 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
5063 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5064 @xref{Composing Messages}.
5065
5066 @item i
5067 @kindex i (Group)
5068 @findex gnus-group-news
5069 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
5070 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
5071 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5072
5073 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5074 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5075 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5076 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5077 for this to work though.
5078
5079 @item G z
5080 @kindex G z (Group)
5081 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
5082
5083 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
5084 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
5085 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
5086 count.
5087
5088 @end table
5089
5090 Variables for the group buffer:
5091
5092 @table @code
5093
5094 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
5095 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
5096 is called after the group buffer has been
5097 created.
5098
5099 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
5100 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5101 is called after the group buffer is
5102 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
5103 unnatural way.
5104
5105 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
5106 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5107 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
5108 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
5109
5110 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5111 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5112 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
5113 whether they are empty or not.
5114
5115 @end table
5116
5117 @node Scanning New Messages
5118 @subsection Scanning New Messages
5119 @cindex new messages
5120 @cindex scanning new news
5121
5122 @table @kbd
5123
5124 @item g
5125 @kindex g (Group)
5126 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
5127 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
5128 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
5129 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
5130 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
5131 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
5132 back end(s).
5133
5134 @item M-g
5135 @kindex M-g (Group)
5136 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
5137 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
5138 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
5139 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
5140 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
5141 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
5142 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
5143
5144 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
5145 @cindex activating groups
5146 @item C-c M-g
5147 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
5148 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
5149
5150 @item R
5151 @kindex R (Group)
5152 @cindex restarting
5153 @findex gnus-group-restart
5154 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
5155 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
5156 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
5157
5158 @end table
5159
5160 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
5161 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
5162
5163 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
5164 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
5165 news.
5166
5167
5168 @node Group Information
5169 @subsection Group Information
5170 @cindex group information
5171 @cindex information on groups
5172
5173 @table @kbd
5174
5175
5176 @item H f
5177 @kindex H f (Group)
5178 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
5179 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
5180 @cindex FAQ
5181 @cindex ange-ftp
5182 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
5183 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
5184 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
5185 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
5186 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
5187 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
5188 used for fetching the file.
5189
5190 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
5191 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
5192
5193 @item H c
5194 @kindex H c (Group)
5195 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
5196 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
5197 @cindex charter
5198 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
5199 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
5200 prefix argument.
5201
5202 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
5203 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
5204 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
5205
5206 @item H C
5207 @kindex H C (Group)
5208 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
5209 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
5210 @cindex control message
5211 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
5212 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
5213 group if given a prefix argument.
5214
5215 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
5216 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
5217 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
5218 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
5219
5220 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
5221 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
5222 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
5223
5224 @item H d
5225 @itemx C-c C-d
5226 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
5227 @kindex H d (Group)
5228 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
5229 @cindex describing groups
5230 @cindex group description
5231 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
5232 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
5233 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
5234
5235 @item M-d
5236 @kindex M-d (Group)
5237 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
5238 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
5239 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
5240
5241 @item H v
5242 @itemx V
5243 @kindex V (Group)
5244 @kindex H v (Group)
5245 @cindex version
5246 @findex gnus-version
5247 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
5248
5249 @item ?
5250 @kindex ? (Group)
5251 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
5252 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
5253
5254 @item C-c C-i
5255 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
5256 @cindex info
5257 @cindex manual
5258 @findex gnus-info-find-node
5259 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
5260 @end table
5261
5262
5263 @node Group Timestamp
5264 @subsection Group Timestamp
5265 @cindex timestamps
5266 @cindex group timestamps
5267
5268 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
5269 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
5270 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
5271
5272 @lisp
5273 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
5274 @end lisp
5275
5276 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
5277
5278 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
5279 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
5280
5281 @lisp
5282 (setq gnus-group-line-format
5283 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
5284 @end lisp
5285
5286 This will result in lines looking like:
5287
5288 @example
5289 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
5290 0: custom 19961002T012713
5291 @end example
5292
5293 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
5294 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
5295 something like:
5296
5297 @lisp
5298 (setq gnus-group-line-format
5299 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
5300 @end lisp
5301
5302 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
5303 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
5304 trick:
5305
5306 @lisp
5307 (setq gnus-group-line-format
5308 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
5309 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
5310 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
5311 (if time
5312 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
5313 "")))
5314 @end lisp
5315
5316
5317 @node File Commands
5318 @subsection File Commands
5319 @cindex file commands
5320
5321 @table @kbd
5322
5323 @item r
5324 @kindex r (Group)
5325 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
5326 @vindex gnus-init-file
5327 @cindex reading init file
5328 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
5329 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
5330
5331 @item s
5332 @kindex s (Group)
5333 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
5334 @cindex saving .newsrc
5335 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
5336 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
5337 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
5338
5339 @c @item Z
5340 @c @kindex Z (Group)
5341 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
5342 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
5343
5344 @end table
5345
5346
5347 @node Sieve Commands
5348 @subsection Sieve Commands
5349 @cindex group sieve commands
5350
5351 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
5352 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
5353 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
5354 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
5355 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
5356
5357 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
5358 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
5359 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
5360 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
5361 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
5362 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
5363 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
5364 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
5365 regenerate the Sieve script.
5366
5367 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
5368 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
5369 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
5370 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
5371 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
5372 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
5373 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
5374 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
5375 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
5376 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
5377
5378 @example
5379 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
5380 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
5381 stop;
5382 @}
5383 @end example
5384
5385 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
5386
5387 @table @kbd
5388
5389 @item D g
5390 @kindex D g (Group)
5391 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
5392 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
5393 @cindex generating sieve script
5394 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
5395 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
5396
5397 @item D u
5398 @kindex D u (Group)
5399 @findex gnus-sieve-update
5400 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
5401 @cindex updating sieve script
5402 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
5403 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
5404 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
5405
5406 @end table
5407
5408
5409 @node Summary Buffer
5410 @chapter Summary Buffer
5411 @cindex summary buffer
5412
5413 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
5414 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
5415
5416 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
5417 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
5418
5419 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
5420
5421 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
5422 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
5423 available in Emacs.
5424
5425 @kindex v (Summary)
5426 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
5427 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5428 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5429 @lisp
5430 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
5431 @end lisp
5432
5433 @menu
5434 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
5435 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
5436 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
5437 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
5438 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
5439 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
5440 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
5441 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
5442 * Threading:: How threads are made.
5443 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
5444 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
5445 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
5446 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
5447 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
5448 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
5449 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
5450 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
5451 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
5452 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
5453 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
5454 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
5455 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
5456 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
5457 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
5458 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
5459 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
5460 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
5461 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
5462 or reselecting the current group.
5463 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
5464 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
5465 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
5466 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
5467 @end menu
5468
5469
5470 @node Summary Buffer Format
5471 @section Summary Buffer Format
5472 @cindex summary buffer format
5473
5474 @iftex
5475 @iflatex
5476 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
5477 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
5478 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
5479 }
5480 @end iflatex
5481 @end iftex
5482
5483 @menu
5484 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
5485 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
5486 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
5487 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
5488 @end menu
5489
5490 @findex mail-extract-address-components
5491 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
5492 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
5493 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
5494 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
5495 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
5496 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
5497 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
5498 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
5499 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
5500 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
5501
5502 @lisp
5503 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
5504 'mail-extract-address-components)
5505 @end lisp
5506
5507 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
5508 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
5509 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
5510 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
5511
5512
5513 @node Summary Buffer Lines
5514 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
5515
5516 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5517 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
5518 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
5519 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
5520 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
5521
5522 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
5523 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
5524 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
5525 possible to change this. Just write a new function
5526 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
5527 @xref{Positioning Point}.
5528
5529 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
5530
5531 The following format specification characters and extended format
5532 specification(s) are understood:
5533
5534 @table @samp
5535 @item N
5536 Article number.
5537 @item S
5538 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
5539 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
5540 @item s
5541 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
5542 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
5543 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
5544 @item F
5545 Full @code{From} header.
5546 @item n
5547 The name (from the @code{From} header).
5548 @item f
5549 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
5550 From Newsgroups}).
5551 @item a
5552 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
5553 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
5554 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
5555 may be more thorough.
5556 @item A
5557 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
5558 the @code{a} spec.
5559 @item L
5560 Number of lines in the article.
5561 @item c
5562 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
5563 in some methods (like nnfolder).
5564 @item k
5565 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
5566 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
5567 @item I
5568 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5569 @item B
5570 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
5571 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
5572
5573 @example
5574 >
5575 +->
5576 | +->
5577 | | \->
5578 | | \->
5579 | \->
5580 +->
5581 \->
5582 @end example
5583
5584 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
5585 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
5586 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
5587 line-drawing glyphs.
5588 @table @code
5589 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5590 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5591 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
5592 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5593
5594 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5595 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5596 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
5597 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5598
5599 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5600 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5601 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
5602 instead. The default is @samp{}.
5603
5604 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5605 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5606 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
5607
5608 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5609 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5610 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
5611
5612 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5613 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5614 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
5615
5616 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5617 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5618 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
5619
5620 @end table
5621
5622 @item T
5623 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
5624 pushes everything after it off the screen).
5625 @item [
5626 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
5627 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5628 @item ]
5629 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
5630 for adopted articles.
5631 @item >
5632 One space for each thread level.
5633 @item <
5634 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
5635 @item U
5636 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
5637
5638 @item R
5639 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
5640 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
5641 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
5642
5643 @item i
5644 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
5645 @item z
5646 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
5647 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
5648 default level. If the difference between
5649 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
5650 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
5651 @item V
5652 Total thread score.
5653 @item x
5654 @code{Xref}.
5655 @item D
5656 @code{Date}.
5657 @item d
5658 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
5659 @item o
5660 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
5661 @item M
5662 @code{Message-ID}.
5663 @item r
5664 @code{References}.
5665 @item t
5666 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
5667 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
5668 @item e
5669 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
5670 article has any children.
5671 @item P
5672 The line number.
5673 @item O
5674 Download mark.
5675 @item *
5676 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
5677 @item &user-date;
5678 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
5679 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
5680 @item u
5681 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
5682 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
5683 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
5684 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
5685 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
5686 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
5687 @end table
5688
5689 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
5690 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
5691 There can only be one such area.
5692
5693 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
5694 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
5695 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
5696 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
5697 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
5698 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
5699
5700 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
5701 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5702
5703 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5704
5705
5706 @node To From Newsgroups
5707 @subsection To From Newsgroups
5708 @cindex To
5709 @cindex Newsgroups
5710
5711 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5712 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5713 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5714 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5715 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5716
5717 @enumerate
5718 @item
5719 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
5720 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5721 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5722 instance:
5723
5724 @lisp
5725 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5726 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5727 @end lisp
5728
5729 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5730 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5731
5732 @item
5733 @findex gnus-extra-header
5734 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5735 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5736 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5737
5738 @example
5739 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5740 @end example
5741
5742 @item
5743 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5744 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5745 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5746 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5747 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5748 headers are used instead.
5749
5750 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5751 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5752 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5753 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5754 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5755 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5756
5757 @end enumerate
5758
5759 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5760 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5761 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5762 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5763 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5764 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5765 regeneration.
5766
5767 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5768 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5769 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5770 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5771
5772 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5773 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5774
5775 @lisp
5776 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5777 '(To Newsgroups))
5778 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5779 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5780 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5781 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5782 "Your Name Here")
5783 @end lisp
5784
5785 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5786 to fit your needs.)
5787
5788 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5789 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5790 support:
5791
5792 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5793 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5794 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5795
5796 @example
5797 Newsgroups:full
5798 @end example
5799
5800 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5801 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5802
5803
5804 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5805 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5806
5807 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5808 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5809 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5810 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5811
5812 Here are the elements you can play with:
5813
5814 @table @samp
5815 @item G
5816 Group name.
5817 @item p
5818 Unprefixed group name.
5819 @item A
5820 Current article number.
5821 @item z
5822 Current article score.
5823 @item V
5824 Gnus version.
5825 @item U
5826 Number of unread articles in this group.
5827 @item e
5828 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5829 summary buffer.
5830 @item Z
5831 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5832 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5833 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5834 and no unselected ones.
5835 @item g
5836 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5837 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5838 @item S
5839 Subject of the current article.
5840 @item u
5841 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5842 @item s
5843 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5844 @item d
5845 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5846 @item t
5847 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5848 @item r
5849 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5850 @item E
5851 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5852 @end table
5853
5854
5855 @node Summary Highlighting
5856 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5857
5858 @table @code
5859
5860 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5861 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5862 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5863 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5864 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5865
5866 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5867 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5868 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5869 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5870
5871 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5872 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5873 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5874 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5875
5876 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5877 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5878 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5879 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5880 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5881 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5882 to something like
5883 @lisp
5884 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5885 ((> score default) . bold))
5886 @end lisp
5887 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5888 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5889 @end table
5890
5891
5892 @node Summary Maneuvering
5893 @section Summary Maneuvering
5894 @cindex summary movement
5895
5896 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5897 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5898
5899 None of these commands select articles.
5900
5901 @table @kbd
5902 @item G M-n
5903 @itemx M-n
5904 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5905 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5906 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5907 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5908 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5909
5910 @item G M-p
5911 @itemx M-p
5912 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5913 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5914 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5915 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5916 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5917
5918 @item G g
5919 @kindex G g (Summary)
5920 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5921 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5922 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5923 @end table
5924
5925 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5926 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5927 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5928 to the group buffer.
5929
5930 Variables related to summary movement:
5931
5932 @table @code
5933
5934 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5935 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5936 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5937 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5938 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5939 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5940 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5941 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5942 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5943 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5944 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5945 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5946 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5947 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5948
5949 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5950 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5951 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5952 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5953 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5954 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5955 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5956
5957 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5958
5959 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5960 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5961 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5962 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5963 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5964
5965 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5966 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5967 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5968 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5969 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5970 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5971 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5972 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5973 threads.
5974
5975 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5976 the given number of lines from the top.
5977
5978 @end table
5979
5980
5981 @node Choosing Articles
5982 @section Choosing Articles
5983 @cindex selecting articles
5984
5985 @menu
5986 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5987 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5988 @end menu
5989
5990
5991 @node Choosing Commands
5992 @subsection Choosing Commands
5993
5994 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5995 and they all select and display an article.
5996
5997 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5998 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5999
6000 @table @kbd
6001 @item SPACE
6002 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
6003 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
6004 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
6005 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6006
6007 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
6008 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
6009 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
6010
6011 @item G n
6012 @itemx n
6013 @kindex n (Summary)
6014 @kindex G n (Summary)
6015 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
6016 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
6017 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
6018
6019 @item G p
6020 @itemx p
6021 @kindex p (Summary)
6022 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
6023 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
6024 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
6025
6026 @item G N
6027 @itemx N
6028 @kindex N (Summary)
6029 @kindex G N (Summary)
6030 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
6031 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
6032
6033 @item G P
6034 @itemx P
6035 @kindex P (Summary)
6036 @kindex G P (Summary)
6037 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
6038 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
6039
6040 @item G C-n
6041 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
6042 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
6043 Go to the next article with the same subject
6044 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
6045
6046 @item G C-p
6047 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
6048 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
6049 Go to the previous article with the same subject
6050 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
6051
6052 @item G f
6053 @itemx .
6054 @kindex G f (Summary)
6055 @kindex . (Summary)
6056 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
6057 Go to the first unread article
6058 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
6059
6060 @item G b
6061 @itemx ,
6062 @kindex G b (Summary)
6063 @kindex , (Summary)
6064 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
6065 Go to the unread article with the highest score
6066 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
6067 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
6068
6069 @item G l
6070 @itemx l
6071 @kindex l (Summary)
6072 @kindex G l (Summary)
6073 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
6074 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
6075
6076 @item G o
6077 @kindex G o (Summary)
6078 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
6079 @cindex history
6080 @cindex article history
6081 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
6082 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
6083 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
6084 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
6085 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
6086 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
6087
6088 @item G j
6089 @itemx j
6090 @kindex j (Summary)
6091 @kindex G j (Summary)
6092 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
6093 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
6094 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
6095
6096 @end table
6097
6098
6099 @node Choosing Variables
6100 @subsection Choosing Variables
6101
6102 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
6103
6104 @table @code
6105 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6106 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6107 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
6108 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
6109 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
6110 the server and display it in the article buffer.
6111
6112 @item gnus-select-article-hook
6113 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
6114 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
6115 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
6116 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
6117 hook will do so.
6118
6119 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
6120 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
6121 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
6122 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
6123 @findex gnus-unread-mark
6124 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
6125 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
6126 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
6127 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
6128 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
6129 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
6130 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
6131 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
6132 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
6133
6134 @end table
6135
6136
6137 @node Paging the Article
6138 @section Scrolling the Article
6139 @cindex article scrolling
6140
6141 @table @kbd
6142
6143 @item SPACE
6144 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
6145 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
6146 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
6147 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
6148 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6149
6150 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
6151 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
6152 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
6153 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
6154 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
6155 what is considered uninteresting with
6156 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
6157 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
6158
6159 @item DEL
6160 @kindex DEL (Summary)
6161 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
6162 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
6163
6164 @item RET
6165 @kindex RET (Summary)
6166 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
6167 Scroll the current article one line forward
6168 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
6169
6170 @item M-RET
6171 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
6172 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
6173 Scroll the current article one line backward
6174 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
6175
6176 @item A g
6177 @itemx g
6178 @kindex A g (Summary)
6179 @kindex g (Summary)
6180 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
6181 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6182 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
6183 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
6184 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
6185 the way it came from the server.
6186
6187 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
6188 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
6189 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
6190
6191 @lisp
6192 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6193 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
6194 (2 . big5)))
6195 @end lisp
6196
6197 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
6198
6199 @item A <
6200 @itemx <
6201 @kindex < (Summary)
6202 @kindex A < (Summary)
6203 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
6204 Scroll to the beginning of the article
6205 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
6206
6207 @item A >
6208 @itemx >
6209 @kindex > (Summary)
6210 @kindex A > (Summary)
6211 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
6212 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
6213
6214 @item A s
6215 @itemx s
6216 @kindex A s (Summary)
6217 @kindex s (Summary)
6218 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
6219 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
6220 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
6221
6222 @item h
6223 @kindex h (Summary)
6224 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
6225 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
6226
6227 @end table
6228
6229
6230 @node Reply Followup and Post
6231 @section Reply, Followup and Post
6232
6233 @menu
6234 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
6235 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
6236 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
6237 * Canceling and Superseding::
6238 @end menu
6239
6240
6241 @node Summary Mail Commands
6242 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
6243 @cindex mail
6244 @cindex composing mail
6245
6246 Commands for composing a mail message:
6247
6248 @table @kbd
6249
6250 @item S r
6251 @itemx r
6252 @kindex S r (Summary)
6253 @kindex r (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-reply
6255 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
6256 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
6257 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
6258 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
6259
6260 @item S R
6261 @itemx R
6262 @kindex R (Summary)
6263 @kindex S R (Summary)
6264 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
6265 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
6266 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6267 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
6268 command uses the process/prefix convention.
6269
6270 @item S w
6271 @kindex S w (Summary)
6272 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
6273 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
6274 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
6275 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6276 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
6277 present, that's used instead.
6278
6279 @item S W
6280 @kindex S W (Summary)
6281 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
6282 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
6283 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
6284 the process/prefix convention.
6285
6286 @item S v
6287 @kindex S v (Summary)
6288 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
6289 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
6290 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
6291 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6292 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
6293 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
6294
6295 @item S V
6296 @kindex S V (Summary)
6297 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
6298 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
6299 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
6300 command uses the process/prefix convention.
6301
6302 @item S B r
6303 @kindex S B r (Summary)
6304 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
6305 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
6306 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
6307 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
6308 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
6309 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
6310 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
6311
6312 @item S B R
6313 @kindex S B R (Summary)
6314 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
6315 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6316 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
6317 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
6318
6319 @item S o m
6320 @itemx C-c C-f
6321 @kindex S o m (Summary)
6322 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
6323 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
6324 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
6325 Forward the current article to some other person
6326 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
6327 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
6328 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6329 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6330 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6331 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6332 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6333 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6334 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
6335 section.
6336
6337 @item S m
6338 @itemx m
6339 @kindex m (Summary)
6340 @kindex S m (Summary)
6341 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
6342 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
6343 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
6344 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6345 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
6346
6347 @item S i
6348 @itemx i
6349 @kindex i (Summary)
6350 @kindex S i (Summary)
6351 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
6352 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
6353 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
6354 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
6355
6356 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
6357 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
6358 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
6359 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
6360 for this to work though.
6361
6362 @item S D b
6363 @kindex S D b (Summary)
6364 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
6365 @cindex bouncing mail
6366 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
6367 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
6368 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
6369 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
6370 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
6371 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
6372 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
6373 very well fail, though.
6374
6375 @item S D r
6376 @kindex S D r (Summary)
6377 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
6378 Not to be confused with the previous command,
6379 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
6380 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
6381 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
6382 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
6383 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
6384 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
6385 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
6386
6387 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
6388 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
6389 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
6390 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
6391 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
6392
6393 This command understands the process/prefix convention
6394 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6395
6396 @item S D e
6397 @kindex S D e (Summary)
6398 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
6399
6400 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
6401 if it were a new message before resending.
6402
6403 @item S O m
6404 @kindex S O m (Summary)
6405 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
6406 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
6407 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
6408 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6409
6410 @item S M-c
6411 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
6412 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
6413 @cindex crossposting
6414 @cindex excessive crossposting
6415 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
6416 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
6417
6418 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
6419 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
6420 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
6421 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
6422 command understands the process/prefix convention
6423 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
6424
6425 @end table
6426
6427 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6428 Manual}, for more information.
6429
6430
6431 @node Summary Post Commands
6432 @subsection Summary Post Commands
6433 @cindex post
6434 @cindex composing news
6435
6436 Commands for posting a news article:
6437
6438 @table @kbd
6439 @item S p
6440 @itemx a
6441 @kindex a (Summary)
6442 @kindex S p (Summary)
6443 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
6444 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
6445 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
6446 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6447 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
6448
6449 @item S f
6450 @itemx f
6451 @kindex f (Summary)
6452 @kindex S f (Summary)
6453 @findex gnus-summary-followup
6454 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
6455 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
6456
6457 @item S F
6458 @itemx F
6459 @kindex S F (Summary)
6460 @kindex F (Summary)
6461 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
6462 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
6463 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
6464 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
6465 process/prefix convention.
6466
6467 @item S n
6468 @kindex S n (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
6470 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6471 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
6472
6473 @item S N
6474 @kindex S N (Summary)
6475 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
6476 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6477 message through mail and include the original message
6478 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
6479 the process/prefix convention.
6480
6481 @item S o p
6482 @kindex S o p (Summary)
6483 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
6484 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
6485 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
6486 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
6487 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
6488 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6489 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6490 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6491 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6492 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6493 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6494 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
6495
6496 @item S O p
6497 @kindex S O p (Summary)
6498 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
6499 @cindex digests
6500 @cindex making digests
6501 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
6502 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
6503 process/prefix convention.
6504
6505 @item S u
6506 @kindex S u (Summary)
6507 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
6508 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
6509 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
6510 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
6511 @end table
6512
6513 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6514 Manual}, for more information.
6515
6516
6517 @node Summary Message Commands
6518 @subsection Summary Message Commands
6519
6520 @table @kbd
6521 @item S y
6522 @kindex S y (Summary)
6523 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
6524 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
6525 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
6526 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
6527 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6528
6529 @end table
6530
6531
6532 @node Canceling and Superseding
6533 @subsection Canceling Articles
6534 @cindex canceling articles
6535 @cindex superseding articles
6536
6537 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
6538 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
6539
6540 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
6541
6542 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
6543 @kindex C (Summary)
6544 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
6545 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
6546 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
6547 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
6548 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
6549 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6550
6551 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
6552 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
6553 question.
6554
6555 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
6556 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
6557 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
6558
6559 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
6560 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
6561 message, Message Manual}).
6562
6563 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
6564 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
6565 your original article.
6566
6567 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
6568 @kindex S (Summary)
6569 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
6570 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
6571 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
6572 usual way.
6573
6574 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
6575 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
6576 have posted almost the same article twice.
6577
6578 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
6579 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
6580 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
6581 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
6582 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
6583 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
6584 header by substituting one of those words for the word
6585 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
6586 you would do normally. The previous article will be
6587 canceled/superseded.
6588
6589 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
6590
6591 @node Delayed Articles
6592 @section Delayed Articles
6593 @cindex delayed sending
6594 @cindex send delayed
6595
6596 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
6597 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
6598 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
6599 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
6600
6601 @lisp
6602 (gnus-delay-initialize)
6603 @end lisp
6604
6605 @findex gnus-delay-article
6606 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
6607 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
6608 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
6609 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
6610
6611 @itemize @bullet
6612 @item
6613 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
6614 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
6615 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
6616 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
6617
6618 @item
6619 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
6620 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
6621 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
6622
6623 @item
6624 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
6625 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
6626 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
6627 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
6628 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
6629 that means a time tomorrow.
6630 @end itemize
6631
6632 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
6633 couple of variables:
6634
6635 @table @code
6636 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
6637 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
6638 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
6639 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
6640
6641 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
6642 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
6643 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
6644 formats described above.
6645
6646 @item gnus-delay-group
6647 @vindex gnus-delay-group
6648 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
6649 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
6650 value is @code{"delayed"}.
6651
6652 @item gnus-delay-header
6653 @vindex gnus-delay-header
6654 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
6655 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
6656 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
6657 @end table
6658
6659 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
6660 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
6661 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
6662 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
6663 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
6664
6665 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
6666 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
6667 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
6668 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
6669 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
6670 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
6671 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
6672
6673 @table @code
6674 @item gnus-delay-initialize
6675 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
6676 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
6677 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
6678 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
6679 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
6680 argument is ignored.
6681
6682 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
6683 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
6684 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
6685 @end table
6686
6687
6688 @node Marking Articles
6689 @section Marking Articles
6690 @cindex article marking
6691 @cindex article ticking
6692 @cindex marks
6693
6694 There are several marks you can set on an article.
6695
6696 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6697 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6698 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6699
6700 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6701
6702 @ifinfo
6703 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6704 @end ifinfo
6705
6706 @menu
6707 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6708 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6709 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6710 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6711 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6712 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6713 @end menu
6714
6715
6716 @node Unread Articles
6717 @subsection Unread Articles
6718
6719 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6720 other.
6721
6722 @table @samp
6723 @item !
6724 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6725 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6726
6727 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6728 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6729 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6730 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6731 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6732 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6733 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6734
6735 @item ?
6736 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6737 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6738
6739 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6740 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6741 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6742 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6743 messages.
6744
6745 @item SPACE
6746 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6747 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6748
6749 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6750 @end table
6751
6752
6753 @node Read Articles
6754 @subsection Read Articles
6755 @cindex expirable mark
6756
6757 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6758
6759 @table @samp
6760
6761 @item r
6762 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6763 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6764 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6765
6766 @item R
6767 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6768 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6769
6770 @item O
6771 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6772 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6773 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6774
6775 @item K
6776 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6777 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6778
6779 @item X
6780 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6781 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6782
6783 @item Y
6784 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6785 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6786
6787 @item C
6788 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6789 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6790
6791 @item G
6792 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6793 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6794
6795 @item F
6796 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
6797 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
6798
6799 @item Q
6800 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6801 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6802 Threading}.
6803
6804 @item M
6805 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6806 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6807 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6808
6809 @end table
6810
6811 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6812 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6813
6814 One more special mark, though:
6815
6816 @table @samp
6817 @item E
6818 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6819 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6820
6821 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6822 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6823 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6824 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6825 any time.
6826 @end table
6827
6828
6829 @node Other Marks
6830 @subsection Other Marks
6831 @cindex process mark
6832 @cindex bookmarks
6833
6834 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6835 read or not.
6836
6837 @itemize @bullet
6838
6839 @item
6840 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6841 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6842 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6843 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6844 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6845
6846 @item
6847 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6848 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6849 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6850 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6851
6852 @item
6853 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6854 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6855 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6856
6857 @item
6858 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6859 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6860 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6861
6862 @item
6863 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6864 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6865 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6866 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6867
6868 @item
6869 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
6870 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
6871 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
6872 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
6873 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
6874 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
6875
6876 @item
6877 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6878 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6879 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6880 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
6881
6882 @item
6883 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6884 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6885 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6886 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6887 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6888 use.)
6889
6890 @item
6891 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6892 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6893 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6894 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6895 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6896 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6897
6898 @item
6899 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6900 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6901 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6902 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6903 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6904 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6905 use.)
6906
6907 @item
6908 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6909 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6910 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6911 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6912 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6913
6914 @item
6915 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6916 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6917 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6918 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6919 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6920 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6921
6922 @end itemize
6923
6924 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6925 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6926 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6927
6928 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6929 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6930 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6931
6932
6933 @node Setting Marks
6934 @subsection Setting Marks
6935 @cindex setting marks
6936
6937 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6938
6939 @table @kbd
6940 @item M c
6941 @itemx M-u
6942 @kindex M c (Summary)
6943 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6944 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6945 @cindex mark as unread
6946 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6947 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6948 article as unread.
6949
6950 @item M t
6951 @itemx !
6952 @kindex ! (Summary)
6953 @kindex M t (Summary)
6954 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6955 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6956 @xref{Article Caching}.
6957
6958 @item M ?
6959 @itemx ?
6960 @kindex ? (Summary)
6961 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6962 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6963 Mark the current article as dormant
6964 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6965
6966 @item M d
6967 @itemx d
6968 @kindex M d (Summary)
6969 @kindex d (Summary)
6970 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6971 Mark the current article as read
6972 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6973
6974 @item D
6975 @kindex D (Summary)
6976 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6977 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6978 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6979
6980 @item M k
6981 @itemx k
6982 @kindex k (Summary)
6983 @kindex M k (Summary)
6984 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6985 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6986 and then select the next unread article
6987 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6988
6989 @item M K
6990 @itemx C-k
6991 @kindex M K (Summary)
6992 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6993 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6994 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6995 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6996
6997 @item M C
6998 @kindex M C (Summary)
6999 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
7000 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
7001 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
7002
7003 @item M C-c
7004 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
7005 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
7006 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
7007 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
7008
7009 @item M H
7010 @kindex M H (Summary)
7011 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
7012 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
7013 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
7014
7015 @item M h
7016 @kindex M h (Summary)
7017 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
7018 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
7019 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
7020
7021 @item C-w
7022 @kindex C-w (Summary)
7023 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
7024 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
7025 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
7026
7027 @item M V k
7028 @kindex M V k (Summary)
7029 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
7030 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
7031 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
7032
7033 @item M e
7034 @itemx E
7035 @kindex M e (Summary)
7036 @kindex E (Summary)
7037 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
7038 Mark the current article as expirable
7039 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
7040
7041 @item M b
7042 @kindex M b (Summary)
7043 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
7044 Set a bookmark in the current article
7045 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
7046
7047 @item M B
7048 @kindex M B (Summary)
7049 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
7050 Remove the bookmark from the current article
7051 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
7052
7053 @item M V c
7054 @kindex M V c (Summary)
7055 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
7056 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
7057 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7058
7059 @item M V u
7060 @kindex M V u (Summary)
7061 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
7062 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
7063 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
7064
7065 @item M V m
7066 @kindex M V m (Summary)
7067 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
7068 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
7069 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
7070 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7071 @end table
7072
7073 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
7074 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
7075 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
7076 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
7077 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
7078 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
7079 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
7080 The default is @code{t}.
7081
7082
7083 @node Generic Marking Commands
7084 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
7085
7086 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
7087 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
7088 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
7089 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
7090 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
7091 well.
7092
7093 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
7094 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
7095 command should do.
7096
7097 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
7098 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
7099 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
7100 to list in this manual.
7101
7102 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
7103 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
7104 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
7105 article, you could say something like:
7106
7107 @lisp
7108 @group
7109 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
7110 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7111 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
7112 @end group
7113 @end lisp
7114
7115 @noindent
7116 or
7117
7118 @lisp
7119 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7120 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
7121 @end lisp
7122
7123
7124 @node Setting Process Marks
7125 @subsection Setting Process Marks
7126 @cindex setting process marks
7127
7128 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
7129 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
7130 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
7131 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
7132 articles into the cache. For more information,
7133 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
7134
7135 @table @kbd
7136
7137 @item M P p
7138 @itemx #
7139 @kindex # (Summary)
7140 @kindex M P p (Summary)
7141 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
7142 Mark the current article with the process mark
7143 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
7144 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
7145
7146 @item M P u
7147 @itemx M-#
7148 @kindex M P u (Summary)
7149 @kindex M-# (Summary)
7150 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
7151 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
7152
7153 @item M P U
7154 @kindex M P U (Summary)
7155 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
7156 Remove the process mark from all articles
7157 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
7158
7159 @item M P i
7160 @kindex M P i (Summary)
7161 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
7162 Invert the list of process marked articles
7163 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
7164
7165 @item M P R
7166 @kindex M P R (Summary)
7167 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
7168 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7169 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
7170
7171 @item M P G
7172 @kindex M P G (Summary)
7173 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
7174 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7175 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
7176
7177 @item M P r
7178 @kindex M P r (Summary)
7179 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
7180 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
7181
7182 @item M P g
7183 @kindex M P g (Summary)
7184 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
7185 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
7186
7187 @item M P t
7188 @kindex M P t (Summary)
7189 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7190 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7191 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7192
7193 @item M P T
7194 @kindex M P T (Summary)
7195 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7196 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7197 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7198
7199 @item M P v
7200 @kindex M P v (Summary)
7201 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
7202 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
7203 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
7204
7205 @item M P s
7206 @kindex M P s (Summary)
7207 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
7208 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
7209
7210 @item M P S
7211 @kindex M P S (Summary)
7212 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
7213 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
7214 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
7215
7216 @item M P a
7217 @kindex M P a (Summary)
7218 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
7219 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
7220
7221 @item M P b
7222 @kindex M P b (Summary)
7223 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
7224 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
7225 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
7226
7227 @item M P k
7228 @kindex M P k (Summary)
7229 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
7230 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
7231 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
7232
7233 @item M P y
7234 @kindex M P y (Summary)
7235 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
7236 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
7237 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
7238
7239 @item M P w
7240 @kindex M P w (Summary)
7241 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
7242 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
7243 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
7244
7245 @end table
7246
7247 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
7248 set process marks based on article body contents.
7249
7250
7251 @node Limiting
7252 @section Limiting
7253 @cindex limiting
7254
7255 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
7256 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
7257 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
7258 buffer.
7259
7260 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
7261 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
7262 additional articles.
7263
7264 @table @kbd
7265
7266 @item / /
7267 @itemx / s
7268 @kindex / / (Summary)
7269 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
7270 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
7271 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
7272 matching articles.
7273
7274 @item / a
7275 @kindex / a (Summary)
7276 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
7277 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
7278 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
7279 matching articles.
7280
7281 @item / R
7282 @kindex / R (Summary)
7283 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
7284 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
7285 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
7286 matching articles.
7287
7288 @item / A
7289 @kindex / A (Summary)
7290 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
7291 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
7292 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
7293 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
7294
7295 @item / S
7296 @kindex / S (Summary)
7297 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
7298 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
7299 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
7300 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
7301
7302 @item / x
7303 @kindex / x (Summary)
7304 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
7305 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
7306 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
7307 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
7308 matching articles.
7309
7310 @item / u
7311 @itemx x
7312 @kindex / u (Summary)
7313 @kindex x (Summary)
7314 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
7315 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
7316 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
7317 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
7318 dormant articles will also be excluded.
7319
7320 @item / m
7321 @kindex / m (Summary)
7322 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
7323 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
7324 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
7325
7326 @item / t
7327 @kindex / t (Summary)
7328 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
7329 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
7330 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
7331 articles younger than that number of days.
7332
7333 @item / n
7334 @kindex / n (Summary)
7335 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
7336 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
7337 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
7338 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
7339
7340 @item / w
7341 @kindex / w (Summary)
7342 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
7343 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
7344 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
7345 the stack.
7346
7347 @item / .
7348 @kindex / . (Summary)
7349 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
7350 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
7351 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
7352
7353 @item / v
7354 @kindex / v (Summary)
7355 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
7356 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
7357 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
7358
7359 @item / p
7360 @kindex / p (Summary)
7361 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
7362 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
7363 group parameter predicate
7364 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
7365 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
7366
7367 @item / r
7368 @kindex / r (Summary)
7369 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
7370 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
7371 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
7372 replied articles.
7373
7374 @item / E
7375 @itemx M S
7376 @kindex M S (Summary)
7377 @kindex / E (Summary)
7378 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
7379 Include all expunged articles in the limit
7380 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
7381
7382 @item / D
7383 @kindex / D (Summary)
7384 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
7385 Include all dormant articles in the limit
7386 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
7387
7388 @item / *
7389 @kindex / * (Summary)
7390 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
7391 Include all cached articles in the limit
7392 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
7393
7394 @item / d
7395 @kindex / d (Summary)
7396 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
7397 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
7398 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
7399
7400 @item / M
7401 @kindex / M (Summary)
7402 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
7403 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
7404
7405 @item / T
7406 @kindex / T (Summary)
7407 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
7408 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
7409
7410 @item / c
7411 @kindex / c (Summary)
7412 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
7413 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
7414 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
7415
7416 @item / C
7417 @kindex / C (Summary)
7418 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
7419 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
7420 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
7421 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
7422
7423 @item / N
7424 @kindex / N (Summary)
7425 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
7426 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
7427 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
7428
7429 @item / o
7430 @kindex / o (Summary)
7431 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
7432 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
7433 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
7434
7435 @item / b
7436 @kindex / b (Summary)
7437 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
7438 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
7439 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
7440 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
7441 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
7442
7443 @item / h
7444 @kindex / h (Summary)
7445 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
7446 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
7447 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
7448
7449 @end table
7450
7451
7452 @node Threading
7453 @section Threading
7454 @cindex threading
7455 @cindex article threading
7456
7457 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
7458 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
7459 hierarchical fashion.
7460
7461 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
7462 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
7463 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
7464 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
7465 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
7466 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
7467 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
7468
7469 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
7470
7471 @table @dfn
7472 @item root
7473 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
7474
7475 @item thread
7476 A tree-like article structure.
7477
7478 @item sub-thread
7479 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
7480
7481 @item loose threads
7482 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
7483 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
7484 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
7485 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
7486 called loose threads.
7487
7488 @item thread gathering
7489 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
7490
7491 @item sparse threads
7492 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
7493 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
7494
7495 @end table
7496
7497
7498 @menu
7499 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
7500 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
7501 @end menu
7502
7503
7504 @node Customizing Threading
7505 @subsection Customizing Threading
7506 @cindex customizing threading
7507
7508 @menu
7509 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
7510 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
7511 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
7512 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
7513 @end menu
7514
7515
7516 @node Loose Threads
7517 @subsubsection Loose Threads
7518 @cindex <
7519 @cindex >
7520 @cindex loose threads
7521
7522 @table @code
7523 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
7524 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
7525 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
7526 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
7527 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
7528 read or killed the root in a previous session.
7529
7530 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
7531 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
7532 There are four possible values:
7533
7534 @iftex
7535 @iflatex
7536 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
7537 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
7538 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
7539 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
7540 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
7541 }
7542 @end iflatex
7543 @end iftex
7544
7545 @cindex adopting articles
7546
7547 @table @code
7548
7549 @item adopt
7550 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
7551 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
7552 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
7553 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
7554
7555 @item dummy
7556 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
7557 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
7558 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
7559 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
7560 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
7561 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
7562 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
7563 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
7564 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
7565 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
7566
7567 @item empty
7568 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
7569 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
7570 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
7571 Buffer Format}).)
7572
7573 @item none
7574 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
7575 display them after one another.
7576
7577 @item nil
7578 Don't gather loose threads.
7579 @end table
7580
7581 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7582 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7583 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
7584 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
7585 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
7586 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
7587 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
7588 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
7589 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
7590 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
7591 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
7592
7593 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
7594 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
7595 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
7596 Matching}).
7597
7598 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7599 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7600 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
7601 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
7602 simplification is used.
7603
7604 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7605 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7606 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
7607 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
7608
7609 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
7610 @lisp
7611 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7612 (concat
7613 "\\`\\[?\\("
7614 (mapconcat
7615 'identity
7616 '("looking"
7617 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
7618 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
7619 "answer" "reference" "announce"
7620 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
7621 ;; ...
7622 )
7623 "\\|")
7624 "\\)\\s *\\("
7625 (mapconcat 'identity
7626 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
7627 "\\|")
7628 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
7629 @end lisp
7630
7631 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
7632 subjects.
7633
7634 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7635 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7636 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
7637 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
7638 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
7639 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
7640
7641 Useful functions to put in this list include:
7642
7643 @table @code
7644 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
7645 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
7646 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
7647
7648 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7649 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7650 Simplify fuzzily.
7651
7652 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
7653 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
7654 Remove excessive whitespace.
7655
7656 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7657 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7658 Remove all whitespace.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 You may also write your own functions, of course.
7662
7663
7664 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7665 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7666 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
7667 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
7668 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
7669 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
7670 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
7671 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
7672
7673 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7674 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7675 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
7676 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
7677 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
7678 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
7679 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
7680 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
7681 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
7682 cholera:
7683
7684 @table @code
7685 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7686 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7687 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
7688 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
7689
7690 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7691 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7692 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7696 something like:
7697
7698 @lisp
7699 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7700 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7701 @end lisp
7702
7703 @end table
7704
7705
7706 @node Filling In Threads
7707 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7708
7709 @table @code
7710 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7711 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7712 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7713 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7714 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7715 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7716 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7717 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7718 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7719 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7720 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7721 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7722 do about that.
7723
7724 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7725 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7726 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7727
7728 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7729
7730 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7731 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7732 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7733 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7734 slow summary generation.
7735
7736 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7737 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7738 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7739 newsgroups.
7740
7741 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7742 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7743 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7744 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7745 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7746 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7747 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7748 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7749 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7750 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7751 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7752 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7753 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7754 @code{nil} by default.
7755
7756 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7757 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7758 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7759 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7760 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7761 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7762 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
7763
7764 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7765 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7766 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7767
7768 @end table
7769
7770
7771 @node More Threading
7772 @subsubsection More Threading
7773
7774 @table @code
7775 @item gnus-show-threads
7776 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7777 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7778 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7779 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7780 slower and more awkward.
7781
7782 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7783 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7784 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7785 generated.
7786
7787 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7788 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7789 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7790
7791 Here's an example:
7792
7793 @lisp
7794 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7795 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7796 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7797 @end lisp
7798
7799 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7800 unread, but you get my drift.)
7801
7802
7803 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7804 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7805 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7806 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7807 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7808 threads are expunged.
7809
7810 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7811 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7812 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7813 will be hidden.
7814
7815 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7816 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7817 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7818 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7819 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7820 result in a new thread.
7821
7822 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7823 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7824 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7825 The default is 4.
7826
7827 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7828 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7829 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7830 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7831 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7832 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7833 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7834 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7835 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7836 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7837 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7838
7839 @end table
7840
7841
7842 @node Low-Level Threading
7843 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7844
7845 @table @code
7846
7847 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7848 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7849 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7850
7851 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7852 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7853 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7854 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7855 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7856 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7857 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7858 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7859 meaningful. Here's one example:
7860
7861 @lisp
7862 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7863
7864 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7865 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7866 (when (string-match
7867 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7868 (mail-header-set-id
7869 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7870 header))))
7871 @end lisp
7872
7873 @end table
7874
7875
7876 @node Thread Commands
7877 @subsection Thread Commands
7878 @cindex thread commands
7879
7880 @table @kbd
7881
7882 @item T k
7883 @itemx C-M-k
7884 @kindex T k (Summary)
7885 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7886 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7887 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7888 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7889 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7890 articles instead.
7891
7892 @item T l
7893 @itemx C-M-l
7894 @kindex T l (Summary)
7895 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7896 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7897 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7898 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7899
7900 @item T i
7901 @kindex T i (Summary)
7902 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7903 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7904 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7905
7906 @item T #
7907 @kindex T # (Summary)
7908 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7909 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7910 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7911
7912 @item T M-#
7913 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7914 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7915 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7916 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7917
7918 @item T T
7919 @kindex T T (Summary)
7920 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7921 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7922
7923 @item T s
7924 @kindex T s (Summary)
7925 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7926 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7927 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7928
7929 @item T h
7930 @kindex T h (Summary)
7931 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7932 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7933
7934 @item T S
7935 @kindex T S (Summary)
7936 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7937 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7938
7939 @item T H
7940 @kindex T H (Summary)
7941 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7942 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7943
7944 @item T t
7945 @kindex T t (Summary)
7946 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7947 Re-thread the current article's thread
7948 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7949 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7950
7951 @item T ^
7952 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7953 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7954 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7955 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7956
7957 @item T M-^
7958 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7959 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7960 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7961 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7962
7963 @end table
7964
7965 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7966 understand the numeric prefix.
7967
7968 @table @kbd
7969
7970 @item T n
7971 @kindex T n (Summary)
7972 @itemx C-M-f
7973 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7974 @itemx M-down
7975 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7976 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7977 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7978
7979 @item T p
7980 @kindex T p (Summary)
7981 @itemx C-M-b
7982 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7983 @itemx M-up
7984 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7985 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7986 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7987
7988 @item T d
7989 @kindex T d (Summary)
7990 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7991 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7992
7993 @item T u
7994 @kindex T u (Summary)
7995 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7996 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7997
7998 @item T o
7999 @kindex T o (Summary)
8000 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
8001 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
8002 @end table
8003
8004 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
8005 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
8006 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
8007 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
8008 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
8009 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
8010 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
8011 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
8012 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
8013 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
8014 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
8015 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
8016 Matching}).
8017
8018
8019 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
8020 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
8021
8022 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
8023 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
8024 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
8025 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8026 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
8027 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
8028 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8029 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
8030 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
8031 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
8032 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
8033 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
8034 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
8035 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
8036 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
8037
8038 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
8039 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
8040 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
8041 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
8042 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
8043 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
8044 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
8045 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
8046 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
8047 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
8048
8049 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
8050 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
8051 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
8052
8053 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
8054 last function in the list. You should probably always include
8055 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
8056 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
8057 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
8058 ascending article order.
8059
8060 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
8061 by number, you could do something like:
8062
8063 @lisp
8064 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
8065 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8066 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8067 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
8068 @end lisp
8069
8070 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
8071 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
8072 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
8073 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
8074 which the articles arrived.
8075
8076 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
8077 say something like:
8078
8079 @lisp
8080 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
8081 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
8082 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
8083 @end lisp
8084
8085 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
8086 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
8087 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
8088 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
8089 tickles your fancy.
8090
8091 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
8092 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
8093 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
8094 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
8095 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
8096 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
8097 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
8098 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
8099 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
8100 variable. It is very similar to the
8101 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
8102 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
8103 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
8104 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
8105 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
8106 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
8107 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
8108
8109 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
8110 say something like:
8111
8112 @lisp
8113 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
8114 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
8115 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
8116 @end lisp
8117
8118 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
8119 @xref{Group Parameters}.
8120
8121
8122 @node Asynchronous Fetching
8123 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
8124 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
8125 @cindex article pre-fetch
8126 @cindex pre-fetch
8127
8128 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
8129 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
8130 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
8131 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
8132 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
8133
8134 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
8135 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
8136
8137 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
8138 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
8139 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
8140 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
8141 connection is blocked.
8142
8143 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
8144 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
8145 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
8146 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
8147
8148 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
8149 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
8150 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
8151 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
8152 extra connection.
8153
8154 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
8155 you really want to.
8156
8157 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
8158 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
8159 happen automatically.
8160
8161 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
8162 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
8163 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
8164 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
8165 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
8166 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
8167 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
8168
8169 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
8170 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
8171 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
8172 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
8173 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
8174 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
8175 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
8176 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
8177 article data structure as the only parameter.
8178
8179 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
8180 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
8181
8182 @lisp
8183 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
8184 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
8185 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
8186 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
8187 100)))
8188
8189 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
8190 @end lisp
8191
8192 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
8193 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
8194 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
8195
8196 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
8197 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
8198 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
8199 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
8200
8201 @table @code
8202 @item read
8203 Remove articles when they are read.
8204
8205 @item exit
8206 Remove articles when exiting the group.
8207 @end table
8208
8209 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
8210
8211 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
8212 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
8213 @c from the next group.
8214
8215
8216 @node Article Caching
8217 @section Article Caching
8218 @cindex article caching
8219 @cindex caching
8220
8221 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
8222 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
8223 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
8224 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
8225 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
8226
8227 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
8228
8229 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8230 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
8231 @vindex gnus-use-cache
8232 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
8233 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
8234 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
8235 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
8236 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
8237
8238 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
8239 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
8240 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
8241 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
8242 as dormant, and don't worry.
8243
8244 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
8245
8246 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
8247 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
8248 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
8249 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
8250 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
8251 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
8252 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
8253 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
8254 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
8255 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
8256
8257 @findex gnus-jog-cache
8258 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
8259 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
8260 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
8261 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
8262 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
8263 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
8264 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
8265 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
8266 not then be downloaded by this command.
8267
8268 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
8269 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
8270 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
8271 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
8272 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
8273 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
8274
8275 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
8276 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
8277 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
8278 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
8279 variables, the group is not cached.
8280
8281 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
8282 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
8283 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
8284 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
8285 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
8286 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
8287 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
8288 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
8289 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
8290 file.
8291
8292 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
8293 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
8294 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
8295 where, isn't that cool?
8296
8297 @node Persistent Articles
8298 @section Persistent Articles
8299 @cindex persistent articles
8300
8301 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
8302 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
8303 useful in my opinion.
8304
8305 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
8306 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
8307 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
8308 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
8309 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
8310 the expiry going on at the news server.
8311
8312 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
8313 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
8314 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
8315
8316 @table @kbd
8317
8318 @item *
8319 @kindex * (Summary)
8320 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
8321 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
8322
8323 @item M-*
8324 @kindex M-* (Summary)
8325 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
8326 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
8327 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
8328 article.
8329 @end table
8330
8331 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
8332
8333 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
8334 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
8335 interested in persistent articles:
8336
8337 @lisp
8338 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
8339 @end lisp
8340
8341 @node Sticky Articles
8342 @section Sticky Articles
8343 @cindex sticky articles
8344
8345 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
8346 according to the value of the variable
8347 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
8348 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
8349 has its own article buffer.
8350
8351 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
8352 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
8353 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
8354 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next christmas party.
8355
8356 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
8357 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
8358 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
8359
8360 @table @kbd
8361 @item A S
8362 @kindex A S (Summary)
8363 @findex gnus-sticky-article
8364 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
8365 name for this sticky article buffer.
8366 @end table
8367
8368 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
8369
8370 @table @kbd
8371 @item q
8372 @kindex q (Article)
8373 @findex bury-buffer
8374 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
8375
8376 @item k
8377 @kindex k (Article)
8378 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
8379 Kills this sticky article buffer.
8380 @end table
8381
8382 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
8383
8384 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
8385 Kill all sticky article buffers.
8386 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
8387 @end defun
8388
8389 @node Article Backlog
8390 @section Article Backlog
8391 @cindex backlog
8392 @cindex article backlog
8393
8394 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
8395 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
8396 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
8397 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
8398 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
8399 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
8400 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
8401 increase memory usage some.
8402
8403 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
8404 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
8405 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
8406 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
8407 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
8408 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
8409 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
8410
8411 The default value is 20.
8412
8413
8414 @node Saving Articles
8415 @section Saving Articles
8416 @cindex saving articles
8417
8418 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
8419 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
8420 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
8421 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
8422 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
8423
8424 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
8425 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
8426 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
8427
8428 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
8429 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
8430 unwanted headers before saving the article.
8431
8432 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
8433 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
8434 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
8435 deleted before saving.
8436
8437 @table @kbd
8438
8439 @item O o
8440 @itemx o
8441 @kindex O o (Summary)
8442 @kindex o (Summary)
8443 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
8444 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
8445 Save the current article using the default article saver
8446 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
8447
8448 @item O m
8449 @kindex O m (Summary)
8450 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
8451 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
8452 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
8453
8454 @item O r
8455 @kindex O r (Summary)
8456 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
8457 Save the current article in Rmail format
8458 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
8459
8460 @item O f
8461 @kindex O f (Summary)
8462 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
8463 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
8464 Save the current article in plain file format
8465 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
8466
8467 @item O F
8468 @kindex O F (Summary)
8469 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
8470 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
8471 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
8472
8473 @item O b
8474 @kindex O b (Summary)
8475 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
8476 Save the current article body in plain file format
8477 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
8478
8479 @item O h
8480 @kindex O h (Summary)
8481 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
8482 Save the current article in mh folder format
8483 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
8484
8485 @item O v
8486 @kindex O v (Summary)
8487 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
8488 Save the current article in a VM folder
8489 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
8490
8491 @item O p
8492 @itemx |
8493 @kindex O p (Summary)
8494 @kindex | (Summary)
8495 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
8496 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
8497 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
8498 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
8499 complete headers in the piped output.
8500
8501 @item O P
8502 @kindex O P (Summary)
8503 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
8504 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
8505 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
8506 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
8507 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
8508 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
8509 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
8510
8511 @end table
8512
8513 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
8514 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
8515 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
8516 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
8517 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
8518 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
8519 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
8520 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
8521 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
8522 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
8523 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
8524 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
8525 files.
8526
8527
8528 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
8529 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
8530 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
8531 functions below, or you can create your own.
8532
8533 @table @code
8534
8535 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8536 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8537 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
8538 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
8539 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
8540 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8541 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8542
8543 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8544 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8545 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
8546 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
8547 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8548 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8549
8550 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
8551 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
8552 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
8553 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8554 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
8555 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8556 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8557
8558 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
8559 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
8560 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8561 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8562 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8563 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8564
8565 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8566 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8567 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
8568 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8569 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8570
8571 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8572 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8573 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8574 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8575 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8576 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8577
8578 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8579 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8580 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
8581 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
8582 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
8583 @cindex rcvstore
8584 @cindex MH folders
8585 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
8586 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
8587 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
8588 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
8589 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
8590
8591 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8592 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8593 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
8594 reader to use this setting.
8595 @end table
8596
8597 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
8598
8599 @table @code
8600 @item :decode
8601 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
8602 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
8603 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
8604 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
8605 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
8606
8607 @item :function
8608 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
8609 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
8610 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
8611 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
8612 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
8613 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
8614
8615 @item :headers
8616 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
8617 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
8618 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
8619 headers should be saved.
8620 @end table
8621
8622 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
8623 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
8624 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
8625 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
8626 default.
8627
8628 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
8629 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
8630 available functions that generate names:
8631
8632 @table @code
8633
8634 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
8635 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8636 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8637
8638 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
8639 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8640 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8641
8642 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
8643 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8644 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8645
8646 @item gnus-plain-save-name
8647 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
8648 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8649
8650 @item gnus-sender-save-name
8651 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
8652 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8653 @end table
8654
8655 @vindex gnus-split-methods
8656 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8657 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8658 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8659 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8660 like:
8661
8662 @lisp
8663 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8664 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8665 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8666 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8667 @end lisp
8668
8669 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8670 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8671 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8672 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8673 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8674 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8675 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8676 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8677 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8678
8679 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8680 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8681 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8682 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8683
8684 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8685 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8686 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8687 name.
8688
8689 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8690 lots of mail groups called things like
8691 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8692 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8693 following will do just that:
8694
8695 @lisp
8696 (defun my-save-name (group)
8697 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8698 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8699
8700 (setq gnus-split-methods
8701 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8702 (my-save-name)))
8703 @end lisp
8704
8705
8706 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8707 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8708 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8709 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8710 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8711 all the files in the top level directory
8712 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8713 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8714 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8715 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8716
8717 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8718 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8719 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8720 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8721 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8722 for kill files.
8723
8724 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8725 a spool, you could
8726
8727 @lisp
8728 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8729 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8730 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8731 @end lisp
8732
8733 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8734 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8735 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8736 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8737
8738
8739 @node Decoding Articles
8740 @section Decoding Articles
8741 @cindex decoding articles
8742
8743 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8744 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8745
8746 @menu
8747 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8748 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8749 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8750 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8751 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8752 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8753 @end menu
8754
8755 @cindex series
8756 @cindex article series
8757 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8758 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8759 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8760 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8761 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8762
8763 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8764 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8765 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8766
8767 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8768 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8769 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8770
8771 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8772 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8773 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8774
8775
8776 @node Uuencoded Articles
8777 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8778 @cindex uudecode
8779 @cindex uuencoded articles
8780
8781 @table @kbd
8782
8783 @item X u
8784 @kindex X u (Summary)
8785 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8786 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8787 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8788
8789 @item X U
8790 @kindex X U (Summary)
8791 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8792 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8793 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8794
8795 @item X v u
8796 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8797 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8798 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8799
8800 @item X v U
8801 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8802 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8803 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8804 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8805
8806 @end table
8807
8808 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8809 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8810 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8811 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8812 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8813
8814 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8815 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8816 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8817 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8818 @kbd{X u}.
8819
8820 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8821 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8822 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8823 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8824 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8825 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8826 off.
8827
8828
8829 @node Shell Archives
8830 @subsection Shell Archives
8831 @cindex unshar
8832 @cindex shell archives
8833 @cindex shared articles
8834
8835 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8836 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8837 some commands to deal with these:
8838
8839 @table @kbd
8840
8841 @item X s
8842 @kindex X s (Summary)
8843 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8844 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8845
8846 @item X S
8847 @kindex X S (Summary)
8848 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8849 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8850
8851 @item X v s
8852 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8853 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8854 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8855
8856 @item X v S
8857 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8858 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8859 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8860 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8861 @end table
8862
8863
8864 @node PostScript Files
8865 @subsection PostScript Files
8866 @cindex PostScript
8867
8868 @table @kbd
8869
8870 @item X p
8871 @kindex X p (Summary)
8872 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8873 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8874
8875 @item X P
8876 @kindex X P (Summary)
8877 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8878 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8879 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8880
8881 @item X v p
8882 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8883 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8884 View the current PostScript series
8885 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8886
8887 @item X v P
8888 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8889 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8890 View and save the current PostScript series
8891 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8892 @end table
8893
8894
8895 @node Other Files
8896 @subsection Other Files
8897
8898 @table @kbd
8899 @item X o
8900 @kindex X o (Summary)
8901 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8902 Save the current series
8903 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8904
8905 @item X b
8906 @kindex X b (Summary)
8907 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8908 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8909 doesn't really work yet.
8910
8911 @item X Y
8912 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8913 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8914 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8915 @end table
8916
8917
8918 @node Decoding Variables
8919 @subsection Decoding Variables
8920
8921 Adjective, not verb.
8922
8923 @menu
8924 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8925 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8926 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8927 @end menu
8928
8929
8930 @node Rule Variables
8931 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8932 @cindex rule variables
8933
8934 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8935 variables are of the form
8936
8937 @lisp
8938 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8939 '(regexp2 command2)
8940 ...)
8941 @end lisp
8942
8943 @table @code
8944
8945 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8946 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8947 @cindex sox
8948 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8949 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8950 say something like:
8951 @lisp
8952 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8953 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8954 @end lisp
8955
8956 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8957 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8958 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8959 user and default view rules.
8960
8961 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8962 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8963 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8964 archives.
8965 @end table
8966
8967
8968 @node Other Decode Variables
8969 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8970
8971 @table @code
8972 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8973
8974 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8975 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8976 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8977 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8978 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8979
8980 @table @code
8981
8982 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8983 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8984 View the file.
8985
8986 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8987 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8988 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8989 @end table
8990
8991 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8992 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8993 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8994 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8995 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8996 time.
8997
8998 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8999 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
9000 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
9001
9002 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9003 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9004 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
9005 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
9006 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
9007 kludgey.
9008
9009 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9010 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9011 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
9012
9013 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9014 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9015 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
9016 looking for files to display.
9017
9018 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
9019 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
9020 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
9021 after viewing it.
9022
9023 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9024 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9025 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
9026 rules.
9027
9028 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9029 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9030 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
9031 unpacking commands.
9032
9033 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9034 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9035 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
9036 from articles.
9037
9038 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9039 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9040 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
9041 decoded articles as unread.
9042
9043 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9044 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9045 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
9046 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
9047
9048 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9049 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9050 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
9051
9052 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9053 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9054 @cindex metamail
9055 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
9056 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
9057 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
9058 @code{metamail} for viewing.
9059
9060 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9061 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9062 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
9063 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
9064 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
9065 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
9066 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
9067 simply dropped them.
9068
9069 @end table
9070
9071
9072 @node Uuencoding and Posting
9073 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
9074
9075 @table @code
9076
9077 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9078 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9079 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
9080 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
9081 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
9082 for you when you post the article.
9083
9084 @item gnus-uu-post-length
9085 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
9086 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
9087 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
9088
9089 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
9090 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
9091 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
9092 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
9093 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
9094 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
9095 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
9096
9097 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9098 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9099 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
9100 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
9101 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
9102 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
9103 Default is @code{t}.
9104
9105 @end table
9106
9107
9108 @node Viewing Files
9109 @subsection Viewing Files
9110 @cindex viewing files
9111 @cindex pseudo-articles
9112
9113 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
9114 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
9115 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
9116 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
9117 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
9118 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
9119 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
9120
9121 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
9122 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
9123 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
9124 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
9125
9126 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
9127 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
9128 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
9129
9130 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
9131 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
9132 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
9133 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
9134 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
9135
9136 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
9137 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
9138 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
9139 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
9140 a list of parameters to that command.
9141
9142 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
9143 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
9144 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
9145
9146 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
9147 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
9148 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
9149
9150
9151 @node Article Treatment
9152 @section Article Treatment
9153
9154 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
9155 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
9156 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
9157 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
9158 these articles easier.
9159
9160 @menu
9161 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
9162 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
9163 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
9164 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
9165 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
9166 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
9167 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
9168 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
9169 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
9170 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
9171 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
9172 @end menu
9173
9174
9175 @node Article Highlighting
9176 @subsection Article Highlighting
9177 @cindex highlighting
9178
9179 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
9180 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
9181
9182 @table @kbd
9183
9184 @item W H a
9185 @kindex W H a (Summary)
9186 @findex gnus-article-highlight
9187 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
9188 Do much highlighting of the current article
9189 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
9190 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
9191
9192 @item W H h
9193 @kindex W H h (Summary)
9194 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
9195 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
9196 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
9197 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
9198 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
9199 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
9200 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
9201 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
9202 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
9203 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
9204 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
9205
9206 @item W H c
9207 @kindex W H c (Summary)
9208 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
9209 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
9210
9211 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
9212
9213 @table @code
9214 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9215
9216 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9217 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
9218 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
9219
9220 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
9221 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
9222 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
9223
9224 @item gnus-cite-face-list
9225 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
9226 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
9227 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
9228 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
9229 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
9230
9231 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
9232 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
9233 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
9234
9235 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9236 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9237 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
9238
9239 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9240 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9241 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
9242 that it's a citation.
9243
9244 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9245 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9246 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
9247
9248 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9249 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9250 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
9251
9252 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
9253 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
9254 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
9255 cited text belonging to the attribution.
9256
9257 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9258 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9259 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
9260 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
9261 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
9262 is @code{t}.
9263
9264 @end table
9265
9266
9267 @item W H s
9268 @kindex W H s (Summary)
9269 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9270 @vindex gnus-signature-face
9271 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
9272 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
9273 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
9274 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
9275 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
9276 default.
9277
9278 @end table
9279
9280 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
9281
9282
9283 @node Article Fontisizing
9284 @subsection Article Fontisizing
9285 @cindex emphasis
9286 @cindex article emphasis
9287
9288 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
9289 @kindex W e (Summary)
9290 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
9291 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
9292 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
9293 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
9294
9295 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
9296 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
9297 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
9298 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
9299 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
9300 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
9301 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
9302 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
9303 highlighting.
9304
9305 @lisp
9306 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
9307 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
9308 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
9309 @end lisp
9310
9311 @cindex slash
9312 @cindex asterisk
9313 @cindex underline
9314 @cindex /
9315 @cindex *
9316
9317 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
9318 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
9319 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
9320 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
9321 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
9322 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
9323 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
9324 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
9325 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
9326 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
9327 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
9328 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
9329 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
9330
9331 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
9332 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
9333 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
9334 say something like:
9335
9336 @lisp
9337 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
9338 @end lisp
9339
9340 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
9341
9342 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
9343 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
9344 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
9345 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
9346
9347 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
9348
9349
9350 @node Article Hiding
9351 @subsection Article Hiding
9352 @cindex article hiding
9353
9354 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
9355 too much cruft in most articles.
9356
9357 @table @kbd
9358
9359 @item W W a
9360 @kindex W W a (Summary)
9361 @findex gnus-article-hide
9362 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
9363 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
9364 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
9365
9366 @item W W h
9367 @kindex W W h (Summary)
9368 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
9369 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
9370 Headers}.
9371
9372 @item W W b
9373 @kindex W W b (Summary)
9374 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9375 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
9376 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
9377
9378 @item W W s
9379 @kindex W W s (Summary)
9380 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
9381 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
9382 Signature}.
9383
9384 @item W W l
9385 @kindex W W l (Summary)
9386 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
9387 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9388 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
9389 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
9390 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
9391 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
9392 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
9393
9394 @table @code
9395
9396 @item gnus-list-identifiers
9397 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9398 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
9399 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
9400
9401 @end table
9402
9403 @item W W P
9404 @kindex W W P (Summary)
9405 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
9406 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
9407 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
9408
9409 @item W W B
9410 @kindex W W B (Summary)
9411 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
9412 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
9413 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9414 @cindex banner
9415 @cindex OneList
9416 @cindex stripping advertisements
9417 @cindex advertisements
9418 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
9419 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
9420 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
9421 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
9422 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
9423 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
9424 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
9425 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
9426 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
9427 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
9428 used.
9429
9430 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
9431 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
9432 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
9433
9434 @table @code
9435
9436 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9437 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9438 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
9439 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
9440 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
9441 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
9442 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
9443 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
9444 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
9445 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
9446 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
9447
9448 @lisp
9449 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
9450 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
9451 @end lisp
9452
9453 @end table
9454
9455 @item W W c
9456 @kindex W W c (Summary)
9457 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
9458 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
9459 customizing the hiding:
9460
9461 @table @code
9462
9463 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9464 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9465 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9466 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9467 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
9468 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
9469 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
9470 specs are valid:
9471
9472 @table @samp
9473 @item b
9474 Starting point of the hidden text.
9475 @item e
9476 Ending point of the hidden text.
9477 @item l
9478 Number of characters in the hidden region.
9479 @item n
9480 Number of lines of hidden text.
9481 @end table
9482
9483 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
9484 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
9485 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
9486 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
9487 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
9488
9489 @end table
9490
9491 @item W W C-c
9492 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
9493 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
9494
9495 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
9496 following two variables:
9497
9498 @table @code
9499 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9500 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9501 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
9502 50), hide the cited text.
9503
9504 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9505 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9506 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
9507 is hidden.
9508 @end table
9509
9510 @item W W C
9511 @kindex W W C (Summary)
9512 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
9513 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
9514 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
9515 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
9516 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9517
9518 @end table
9519
9520 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
9521 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
9522 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
9523
9524 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
9525 citation customization.
9526
9527 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
9528 automatically.
9529
9530
9531 @node Article Washing
9532 @subsection Article Washing
9533 @cindex washing
9534 @cindex article washing
9535
9536 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
9537 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
9538
9539 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
9540 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
9541 Cleaner, perhaps.
9542
9543 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
9544 articles by default.
9545
9546 @table @kbd
9547
9548 @item C-u g
9549 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
9550 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
9551 the server.
9552
9553 @item g
9554 Force redisplaying of the current article
9555 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
9556 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
9557 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
9558 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9559
9560 @item W l
9561 @kindex W l (Summary)
9562 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
9563 Remove page breaks from the current article
9564 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
9565 delimiters.
9566
9567 @item W r
9568 @kindex W r (Summary)
9569 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
9570 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
9571 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
9572 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
9573 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
9574 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
9575
9576 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
9577 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
9578 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
9579 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
9580
9581 @item W m
9582 @kindex W m (Summary)
9583 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
9584 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
9585
9586 @item W i
9587 @kindex W i (Summary)
9588 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
9589 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
9590 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
9591 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
9592 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
9593 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
9594 to work.
9595
9596 @item W t
9597 @item t
9598 @kindex W t (Summary)
9599 @kindex t (Summary)
9600 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
9601 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
9602 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
9603
9604 @item W v
9605 @kindex W v (Summary)
9606 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
9607 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
9608 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
9609
9610 @item W o
9611 @kindex W o (Summary)
9612 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
9613 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
9614
9615 @item W d
9616 @kindex W d (Summary)
9617 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
9618 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
9619 @cindex Smartquotes
9620 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
9621 @cindex Latin 1
9622 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
9623 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
9624 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
9625 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
9626 interactively.
9627
9628 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9629 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9630 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9631 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9632
9633 @item W Y f
9634 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
9635 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9636 @cindex Outlook Express
9637 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9638 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9639 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9640
9641 @item W Y u
9642 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9643 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9644 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9645 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9646 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9647 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9648 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9649 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9650 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9651 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9652
9653 @item W Y a
9654 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9655 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9656 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9657 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9658
9659 @item W Y c
9660 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9661 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9662 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9663 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9664
9665 @item W w
9666 @kindex W w (Summary)
9667 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9668 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9669
9670 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9671 when filling.
9672
9673 @item W Q
9674 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9675 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9676 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9677
9678 @item W C
9679 @kindex W C (Summary)
9680 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9681 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9682 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9683
9684 @item W c
9685 @kindex W c (Summary)
9686 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9687 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9688 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9689 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9690 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9691
9692 @item W q
9693 @kindex W q (Summary)
9694 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9695 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9696 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9697 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9698 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9699 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9700 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9701 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9702 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9703
9704 @item W 6
9705 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9706 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9707 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9708 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9709 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9710 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9711 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9712 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9713
9714 @item W Z
9715 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9716 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9717 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9718 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9719 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9720
9721 @item W A
9722 @kindex W A (Summary)
9723 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9724 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9725 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9726 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9727 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9728
9729 @item W u
9730 @kindex W u (Summary)
9731 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9732 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9733 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9734 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9735 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9736
9737 @item W h
9738 @kindex W h (Summary)
9739 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9740 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9741 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9742 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9743
9744 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9745 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9746 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9747
9748 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
9749 The default is to use the function specified by
9750 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9751 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9752 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
9753 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
9754 can use include:
9755
9756 @table @code
9757 @item w3
9758 Use Emacs/W3.
9759
9760 @item w3m
9761 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9762
9763 @item w3m-standalone
9764 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9765
9766 @item links
9767 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9768
9769 @item lynx
9770 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9771
9772 @item html2text
9773 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9774
9775 @end table
9776
9777 @item W b
9778 @kindex W b (Summary)
9779 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9780 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9781 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9782
9783 @item W B
9784 @kindex W B (Summary)
9785 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9786 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9787 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9788
9789 @item W p
9790 @kindex W p (Summary)
9791 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9792 Verify a signed control message
9793 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9794 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9795 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9796 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9797 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9798 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9799
9800 @item W s
9801 @kindex W s (Summary)
9802 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9803 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9804 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9805 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9806
9807 @item W a
9808 @kindex W a (Summary)
9809 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9810 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9811 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9812
9813 @item W E l
9814 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9815 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9816 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9817 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9818
9819 @item W E m
9820 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9821 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9822 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9823 lines with a single empty line.
9824 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9825
9826 @item W E t
9827 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9828 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9829 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9830 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9831
9832 @item W E a
9833 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9834 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9835 Do all the three commands above
9836 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9837
9838 @item W E A
9839 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9840 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9841 Remove all blank lines
9842 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9843
9844 @item W E s
9845 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9846 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9847 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9848 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9849
9850 @item W E e
9851 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9852 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9853 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9854 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9855
9856 @end table
9857
9858 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9859
9860
9861 @node Article Header
9862 @subsection Article Header
9863
9864 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9865
9866 @table @kbd
9867
9868 @item W G u
9869 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9870 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9871 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9872
9873 @item W G n
9874 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9875 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9876 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9877 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9878
9879 @item W G f
9880 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9881 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9882 Fold all the message headers
9883 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9884
9885 @item W E w
9886 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9887 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9888 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9889 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9890
9891 @end table
9892
9893
9894 @node Article Buttons
9895 @subsection Article Buttons
9896 @cindex buttons
9897
9898 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9899 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9900 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9901 button on these references.
9902
9903 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9904 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9905 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9906 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9907 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9908
9909 @table @code
9910
9911 @item gnus-button-alist
9912 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9913 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9914
9915 @lisp
9916 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9917 @end lisp
9918
9919 @table @var
9920
9921 @item regexp
9922 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9923 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9924 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9925 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9926 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9927
9928 @item button-par
9929 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9930 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9931 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9932
9933 @item use-p
9934 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9935 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9936 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9937 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9938 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9939
9940 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9941
9942 @item function
9943 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9944
9945 @item data-par
9946 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9947 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9948
9949 @end table
9950
9951 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9952
9953 @lisp
9954 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9955 @end lisp
9956
9957 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9958 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9959 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9960 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9961 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9962
9963 @lisp
9964 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9965 @end lisp
9966
9967 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9968 @end table
9969
9970 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9971
9972 @table @code
9973 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9974 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9975
9976 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9977
9978 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9979 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9980 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9981 default values of the variables above.
9982
9983 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9984
9985 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9986 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9987 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9988 argument with a string naming the man page.
9989
9990 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9991
9992 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9993 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9994 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9995
9996 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9997 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9998 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9999 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
10000 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
10001 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
10002 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
10003 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
10004 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
10005 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
10006 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
10007 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10008
10009 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10010 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10011 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
10012 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
10013 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
10014 string is invalid.
10015
10016 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10017 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10018 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
10019 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10020
10021 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
10022
10023 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
10024 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
10025 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
10026 argument, the string naming the URL.
10027
10028 @item gnus-ctan-url
10029 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
10030 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
10031 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
10032
10033 @c Misc stuff
10034
10035 @item gnus-article-button-face
10036 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
10037 Face used on buttons.
10038
10039 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
10040 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
10041 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
10042
10043 @end table
10044
10045 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
10046
10047
10048 @node Article Button Levels
10049 @subsection Article button levels
10050 @cindex button levels
10051 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
10052 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
10053 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
10054 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
10055 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
10056 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
10057 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
10058 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
10059
10060 @lisp
10061 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
10062 (setq gnus-parameters
10063 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
10064 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
10065 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
10066 @end lisp
10067
10068 @table @code
10069
10070 @item gnus-button-browse-level
10071 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
10072 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
10073 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
10074 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
10075 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
10076
10077 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
10078 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
10079 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
10080 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
10081 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
10082 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
10083 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
10084 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
10085 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
10086 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
10087 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
10088 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
10089 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
10090
10091 @item gnus-button-man-level
10092 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
10093 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
10094 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
10095
10096 @item gnus-button-message-level
10097 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
10098 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
10099 Related variables and functions include
10100 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
10101 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
10102 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
10103 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
10104
10105 @item gnus-button-tex-level
10106 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
10107 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
10108 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
10109 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
10110 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
10111 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
10112
10113 @end table
10114
10115
10116 @node Article Date
10117 @subsection Article Date
10118
10119 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
10120 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
10121 when the article was sent.
10122
10123 @table @kbd
10124
10125 @item W T u
10126 @kindex W T u (Summary)
10127 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
10128 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
10129 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
10130
10131 @item W T i
10132 @kindex W T i (Summary)
10133 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
10134 @cindex ISO 8601
10135 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
10136 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
10137
10138 @item W T l
10139 @kindex W T l (Summary)
10140 @findex gnus-article-date-local
10141 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
10142
10143 @item W T p
10144 @kindex W T p (Summary)
10145 @findex gnus-article-date-english
10146 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
10147 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
10148
10149 @item W T s
10150 @kindex W T s (Summary)
10151 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
10152 @findex gnus-article-date-user
10153 @findex format-time-string
10154 Display the date using a user-defined format
10155 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
10156 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
10157 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
10158 for a list of possible format specs.
10159
10160 @item W T e
10161 @kindex W T e (Summary)
10162 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
10163 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
10164 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
10165 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
10166 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
10167
10168 @example
10169 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
10170 @end example
10171
10172 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
10173 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
10174 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
10175 replace it.
10176
10177 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
10178 into wonderful absurdities.
10179
10180 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
10181
10182 @lisp
10183 (gnus-start-date-timer)
10184 @end lisp
10185
10186 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
10187 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
10188 command.
10189
10190 @item W T o
10191 @kindex W T o (Summary)
10192 @findex gnus-article-date-original
10193 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
10194 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
10195 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
10196 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
10197 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
10198
10199 @end table
10200
10201 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
10202 preferred format automatically.
10203
10204
10205 @node Article Display
10206 @subsection Article Display
10207 @cindex picons
10208 @cindex x-face
10209 @cindex smileys
10210
10211 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
10212 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
10213
10214 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
10215 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
10216
10217 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
10218 headers (@pxref{Face}).
10219
10220 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
10221 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
10222
10223 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
10224 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
10225
10226 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
10227 they'll be removed.
10228
10229 @table @kbd
10230 @item W D x
10231 @kindex W D x (Summary)
10232 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
10233 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
10234 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
10235
10236 @item W D d
10237 @kindex W D d (Summary)
10238 @findex gnus-article-display-face
10239 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
10240 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
10241
10242 @item W D s
10243 @kindex W D s (Summary)
10244 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
10245 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
10246
10247 @item W D f
10248 @kindex W D f (Summary)
10249 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
10250 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
10251
10252 @item W D m
10253 @kindex W D m (Summary)
10254 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
10255 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
10256 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
10257
10258 @item W D n
10259 @kindex W D n (Summary)
10260 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
10261 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
10262 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
10263
10264 @item W D D
10265 @kindex W D D (Summary)
10266 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
10267 Remove all images from the article buffer
10268 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
10269
10270 @end table
10271
10272
10273
10274 @node Article Signature
10275 @subsection Article Signature
10276 @cindex signatures
10277 @cindex article signature
10278
10279 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
10280 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
10281 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
10282 that says what is to be considered a signature is
10283 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
10284 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
10285 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
10286 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
10287 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
10288
10289 @lisp
10290 (setq gnus-signature-separator
10291 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
10292 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
10293 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
10294 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
10295 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
10296 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
10297 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
10298 @end lisp
10299
10300 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
10301 positives.
10302
10303 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
10304 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
10305 signature when displaying articles.
10306
10307 @enumerate
10308 @item
10309 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
10310 that integer.
10311 @item
10312 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
10313 than that number.
10314 @item
10315 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
10316 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
10317 @item
10318 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
10319 in question is not a signature.
10320 @end enumerate
10321
10322 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
10323 listed above. Here's an example:
10324
10325 @lisp
10326 (setq gnus-signature-limit
10327 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
10328 @end lisp
10329
10330 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
10331 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
10332 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
10333 signature after all.
10334
10335
10336 @node Article Miscellanea
10337 @subsection Article Miscellanea
10338
10339 @table @kbd
10340 @item A t
10341 @kindex A t (Summary)
10342 @findex gnus-article-babel
10343 Translate the article from one language to another
10344 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
10345
10346 @end table
10347
10348
10349 @node MIME Commands
10350 @section MIME Commands
10351 @cindex MIME decoding
10352 @cindex attachments
10353 @cindex viewing attachments
10354
10355 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
10356 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
10357
10358 @table @kbd
10359 @item b
10360 @itemx K v
10361 @kindex b (Summary)
10362 @kindex K v (Summary)
10363 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
10364
10365 @item K o
10366 @kindex K o (Summary)
10367 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
10368
10369 @item K O
10370 @kindex K O (Summary)
10371 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
10372 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
10373 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10374
10375 @item K r
10376 @kindex K r (Summary)
10377 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
10378
10379 @item K d
10380 @kindex K d (Summary)
10381 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
10382 removed part.
10383
10384 @item K c
10385 @kindex K c (Summary)
10386 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
10387
10388 @item K e
10389 @kindex K e (Summary)
10390 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
10391
10392 @item K i
10393 @kindex K i (Summary)
10394 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
10395
10396 @item K |
10397 @kindex K | (Summary)
10398 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
10399 @end table
10400
10401 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
10402 the same manner:
10403
10404 @table @kbd
10405 @item K H
10406 @kindex K H (Summary)
10407 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
10408 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
10409 The message header is added to the beginning of every html part unless
10410 the prefix argument is given.
10411
10412 Warning: Spammers use links to images in HTML articles to verify whether
10413 you have read the message. As this command passes the @acronym{HTML}
10414 content to the browser without eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should
10415 only use it for mails from trusted senders.
10416
10417 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
10418 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
10419
10420 @item K b
10421 @kindex K b (Summary)
10422 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
10423 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
10424 parts.
10425
10426 @item K m
10427 @kindex K m (Summary)
10428 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
10429 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
10430 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
10431 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
10432 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
10433
10434 @item X m
10435 @kindex X m (Summary)
10436 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
10437 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
10438 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
10439 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10440
10441 @item M-t
10442 @kindex M-t (Summary)
10443 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
10444 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
10445 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
10446
10447 @item W M w
10448 @kindex W M w (Summary)
10449 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
10450 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
10451 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
10452
10453 @item W M c
10454 @kindex W M c (Summary)
10455 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
10456 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
10457 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
10458
10459 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
10460 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
10461 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
10462 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
10463 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
10464 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
10465
10466 @item W M v
10467 @kindex W M v (Summary)
10468 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
10469 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
10470 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
10471
10472 @end table
10473
10474 Relevant variables:
10475
10476 @table @code
10477 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
10478 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
10479 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10480 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
10481 @code{nil}.
10482
10483 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
10484
10485 @lisp
10486 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
10487 '("text/x-vcard"))
10488 @end lisp
10489
10490 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
10491 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
10492 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
10493 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
10494 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
10495 default is @code{t}.
10496
10497 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
10498 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
10499 @cindex uuencode
10500 @cindex yEnc
10501 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
10502 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
10503 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
10504 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
10505 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
10506 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
10507 for encoding in Gnus.
10508
10509 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10510 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10511 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10512 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10513 displayed or this variable is overridden by
10514 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
10515 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
10516 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
10517
10518 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10519 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10520 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10521 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10522 displayed. This variable overrides
10523 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
10524 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
10525 is @code{nil}.
10526
10527 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
10528 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
10529 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
10530
10531 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
10532 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
10533 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
10534 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
10535 Emacs MIME Manual}).
10536
10537 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10538 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10539 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
10540 default value is @code{nil}.
10541
10542 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
10543 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
10544 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
10545 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
10546 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
10547 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
10548 save all jpegs into some directory).
10549
10550 Here's an example function the does the latter:
10551
10552 @lisp
10553 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
10554 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
10555 (with-temp-buffer
10556 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
10557 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
10558 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
10559 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
10560 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
10561 @end lisp
10562
10563 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10564 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10565 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
10566
10567 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10568 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10569 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10570
10571 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10572 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10573 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10574
10575 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
10576 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
10577 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
10578 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
10579 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
10580
10581 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10582 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10583 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
10584 overrides @code{nil} values of
10585 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
10586 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
10587
10588 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10589 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10590 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
10591 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
10592
10593 Ready-made functions include@*
10594 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
10595 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
10596 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
10597 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
10598 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
10599 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
10600 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
10601 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
10602 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10603 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10604 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10605 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10606
10607 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
10608 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
10609
10610 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
10611 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
10612 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
10613
10614 @lisp
10615 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10616 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10617 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10618 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10619 @end lisp
10620
10621 @noindent
10622 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10623
10624 @end table
10625
10626
10627 @node Charsets
10628 @section Charsets
10629 @cindex charsets
10630
10631 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10632 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10633 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10634 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10635 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10636 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10637 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10638
10639 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10640 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10641 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10642 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10643
10644 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10645 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10646 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10647 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10648 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10649 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10650 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10651 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10652 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10653
10654 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10655 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10656 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10657 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10658 quoted-printable header encoding.
10659
10660 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10661 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10662 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10663
10664 @table @var
10665 @item test
10666 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10667 variable to query,
10668 @item header
10669 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10670 means encode all charsets),
10671 @item body-list
10672 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10673 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10674 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10675 @end table
10676
10677 @cindex Russian
10678 @cindex koi8-r
10679 @cindex koi8-u
10680 @cindex iso-8859-5
10681 @cindex coding system aliases
10682 @cindex preferred charset
10683
10684 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10685 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10686 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10687
10688 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10689
10690 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10691 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10692
10693 @lisp
10694 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10695 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10696 @end lisp
10697
10698 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10699 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10700
10701 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10702
10703 @lisp
10704 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10705 @end lisp
10706
10707 This will almost do the right thing.
10708
10709 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10710 something like
10711
10712 @lisp
10713 (codepage-setup 1251)
10714 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10715 @end lisp
10716
10717
10718 @node Article Commands
10719 @section Article Commands
10720
10721 @table @kbd
10722
10723 @item A P
10724 @cindex PostScript
10725 @cindex printing
10726 @kindex A P (Summary)
10727 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10728 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10729 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10730 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10731 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10732 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10733
10734 @end table
10735
10736
10737 @node Summary Sorting
10738 @section Summary Sorting
10739 @cindex summary sorting
10740
10741 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10742 can't really see why you'd want that.
10743
10744 @table @kbd
10745
10746 @item C-c C-s C-n
10747 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10748 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10749 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10750
10751 @item C-c C-s C-a
10752 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10753 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10754 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10755
10756 @item C-c C-s C-t
10757 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10758 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10759 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10760
10761 @item C-c C-s C-s
10762 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10763 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10764 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10765
10766 @item C-c C-s C-d
10767 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10768 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10769 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10770
10771 @item C-c C-s C-l
10772 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10773 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10774 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10775
10776 @item C-c C-s C-c
10777 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10778 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10779 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10780
10781 @item C-c C-s C-i
10782 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10783 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10784 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10785
10786 @item C-c C-s C-r
10787 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10788 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10789 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10790
10791 @item C-c C-s C-o
10792 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10793 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10794 Sort using the default sorting method
10795 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10796 @end table
10797
10798 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10799 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10800 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10801 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10802 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10803 Commands}).
10804
10805
10806 @node Finding the Parent
10807 @section Finding the Parent
10808 @cindex parent articles
10809 @cindex referring articles
10810
10811 @table @kbd
10812 @item ^
10813 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10814 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10815 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10816 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10817 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10818 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10819 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10820 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10821 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10822 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10823
10824 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10825 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10826 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10827 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10828 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10829 article.
10830
10831 @item A R (Summary)
10832 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10833 @kindex A R (Summary)
10834 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10835 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10836
10837 @item A T (Summary)
10838 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10839 @kindex A T (Summary)
10840 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10841 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10842 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10843 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10844 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10845 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10846 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10847
10848 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10849 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10850 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10851 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10852 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10853 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10854
10855 @item M-^ (Summary)
10856 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10857 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10858 @cindex Message-ID
10859 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10860 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10861 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10862 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10863 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10864 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10865
10866 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10867 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10868 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10869 @end table
10870
10871 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10872 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10873 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10874 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10875 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10876 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10877 necessary.
10878
10879 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10880 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10881 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10882 match.
10883
10884 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10885 then ask Google if that fails:
10886
10887 @lisp
10888 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10889 '(current
10890 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10891 @end lisp
10892
10893 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10894 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10895 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10896 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10897 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10898 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
10899 not support this at all.
10900
10901
10902 @node Alternative Approaches
10903 @section Alternative Approaches
10904
10905 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10906 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10907
10908 @menu
10909 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10910 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10911 @end menu
10912
10913
10914 @node Pick and Read
10915 @subsection Pick and Read
10916 @cindex pick and read
10917
10918 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10919 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10920 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10921 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10922
10923 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10924 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10925 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10926 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10927 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10928 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10929
10930 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10931
10932 @table @kbd
10933 @item .
10934 @kindex . (Pick)
10935 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10936 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10937 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10938 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10939 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10940 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10941 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10942 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10943
10944 @item SPACE
10945 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10946 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10947 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10948 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10949
10950 @item u
10951 @kindex u (Pick)
10952 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10953 Unpick the thread or article
10954 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10955 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10956 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10957 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10958 the thread or article at that line.
10959
10960 @item RET
10961 @kindex RET (Pick)
10962 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10963 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10964 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10965 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10966 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10967 will still be visible when you are reading.
10968
10969 @end table
10970
10971 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10972 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10973 which is mapped to the same function
10974 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10975
10976 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10977
10978 @lisp
10979 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10980 @end lisp
10981
10982 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10983 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10984
10985 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10986 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10987 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10988
10989 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10990 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10991 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10992 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10993 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10994 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10995 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10996
10997
10998 @node Binary Groups
10999 @subsection Binary Groups
11000 @cindex binary groups
11001
11002 @findex gnus-binary-mode
11003 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
11004 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
11005 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
11006 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
11007 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
11008 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
11009
11010 @kindex g (Binary)
11011 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
11012 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
11013 command, when you have turned on this mode
11014 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
11015
11016 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
11017 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
11018
11019
11020 @node Tree Display
11021 @section Tree Display
11022 @cindex trees
11023
11024 @vindex gnus-use-trees
11025 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
11026 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
11027 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
11028 in the tree buffer.
11029
11030 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
11031
11032 @table @code
11033 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
11034 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
11035 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
11036
11037 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11038 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11039 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
11040 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
11041 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
11042
11043 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
11044 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
11045 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
11046 default is @code{modeline}.
11047
11048 @item gnus-tree-line-format
11049 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
11050 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
11051 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
11052 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
11053 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
11054 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
11055
11056 Valid specs are:
11057
11058 @table @samp
11059 @item n
11060 The name of the poster.
11061 @item f
11062 The @code{From} header.
11063 @item N
11064 The number of the article.
11065 @item [
11066 The opening bracket.
11067 @item ]
11068 The closing bracket.
11069 @item s
11070 The subject.
11071 @end table
11072
11073 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
11074
11075 Variables related to the display are:
11076
11077 @table @code
11078 @item gnus-tree-brackets
11079 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
11080 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
11081 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
11082 @example
11083 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
11084 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
11085 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
11086 @end example
11087 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
11088
11089 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11090 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11091 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
11092 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
11093
11094 @end table
11095
11096 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
11097 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
11098 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
11099 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
11100 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
11101 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
11102 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
11103 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
11104 other windows displayed next to it.
11105
11106 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
11107 at all times:
11108
11109 @lisp
11110 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
11111 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
11112 @end lisp
11113
11114 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
11115 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
11116 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11117 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
11118 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
11119 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
11120 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
11121
11122 @end table
11123
11124 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
11125
11126 @example
11127 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
11128 | \[Jan]
11129 | \[odd]-[Eri]
11130 | \(***)-[Eri]
11131 | \[odd]-[Paa]
11132 \[Bjo]
11133 \[Gun]
11134 \[Gun]-[Jor]
11135 @end example
11136
11137 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
11138
11139 @example
11140 @group
11141 @{***@}
11142 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
11143 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
11144 |--\-----\-----\ |
11145 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
11146 | | |--\
11147 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
11148 |
11149 [Paa]
11150 @end group
11151 @end example
11152
11153 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
11154 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
11155 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11156
11157 @lisp
11158 (setq gnus-use-trees t
11159 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11160 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
11161 (gnus-add-configuration
11162 '(article
11163 (vertical 1.0
11164 (horizontal 0.25
11165 (summary 0.75 point)
11166 (tree 1.0))
11167 (article 1.0))))
11168 @end lisp
11169
11170 @xref{Window Layout}.
11171
11172
11173 @node Mail Group Commands
11174 @section Mail Group Commands
11175 @cindex mail group commands
11176
11177 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
11178 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
11179
11180 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
11181 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11182
11183 @table @kbd
11184
11185 @item B e
11186 @kindex B e (Summary)
11187 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
11188 @cindex expiring mail
11189 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
11190 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
11191 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
11192 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
11193
11194 @item B C-M-e
11195 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
11196 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
11197 @cindex expiring mail
11198 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
11199 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
11200 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
11201 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
11202
11203 @item B DEL
11204 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
11205 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
11206 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
11207 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
11208 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
11209 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
11210
11211 @item B m
11212 @kindex B m (Summary)
11213 @cindex move mail
11214 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
11215 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
11216 Move the article from one mail group to another
11217 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11218 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11219
11220 @item B c
11221 @kindex B c (Summary)
11222 @cindex copy mail
11223 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
11224 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
11225 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
11226 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11227 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11228
11229 @item B B
11230 @kindex B B (Summary)
11231 @cindex crosspost mail
11232 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
11233 Crosspost the current article to some other group
11234 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
11235 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
11236 be properly updated.
11237
11238 @item B i
11239 @kindex B i (Summary)
11240 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
11241 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
11242 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
11243 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11244
11245 @item B I
11246 @kindex B I (Summary)
11247 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
11248 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
11249 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
11250 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11251
11252 @item B r
11253 @kindex B r (Summary)
11254 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
11255 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
11256 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
11257 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
11258 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
11259 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
11260 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
11261 (which is the default).
11262
11263 @item B w
11264 @itemx e
11265 @kindex B w (Summary)
11266 @kindex e (Summary)
11267 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
11268 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
11269 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
11270 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
11271 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
11272 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
11273 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
11274
11275 @item B q
11276 @kindex B q (Summary)
11277 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
11278 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
11279 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
11280 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
11281
11282 @item B t
11283 @kindex B t (Summary)
11284 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
11285 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
11286 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
11287
11288 @item B p
11289 @kindex B p (Summary)
11290 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
11291 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
11292 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
11293 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
11294 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
11295 article from your news server (or rather, from
11296 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
11297 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
11298 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
11299 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
11300 just not have arrived yet.
11301
11302 @item K E
11303 @kindex K E (Summary)
11304 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
11305 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
11306 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
11307 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
11308 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
11309
11310 @end table
11311
11312 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
11313 @cindex moving articles
11314 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
11315 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
11316 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
11317 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
11318 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
11319 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
11320 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
11321
11322 @lisp
11323 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
11324 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
11325 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
11326 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
11327 @end lisp
11328
11329
11330 @node Various Summary Stuff
11331 @section Various Summary Stuff
11332
11333 @menu
11334 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
11335 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
11336 * Summary Generation Commands::
11337 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
11338 @end menu
11339
11340 @table @code
11341 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
11342 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
11343 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
11344 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
11345 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
11346 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
11347
11348 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
11349 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
11350 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
11351 current article.
11352
11353 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
11354 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
11355 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
11356
11357 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
11358 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
11359 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
11360 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
11361 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
11362 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
11363 have been set.
11364
11365 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11366 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11367 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
11368 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
11369 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
11370
11371 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11372 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11373 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
11374 generated.
11375
11376 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11377 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11378 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
11379 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
11380 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
11381 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
11382 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
11383 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
11384 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
11385 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
11386
11387 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11388 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11389 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
11390 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
11391 list of articles to be selected.
11392
11393 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
11394 the list in one particular group:
11395
11396 @lisp
11397 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
11398 (if (string= group "some.group")
11399 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
11400 articles))
11401 @end lisp
11402
11403 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
11404 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
11405 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
11406 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
11407 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
11408 buffer is active.
11409
11410 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
11411 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
11412 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
11413 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
11414 variable will be used instead.
11415
11416 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
11417 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
11418 buffers. For example:
11419
11420 @lisp
11421 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
11422 '(message-use-followup-to
11423 (gnus-visible-headers .
11424 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
11425 @end lisp
11426
11427 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
11428
11429 @vindex gnus-propagate-marks
11430 @item gnus-propagate-marks
11431 If non-@code{nil}, propagate marks to the backends for possible
11432 storing. @xref{NNTP marks}, and friends, for a more fine-grained
11433 sieve.
11434
11435 @end table
11436
11437
11438 @node Summary Group Information
11439 @subsection Summary Group Information
11440
11441 @table @kbd
11442
11443 @item H f
11444 @kindex H f (Summary)
11445 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
11446 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
11447 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
11448 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
11449 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
11450 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
11451 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
11452 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
11453 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
11454
11455 @item H d
11456 @kindex H d (Summary)
11457 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
11458 Give a brief description of the current group
11459 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
11460 rereading the description from the server.
11461
11462 @item H h
11463 @kindex H h (Summary)
11464 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
11465 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
11466 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
11467
11468 @item H i
11469 @kindex H i (Summary)
11470 @findex gnus-info-find-node
11471 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
11472 @end table
11473
11474
11475 @node Searching for Articles
11476 @subsection Searching for Articles
11477
11478 @table @kbd
11479
11480 @item M-s
11481 @kindex M-s (Summary)
11482 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
11483 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
11484 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
11485
11486 @item M-r
11487 @kindex M-r (Summary)
11488 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
11489 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
11490 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
11491
11492 @item M-S
11493 @kindex M-S (Summary)
11494 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
11495 Repeat the previous search forwards
11496 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
11497
11498 @item M-R
11499 @kindex M-R (Summary)
11500 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
11501 Repeat the previous search backwards
11502 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
11503
11504 @item &
11505 @kindex & (Summary)
11506 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
11507 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
11508 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
11509 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
11510 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
11511 search backward instead.
11512
11513 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
11514 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
11515
11516 @item M-&
11517 @kindex M-& (Summary)
11518 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
11519 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
11520 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
11521 @end table
11522
11523 @node Summary Generation Commands
11524 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
11525
11526 @table @kbd
11527
11528 @item Y g
11529 @kindex Y g (Summary)
11530 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
11531 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
11532
11533 @item Y c
11534 @kindex Y c (Summary)
11535 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
11536 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11537 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
11538
11539 @item Y d
11540 @kindex Y d (Summary)
11541 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
11542 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11543 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
11544
11545 @item Y t
11546 @kindex Y t (Summary)
11547 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
11548 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11549 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
11550
11551 @end table
11552
11553
11554 @node Really Various Summary Commands
11555 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
11556
11557 @table @kbd
11558
11559 @item A D
11560 @itemx C-d
11561 @kindex C-d (Summary)
11562 @kindex A D (Summary)
11563 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
11564 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
11565 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
11566 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
11567 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
11568 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
11569 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
11570 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
11571 fashion.
11572
11573 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
11574 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
11575 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
11576 include:
11577
11578 @table @code
11579 @item next
11580 Select the next article.
11581
11582 @item next-unread
11583 Select the next unread article.
11584
11585 @item next-noselect
11586 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
11587
11588 @item next-unread-noselect
11589 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
11590 @end table
11591
11592 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
11593 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
11594
11595 @item C-M-d
11596 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
11597 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
11598 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
11599 several documents into one biiig group
11600 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
11601 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
11602 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
11603 command understands the process/prefix convention
11604 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11605
11606 @item C-t
11607 @kindex C-t (Summary)
11608 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11609 Toggle truncation of summary lines
11610 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11611 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11612 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11613
11614 @item =
11615 @kindex = (Summary)
11616 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11617 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11618 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11619
11620 @item C-M-e
11621 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11622 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11623 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11624 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11625
11626 @item C-M-a
11627 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11628 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11629 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11630 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11631
11632 @end table
11633
11634
11635 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11636 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11637 @cindex summary exit
11638 @cindex exiting groups
11639
11640 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11641 group and return you to the group buffer.
11642
11643 @table @kbd
11644
11645 @item Z Z
11646 @itemx Z Q
11647 @itemx q
11648 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11649 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11650 @kindex q (Summary)
11651 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11652 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11653 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11654 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11655 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11656 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11657 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11658 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11659 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11660 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11661 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11662 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11663
11664 @item Z E
11665 @itemx Q
11666 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11667 @kindex Q (Summary)
11668 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11669 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11670 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11671
11672 @item Z c
11673 @itemx c
11674 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11675 @kindex c (Summary)
11676 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11677 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11678 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11679 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11680
11681 @item Z C
11682 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11683 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11684 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11685 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11686
11687 @item Z n
11688 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11689 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11690 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11691 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11692
11693 @item Z p
11694 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11695 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11696 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11697 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11698
11699 @item Z R
11700 @itemx C-x C-s
11701 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11702 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11703 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11704 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11705 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11706 all articles, both read and unread.
11707
11708 @item Z G
11709 @itemx M-g
11710 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11711 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11712 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11713 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11714 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11715 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11716 articles, both read and unread.
11717
11718 @item Z N
11719 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11720 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11721 Exit the group and go to the next group
11722 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11723
11724 @item Z P
11725 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11726 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11727 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11728 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11729
11730 @item Z s
11731 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11732 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11733 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11734 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11735 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11736 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11737 @end table
11738
11739 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11740 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11741 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11742 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11743
11744 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11745 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11746 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11747 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11748 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11749 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11750 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11751 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11752 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11753 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11754 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11755 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11756
11757 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11758
11759 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11760 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11761 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11762 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11763 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11764 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11765 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11766 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11767 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11768
11769
11770 @node Crosspost Handling
11771 @section Crosspost Handling
11772
11773 @cindex velveeta
11774 @cindex spamming
11775 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11776 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11777 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11778 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11779 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11780 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
11781 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
11782
11783 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11784 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11785 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11786 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11787 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11788
11789 @cindex cross-posting
11790 @cindex Xref
11791 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11792 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11793 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11794 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11795 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11796 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11797 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11798 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11799 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11800 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11801 the cross reference mechanism.
11802
11803 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11804 @cindex overview.fmt
11805 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11806 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11807 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11808 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11809 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11810 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11811 overview files.
11812
11813 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11814 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11815 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11816
11817 C'est la vie.
11818
11819 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11820
11821
11822 @node Duplicate Suppression
11823 @section Duplicate Suppression
11824
11825 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11826 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11827 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11828 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11829 reasons.
11830
11831 @enumerate
11832 @item
11833 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11834 is evil and not very common.
11835
11836 @item
11837 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11838 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11839
11840 @item
11841 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11842 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11843
11844 @item
11845 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11846 @end enumerate
11847
11848 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11849 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11850
11851 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11852 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11853 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11854 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11855 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11856 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11857 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11858 once.
11859
11860 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11861 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11862 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11863 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11864 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11865 saw the article in.
11866
11867 @table @code
11868 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11869 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11870 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11871
11872 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11873 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11874 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11875 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11876 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11877 session are suppressed.
11878
11879 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11880 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11881 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11882 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11883
11884 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11885 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11886 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11887 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11888 @end table
11889
11890 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11891 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11892 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11893 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11894 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11895 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11896 to you to figure out, I think.
11897
11898 @node Security
11899 @section Security
11900
11901 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11902 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11903 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11904 things to work:
11905
11906 @enumerate
11907 @item
11908 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11909 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
11910 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
11911 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
11912
11913 @item
11914 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11915 or newer is recommended.
11916
11917 @end enumerate
11918
11919 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
11920 include:
11921
11922 @table @code
11923 @item mm-verify-option
11924 @vindex mm-verify-option
11925 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11926 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11927 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11928
11929 @item mm-decrypt-option
11930 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11931 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11932 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11933 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11934
11935 @item mml1991-use
11936 @vindex mml1991-use
11937 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11938 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
11939 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
11940 deprecated.
11941
11942 @item mml2015-use
11943 @vindex mml2015-use
11944 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11945 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
11946 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
11947 deprecated.
11948
11949 @end table
11950
11951 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11952 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11953 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11954 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11955 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11956 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11957 how to customize these variables to always display security
11958 information.
11959
11960 @cindex snarfing keys
11961 @cindex importing PGP keys
11962 @cindex PGP key ring import
11963 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11964 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11965 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11966 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11967 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11968 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11969 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11970 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11971 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11972
11973 @example
11974 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11975 @end example
11976 @noindent
11977 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11978 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11979
11980 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11981 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11982 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11983
11984 @node Mailing List
11985 @section Mailing List
11986 @cindex mailing list
11987 @cindex RFC 2396
11988
11989 @kindex A M (summary)
11990 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11991 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11992 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11993 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11994 summary buffer.
11995
11996 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11997
11998 @table @kbd
11999
12000 @item C-c C-n h
12001 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
12002 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
12003 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
12004
12005 @item C-c C-n s
12006 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
12007 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
12008 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
12009
12010 @item C-c C-n u
12011 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
12012 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
12013 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
12014 field exists.
12015
12016 @item C-c C-n p
12017 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
12018 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
12019 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
12020
12021 @item C-c C-n o
12022 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
12023 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
12024 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
12025
12026 @item C-c C-n a
12027 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
12028 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
12029 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
12030
12031 @end table
12032
12033
12034 @node Article Buffer
12035 @chapter Article Buffer
12036 @cindex article buffer
12037
12038 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
12039 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
12040 tell Gnus otherwise.
12041
12042 @menu
12043 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
12044 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
12045 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
12046 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
12047 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
12048 @end menu
12049
12050
12051 @node Hiding Headers
12052 @section Hiding Headers
12053 @cindex hiding headers
12054 @cindex deleting headers
12055
12056 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
12057 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
12058
12059 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
12060 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
12061 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
12062 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
12063 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
12064 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
12065 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
12066 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
12067 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
12068
12069 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
12070
12071 @table @code
12072
12073 @item gnus-visible-headers
12074 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
12075 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
12076 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
12077 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
12078
12079 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
12080 the article and the subject, you'd say:
12081
12082 @lisp
12083 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
12084 @end lisp
12085
12086 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12087 remain visible.
12088
12089 @item gnus-ignored-headers
12090 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
12091 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
12092 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
12093 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
12094 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
12095
12096 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
12097 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
12098
12099 @lisp
12100 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
12101 @end lisp
12102
12103 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12104 be removed.
12105
12106 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
12107 variable will have no effect.
12108
12109 @end table
12110
12111 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
12112 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
12113 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
12114 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
12115 the headers are to be displayed.
12116
12117 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
12118 and then the subject, you might say something like:
12119
12120 @lisp
12121 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
12122 @end lisp
12123
12124 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
12125 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
12126
12127 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
12128 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
12129 You can hide further boring headers by setting
12130 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
12131 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
12132 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
12133 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
12134 from sight.
12135
12136 These conditions are:
12137 @table @code
12138 @item empty
12139 Remove all empty headers.
12140 @item followup-to
12141 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
12142 @code{Newsgroups} header.
12143 @item reply-to
12144 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
12145 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
12146 parameter is set.
12147 @item newsgroups
12148 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
12149 name.
12150 @item to-address
12151 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12152 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
12153 @item to-list
12154 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12155 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12156 @item cc-list
12157 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
12158 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12159 @item date
12160 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
12161 old.
12162 @item long-to
12163 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
12164 @item many-to
12165 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
12166 @end table
12167
12168 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
12169
12170 @lisp
12171 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
12172 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
12173 @end lisp
12174
12175 This is also the default value for this variable.
12176
12177
12178 @node Using MIME
12179 @section Using MIME
12180 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12181
12182 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
12183 while people stand around yawning.
12184
12185 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
12186 while all newsreaders die of fear.
12187
12188 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
12189 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
12190 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
12191
12192 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
12193 @findex gnus-display-mime
12194 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
12195 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
12196 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
12197 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
12198
12199 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
12200 @acronym{MIME} button:
12201
12202 @table @kbd
12203 @findex gnus-article-press-button
12204 @item RET (Article)
12205 @kindex RET (Article)
12206 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
12207 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
12208 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
12209 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
12210 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
12211 object is displayed inline.
12212
12213 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
12214 @item M-RET (Article)
12215 @kindex M-RET (Article)
12216 @itemx v (Article)
12217 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12218 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
12219
12220 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
12221 @item t (Article)
12222 @kindex t (Article)
12223 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
12224 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
12225
12226 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
12227 @item C (Article)
12228 @kindex C (Article)
12229 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12230 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
12231
12232 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
12233 @item o (Article)
12234 @kindex o (Article)
12235 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
12236 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
12237
12238 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
12239 @item C-o (Article)
12240 @kindex C-o (Article)
12241 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
12242 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
12243 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
12244 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
12245 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
12246 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
12247
12248 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
12249 @item r (Article)
12250 @kindex r (Article)
12251 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
12252 external body refering to the file via the message/external-body
12253 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
12254
12255 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
12256 @item d (Article)
12257 @kindex d (Article)
12258 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
12259 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
12260 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
12261
12262 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
12263
12264 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
12265 @item c (Article)
12266 @kindex c (Article)
12267 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
12268 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
12269 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
12270 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
12271 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
12272 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
12273 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
12274 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
12275
12276 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
12277 @item p (Article)
12278 @kindex p (Article)
12279 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
12280 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
12281 @file{.mailcap} file.
12282
12283 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
12284 @item i (Article)
12285 @kindex i (Article)
12286 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
12287 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
12288 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
12289 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
12290 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
12291 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
12292 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
12293 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
12294 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
12295
12296 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
12297 @item E (Article)
12298 @kindex E (Article)
12299 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
12300 viewer is available, use an external viewer
12301 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
12302
12303 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
12304 @item e (Article)
12305 @kindex e (Article)
12306 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
12307 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
12308
12309 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
12310 @item | (Article)
12311 @kindex | (Article)
12312 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
12313
12314 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
12315 @item . (Article)
12316 @kindex . (Article)
12317 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
12318 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
12319
12320 @end table
12321
12322 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
12323 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
12324 @acronym{MIME} manual.
12325
12326 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
12327 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
12328 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
12329 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
12330 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
12331 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
12332 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
12333 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
12334 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
12335
12336 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
12337
12338 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
12339
12340
12341 @node Customizing Articles
12342 @section Customizing Articles
12343 @cindex article customization
12344
12345 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
12346 exist. You can call these functions interactively
12347 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
12348 called automatically when you select the articles.
12349
12350 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
12351 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
12352 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
12353 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
12354
12355 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
12356 for sensible values.
12357
12358 @enumerate
12359 @item
12360 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
12361
12362 @item
12363 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
12364
12365 @item
12366 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
12367
12368 @item
12369 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
12370
12371 @item
12372 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
12373
12374 @item
12375 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
12376 than this number.
12377
12378 @item
12379 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
12380 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
12381 regexps in the list.
12382
12383 @item
12384 A list where the first element is not a string:
12385
12386 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
12387 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
12388 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
12389
12390 @lisp
12391 (or last
12392 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
12393 @end lisp
12394
12395 @end enumerate
12396
12397 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
12398 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
12399 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
12400 considered to contain just a single part.
12401
12402 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
12403 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
12404 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
12405 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
12406 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
12407 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
12408 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
12409
12410 @ifinfo
12411 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
12412 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
12413 @c `i foo-bar'.
12414 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
12415 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
12416 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
12417 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
12418 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
12419 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
12420 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
12421 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
12422 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
12423 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
12424 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
12425 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
12426 @vindex gnus-treat-date-english
12427 @vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
12428 @vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
12429 @vindex gnus-treat-date-local
12430 @vindex gnus-treat-date-original
12431 @vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
12432 @vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
12433 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
12434 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
12435 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
12436 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
12437 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
12438 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12439 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12440 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12441 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12442 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12443 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12444 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12445 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12446 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12447 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12448 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12449 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12450 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12451 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12452 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12453 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12454 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
12455 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12456 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12457 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12458 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12459 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12460 @end ifinfo
12461
12462 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
12463 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
12464 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
12465 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
12466
12467 @table @code
12468 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
12469 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
12470
12471 @xref{Article Buttons}.
12472
12473 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
12474 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
12475 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
12476 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
12477 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
12478 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
12479 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
12480 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
12481 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
12482 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
12483
12484 @xref{Article Washing}.
12485
12486 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
12487 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
12488 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
12489 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
12490 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
12491 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
12492 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
12493
12494 @xref{Article Date}.
12495
12496 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
12497 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
12498 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12499
12500 @xref{Picons}.
12501
12502 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12503
12504 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12505
12506 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12507 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12508 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12509
12510 @xref{Smileys}.
12511
12512 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12513 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12514
12515 @xref{X-Face}.
12516
12517 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12518 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12519
12520 @xref{Face}.
12521
12522 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12523 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12524 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12525 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12526 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12527 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12528 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12529 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12530 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12531 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12532 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12533 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12534 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12535 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12536 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12537 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12538 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12539 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12540 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12541 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12542
12543 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12544
12545 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12546 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12547 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12548 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12549 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12550 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12551
12552 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12553
12554 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12555 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12556 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
12557 @item gnus-treat-translate
12558 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12559 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12560 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12561
12562 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12563 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12564 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12565 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12566 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12567 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12568 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12569 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12570
12571 @xref{Article Header}.
12572
12573
12574 @end table
12575
12576 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12577 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12578 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12579 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12580 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12581 everything.
12582
12583
12584 @node Article Keymap
12585 @section Article Keymap
12586
12587 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12588 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12589 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12590 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12591 buffer.
12592
12593 @kindex v (Article)
12594 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12595 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12596 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12597
12598 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12599
12600 @table @kbd
12601
12602 @item SPACE
12603 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12604 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12605 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12606 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12607
12608 @item DEL
12609 @kindex DEL (Article)
12610 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12611 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12612 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12613
12614 @item C-c ^
12615 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12616 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12617 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12618 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12619 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12620
12621 @item C-c C-m
12622 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12623 @findex gnus-article-mail
12624 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12625 given a prefix, include the mail.
12626
12627 @item s
12628 @kindex s (Article)
12629 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12630 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12631 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12632
12633 @item ?
12634 @kindex ? (Article)
12635 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12636 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12637 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12638
12639 @item TAB
12640 @kindex TAB (Article)
12641 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12642 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12643 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12644
12645 @item M-TAB
12646 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12647 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12648 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12649
12650 @item R
12651 @kindex R (Article)
12652 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12653 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12654 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12655 only yank the text in the region.
12656
12657 @item S W
12658 @kindex S W (Article)
12659 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12660 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12661 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12662 active, only yank the text in the region.
12663
12664 @item F
12665 @kindex F (Article)
12666 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12667 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12668 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12669 only yank the text in the region.
12670
12671
12672 @end table
12673
12674
12675 @node Misc Article
12676 @section Misc Article
12677
12678 @table @code
12679
12680 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12681 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12682 @cindex article buffers, several
12683 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12684 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12685 article buffer.
12686
12687 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12688 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12689 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12690 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12691 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12692
12693 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12694 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12695 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12696 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12697 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12698 the contents of the article buffer.
12699
12700 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12701 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12702 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12703
12704 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12705 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12706 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12707 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12708
12709 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12710 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12711 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12712 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12713
12714 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12715 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12716 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12717 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12718 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12719 with two extensions:
12720
12721 @table @samp
12722
12723 @item w
12724 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12725 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12726 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12727
12728 @table @samp
12729
12730 @item c
12731 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12732
12733 @item h
12734 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12735
12736 @item p
12737 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12738 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12739 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
12740
12741 @item s
12742 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12743
12744 @item o
12745 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12746
12747 @item e
12748 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
12749
12750 @end table
12751
12752 @item m
12753 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12754
12755 @end table
12756
12757 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12758
12759 @item gnus-break-pages
12760 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12761 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12762 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12763 paging will not be done.
12764
12765 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12766 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12767 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12768 (formfeed).
12769
12770 @cindex IDNA
12771 @cindex internationalized domain names
12772 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12773 @item gnus-use-idna
12774 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12775 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12776 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12777 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12778 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12779 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12780
12781 @end table
12782
12783
12784 @node Composing Messages
12785 @chapter Composing Messages
12786 @cindex composing messages
12787 @cindex messages
12788 @cindex mail
12789 @cindex sending mail
12790 @cindex reply
12791 @cindex followup
12792 @cindex post
12793 @cindex using gpg
12794 @cindex using s/mime
12795 @cindex using smime
12796
12797 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12798 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12799 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12800 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12801 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12802 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12803
12804 @menu
12805 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12806 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12807 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12808 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12809 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12810 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12811 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12812 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12813 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12814 @end menu
12815
12816 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12817 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12818
12819
12820 @node Mail
12821 @section Mail
12822
12823 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12824
12825 @table @code
12826 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12827 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12828 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12829 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12830 @code{nil} include all headers.
12831
12832 @item gnus-add-to-list
12833 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12834 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12835 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12836
12837 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12838 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12839 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12840 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12841 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12842 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12843 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12844 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12845
12846 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12847 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12848
12849 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12850 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12851 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12852 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12853 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12854
12855 @end table
12856
12857
12858 @node Posting Server
12859 @section Posting Server
12860
12861 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12862 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12863
12864 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12865
12866 It can be quite complicated.
12867
12868 @vindex gnus-post-method
12869 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12870 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12871 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12872 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12873 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12874 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12875 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12876 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12877 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12878
12879 @lisp
12880 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12881 @end lisp
12882
12883 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12884 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12885 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12886 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12887
12888 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12889 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12890
12891 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12892 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12893 for posting.
12894
12895 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12896 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12897
12898 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12899 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12900 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12901 value suitable for your system.
12902 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12903 information.
12904
12905 @node POP before SMTP
12906 @section POP before SMTP
12907 @cindex pop before smtp
12908 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
12909 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12910
12911 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12912 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
12913 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
12914 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
12915 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12916
12917 @lisp
12918 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
12919 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12920 @end lisp
12921
12922 @noindent
12923 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
12924 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
12925 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
12926 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
12927 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
12928 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
12929 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
12930 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12931
12932 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12933 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12934 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12935 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12936 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12937 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12938
12939 @lisp
12940 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12941 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12942 :password "secret"))
12943 @end lisp
12944
12945 @noindent
12946 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12947 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12948
12949 @lisp
12950 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12951 (lambda ()
12952 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12953 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12954 :password "secret")))
12955 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12956 @end lisp
12957
12958 @node Mail and Post
12959 @section Mail and Post
12960
12961 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12962 posting:
12963
12964 @table @code
12965 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12966 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12967 @cindex mailing lists
12968
12969 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12970 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12971 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12972 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12973 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12974 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12975 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12976 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12977 still a pain, though.
12978
12979 @item gnus-user-agent
12980 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12981 @cindex User-Agent
12982
12983 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12984 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12985 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12986 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12987 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12988 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12989 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12990
12991 @end table
12992
12993 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12994 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12995 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12996
12997 @cindex ispell
12998 @findex ispell-message
12999 @lisp
13000 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
13001 @end lisp
13002
13003 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
13004 you're in, you could say something like the following:
13005
13006 @lisp
13007 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
13008 (lambda ()
13009 (cond
13010 ((string-match
13011 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
13012 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
13013 (t
13014 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
13015 @end lisp
13016
13017 Modify to suit your needs.
13018
13019 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
13020 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
13021 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
13022 mode buffers.
13023
13024 @node Archived Messages
13025 @section Archived Messages
13026 @cindex archived messages
13027 @cindex sent messages
13028
13029 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
13030 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
13031 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
13032 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
13033 is the default.
13034
13035 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
13036 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
13037 Group Commands}).
13038
13039 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
13040 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
13041 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
13042 actually being used it is expanded into:
13043
13044 @lisp
13045 (nnfolder "archive"
13046 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
13047 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
13048 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
13049 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
13050 @end lisp
13051
13052 @quotation
13053 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
13054 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
13055 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
13056 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
13057 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
13058 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
13059 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13060 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
13061 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
13062 saved method to reflect always the value of
13063 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
13064 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
13065 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
13066 @end quotation
13067
13068 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
13069 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
13070 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
13071 directory chosen, you could say something like:
13072
13073 @lisp
13074 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
13075 '(nnfolder "archive"
13076 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
13077 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
13078 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
13079 @end lisp
13080
13081 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
13082 @cindex Gcc
13083 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
13084 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
13085 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
13086
13087 This variable can be used to do the following:
13088
13089 @table @asis
13090 @item a string
13091 Messages will be saved in that group.
13092
13093 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
13094 message will not be stored in the select method given by
13095 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
13096 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13097 has the default value shown above. Then setting
13098 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
13099 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
13100 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
13101 @samp{nnml:foo}.
13102
13103 @item a list of strings
13104 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
13105
13106 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
13107 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
13108
13109 @item @code{nil}
13110 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
13111 @end table
13112
13113 Let's illustrate:
13114
13115 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
13116 @lisp
13117 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
13118 @end lisp
13119
13120 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
13121 @lisp
13122 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
13123 @end lisp
13124
13125 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
13126 @lisp
13127 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
13128 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
13129 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
13130 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
13131 @end lisp
13132
13133 More complex stuff:
13134 @lisp
13135 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
13136 '((if (message-news-p)
13137 "misc-news"
13138 "misc-mail")))
13139 @end lisp
13140
13141 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
13142 messages in one file per month:
13143
13144 @lisp
13145 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
13146 '((if (message-news-p)
13147 "misc-news"
13148 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
13149 @end lisp
13150
13151 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
13152 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
13153
13154 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
13155 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
13156 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
13157 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
13158 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
13159 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
13160 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
13161 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
13162 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
13163 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
13164
13165 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
13166 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
13167 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
13168 this will disable archiving.
13169
13170 @table @code
13171 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
13172 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
13173 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
13174 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
13175 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
13176 group names.
13177
13178 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
13179 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
13180 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
13181 of names).
13182
13183 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
13184 but the latter is the preferred method.
13185
13186 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13187 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13188 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
13189
13190 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13191 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13192 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
13193 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
13194 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
13195 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
13196 changed in the future.
13197
13198 @end table
13199
13200
13201 @node Posting Styles
13202 @section Posting Styles
13203 @cindex posting styles
13204 @cindex styles
13205
13206 All them variables, they make my head swim.
13207
13208 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
13209 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
13210 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
13211 on?
13212
13213 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
13214 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
13215 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
13216 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
13217 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
13218 variable:
13219
13220 @lisp
13221 ((".*"
13222 (signature "Peace and happiness")
13223 (organization "What me?"))
13224 ("^comp"
13225 (signature "Death to everybody"))
13226 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
13227 (organization "Emacs is it")))
13228 @end lisp
13229
13230 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
13231 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
13232 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
13233 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
13234 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
13235 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
13236 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
13237 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
13238
13239 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
13240 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
13241 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
13242 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
13243 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
13244 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
13245 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
13246 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
13247 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
13248 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
13249 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
13250 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
13251 said to @dfn{match}.
13252
13253 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
13254 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
13255 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
13256 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
13257 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
13258 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
13259 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
13260 name can be one of:
13261
13262 @itemize @bullet
13263 @item @code{signature}
13264 @item @code{signature-file}
13265 @item @code{x-face-file}
13266 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
13267 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
13268 @item @code{body}
13269 @end itemize
13270
13271 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
13272 @code{message-signature-directory}.
13273
13274 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
13275 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
13276 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
13277 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
13278 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
13279
13280 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
13281 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
13282 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
13283 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
13284 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
13285 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
13286 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
13287 references chars lines xref extra.
13288
13289 @vindex message-reply-headers
13290
13291 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
13292 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
13293 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
13294
13295 @findex message-mail-p
13296 @findex message-news-p
13297
13298 So here's a new example:
13299
13300 @lisp
13301 (setq gnus-posting-styles
13302 '((".*"
13303 (signature-file "~/.signature")
13304 (name "User Name")
13305 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
13306 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
13307 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
13308 ("^rec.humor"
13309 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
13310 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
13311 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
13312 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
13313 (signature my-news-signature))
13314 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
13315 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
13316 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
13317 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
13318 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
13319 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
13320 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
13321 (address "user@@bar.foo")
13322 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
13323 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
13324 ("nnml:.*"
13325 (From (save-excursion
13326 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
13327 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
13328 ("^nn.+:"
13329 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
13330 @end lisp
13331
13332 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
13333 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
13334 if you fill many roles.
13335 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
13336 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
13337
13338 @node Drafts
13339 @section Drafts
13340 @cindex drafts
13341
13342 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
13343 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
13344 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
13345 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
13346 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
13347
13348 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
13349 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
13350 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
13351 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
13352 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
13353 group.)
13354
13355 @cindex nndraft
13356 @vindex nndraft-directory
13357 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
13358 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
13359 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
13360 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
13361 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
13362 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
13363
13364 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
13365 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
13366 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
13367 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
13368 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
13369 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
13370 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
13371 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
13372 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
13373
13374 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
13375 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
13376 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
13377 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
13378 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
13379 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
13380 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
13381 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
13382 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
13383 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
13384 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
13385 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
13386 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
13387 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
13388 @c
13389 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
13390 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
13391 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
13392
13393 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
13394 @kindex D e (Draft)
13395 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
13396 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
13397 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
13398
13399 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
13400 Articles}).
13401
13402 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
13403 @kindex D s (Draft)
13404 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
13405 @kindex D S (Draft)
13406 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
13407 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
13408 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
13409 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
13410 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
13411 in the buffer.
13412
13413 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
13414 @kindex D t (Draft)
13415 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
13416 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
13417 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
13418
13419
13420 @node Rejected Articles
13421 @section Rejected Articles
13422 @cindex rejected articles
13423
13424 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
13425 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
13426 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
13427 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
13428
13429 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
13430 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
13431 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
13432 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
13433 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
13434
13435 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
13436 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
13437 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
13438
13439 @node Signing and encrypting
13440 @section Signing and encrypting
13441 @cindex using gpg
13442 @cindex using s/mime
13443 @cindex using smime
13444
13445 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
13446 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
13447 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
13448 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
13449
13450 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
13451 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
13452 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
13453 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
13454 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
13455 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
13456 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
13457 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
13458 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
13459 automatically encrypted messages.
13460
13461 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
13462 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
13463 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
13464
13465 @table @kbd
13466
13467 @item C-c C-m s s
13468 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13469 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13470
13471 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13472
13473 @item C-c C-m s o
13474 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13475 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13476
13477 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13478
13479 @item C-c C-m s p
13480 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13481 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13482
13483 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13484
13485 @item C-c C-m c s
13486 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13487 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13488
13489 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13490
13491 @item C-c C-m c o
13492 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13493 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13494
13495 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13496
13497 @item C-c C-m c p
13498 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13499 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13500
13501 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13502
13503 @item C-c C-m C-n
13504 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13505 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13506 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13507
13508 @end table
13509
13510 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13511
13512 @node Select Methods
13513 @chapter Select Methods
13514 @cindex foreign groups
13515 @cindex select methods
13516
13517 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13518 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13519 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13520 personal mail group.
13521
13522 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13523 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13524 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
13525 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13526 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13527 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13528
13529 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13530 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13531
13532 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13533 group as.
13534
13535 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13536 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13537 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13538 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13539 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13540
13541 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13542
13543 @menu
13544 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13545 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13546 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13547 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13548 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
13549 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
13550 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13551 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13552 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13553 @end menu
13554
13555
13556 @node Server Buffer
13557 @section Server Buffer
13558
13559 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13560 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13561 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13562 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13563 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13564 back end represents a virtual server.
13565
13566 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13567 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13568 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13569 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13570
13571 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13572 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13573 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13574 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13575 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13576 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13577 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13578
13579 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13580 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13581
13582 @menu
13583 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13584 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13585 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13586 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13587 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13588 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13589 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13590 @end menu
13591
13592 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13593 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13594
13595
13596 @node Server Buffer Format
13597 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13598 @cindex server buffer format
13599
13600 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13601 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13602 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13603 variable, with some simple extensions:
13604
13605 @table @samp
13606
13607 @item h
13608 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13609
13610 @item n
13611 The name of this server.
13612
13613 @item w
13614 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13615
13616 @item s
13617 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13618
13619 @item a
13620 Whether this server is agentized.
13621 @end table
13622
13623 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13624 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13625 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13626 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13627
13628 @table @samp
13629 @item S
13630 Server name.
13631
13632 @item M
13633 Server method.
13634 @end table
13635
13636 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13637
13638
13639 @node Server Commands
13640 @subsection Server Commands
13641 @cindex server commands
13642
13643 @table @kbd
13644
13645 @item v
13646 @kindex v (Server)
13647 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13648 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13649 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13650
13651 @item a
13652 @kindex a (Server)
13653 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13654 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13655
13656 @item e
13657 @kindex e (Server)
13658 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13659 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13660
13661 @item SPACE
13662 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13663 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13664 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13665
13666 @item q
13667 @kindex q (Server)
13668 @findex gnus-server-exit
13669 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13670
13671 @item k
13672 @kindex k (Server)
13673 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13674 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13675
13676 @item y
13677 @kindex y (Server)
13678 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13679 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13680
13681 @item c
13682 @kindex c (Server)
13683 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13684 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13685
13686 @item l
13687 @kindex l (Server)
13688 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13689 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13690
13691 @item s
13692 @kindex s (Server)
13693 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13694 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13695 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13696 servers.
13697
13698 @item g
13699 @kindex g (Server)
13700 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13701 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13702 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13703 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13704
13705 @item z
13706 @kindex z (Server)
13707 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13708
13709 Compact all groups in the server under point
13710 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13711 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13712 hence getting a correct total article count.
13713
13714 @end table
13715
13716
13717 @node Example Methods
13718 @subsection Example Methods
13719
13720 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13721
13722 @lisp
13723 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13724 @end lisp
13725
13726 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13727
13728 @lisp
13729 (nnspool "")
13730 @end lisp
13731
13732 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13733 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13734 will.
13735
13736 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13737 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13738
13739 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13740 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13741 look like then:
13742
13743 @lisp
13744 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13745 @end lisp
13746
13747 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13748 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13749
13750 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13751 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13752 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13753 your private mail:
13754
13755 @lisp
13756 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13757 @end lisp
13758
13759 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13760 that.)
13761
13762 Here's the method for a public spool:
13763
13764 @lisp
13765 (nnmh "public"
13766 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13767 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13768 @end lisp
13769
13770 @cindex proxy
13771 @cindex firewall
13772
13773 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13774 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13775 on the firewall machine and connect with
13776 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13777 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13778 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13779 should probably look something like this:
13780
13781 @lisp
13782 (nntp "firewall"
13783 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13784 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13785 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13786 @end lisp
13787
13788 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13789 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13790 configuration to the example above:
13791
13792 @lisp
13793 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13794 @end lisp
13795
13796 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13797 an indirect connection:
13798
13799 @lisp
13800 (setq gnus-select-method
13801 '(nntp "indirect"
13802 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13803 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13804 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13805 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13806 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13807 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13808 @end lisp
13809
13810 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13811 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13812
13813 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13814 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13815 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13816
13817 @lisp
13818 (nntp "outside"
13819 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13820 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13821 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13822 @end lisp
13823
13824
13825 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13826 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13827
13828 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13829 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13830
13831 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13832 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13833 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13834
13835 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13836
13837 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13838 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13839 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13840 will contain the following:
13841
13842 @lisp
13843 (nnml "cache")
13844 @end lisp
13845
13846 Change that to:
13847
13848 @lisp
13849 (nnml "cache"
13850 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13851 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13852 @end lisp
13853
13854 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13855 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13856 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13857
13858
13859 @node Server Variables
13860 @subsection Server Variables
13861 @cindex server variables
13862 @cindex server parameters
13863
13864 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13865 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13866 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13867 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13868 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13869
13870 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13871 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13872 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13873 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13874 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13875 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13876 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13877 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13878 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13879
13880 @lisp
13881 (nnml "public"
13882 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13883 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13884 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13885 @end lisp
13886
13887 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13888
13889 @node Servers and Methods
13890 @subsection Servers and Methods
13891
13892 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13893 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13894 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13895 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13896 over.
13897
13898
13899 @node Unavailable Servers
13900 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13901
13902 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13903 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13904 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13905 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13906 actually the case or not.
13907
13908 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13909 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13910 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13911 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13912 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13913 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13914 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13915 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13916
13917 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13918 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13919
13920 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13921 with the following commands:
13922
13923 @table @kbd
13924
13925 @item O
13926 @kindex O (Server)
13927 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13928 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13929 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13930
13931 @item C
13932 @kindex C (Server)
13933 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13934 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13935 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13936
13937 @item D
13938 @kindex D (Server)
13939 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13940 Mark the current server as unreachable
13941 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13942
13943 @item M-o
13944 @kindex M-o (Server)
13945 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13946 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13947 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13948
13949 @item M-c
13950 @kindex M-c (Server)
13951 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13952 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13953 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13954
13955 @item R
13956 @kindex R (Server)
13957 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13958 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13959 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13960
13961 @item L
13962 @kindex L (Server)
13963 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13964 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13965
13966 @end table
13967
13968
13969 @node Getting News
13970 @section Getting News
13971 @cindex reading news
13972 @cindex news back ends
13973
13974 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13975 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13976 or it can read from a local spool.
13977
13978 @menu
13979 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13980 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13981 @end menu
13982
13983
13984 @node NNTP
13985 @subsection NNTP
13986 @cindex nntp
13987
13988 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13989 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13990 server as the, uhm, address.
13991
13992 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13993 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13994 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13995 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13996
13997 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13998 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13999 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
14000
14001 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
14002 server:
14003
14004 @table @code
14005
14006 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
14007 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
14008 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
14009 @cindex authinfo
14010 @cindex authentication
14011 @cindex nntp authentication
14012 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
14013 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
14014 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
14015 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
14016 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
14017 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
14018 present in this hook.
14019
14020 @item nntp-authinfo-function
14021 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
14022 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
14023 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
14024 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
14025 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
14026 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
14027 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
14028 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
14029 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
14030 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
14031 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
14032
14033 @enumerate
14034 @item
14035 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
14036
14037 @item
14038 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
14039
14040 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
14041 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
14042 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
14043 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
14044 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
14045 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
14046 @samp{force} is explained below.
14047
14048 @end enumerate
14049
14050 Here's an example file:
14051
14052 @example
14053 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
14054 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
14055 @end example
14056
14057 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
14058 have to be first, for instance.
14059
14060 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
14061 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
14062 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
14063 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
14064 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
14065 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
14066 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
14067
14068 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
14069 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
14070
14071 @example
14072 default force yes
14073 @end example
14074
14075 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
14076 previously mentioned.
14077
14078 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
14079
14080 @item nntp-server-action-alist
14081 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
14082 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
14083 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
14084 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
14085
14086 @lisp
14087 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
14088 '(("innd" (ding))))
14089 @end lisp
14090
14091 You probably don't want to do that, though.
14092
14093 The default value is
14094
14095 @lisp
14096 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
14097 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
14098 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
14099 @end lisp
14100
14101 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
14102 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
14103
14104 @item nntp-maximum-request
14105 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
14106 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
14107 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
14108 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
14109 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
14110 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
14111 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
14112
14113 @item nntp-connection-timeout
14114 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
14115 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
14116 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
14117 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
14118 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
14119 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
14120 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
14121 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
14122 no timeouts are done.
14123
14124 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
14125 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
14126 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
14127 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
14128 can be used.
14129
14130 @item nntp-xover-commands
14131 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
14132 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
14133 @cindex XOVER
14134 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
14135 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
14136 "XOVERVIEW")}.
14137
14138 @item nntp-nov-gap
14139 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
14140 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
14141 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
14142 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
14143 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
14144 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
14145 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
14146 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
14147 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
14148 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
14149 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
14150
14151 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14152 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14153 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
14154 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
14155 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
14156 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
14157 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
14158 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
14159 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
14160 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
14161 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
14162 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
14163 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
14164 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
14165 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
14166 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
14167 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
14168
14169 @lisp
14170 (setq gnus-select-method
14171 '(nntp "newszilla"
14172 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
14173 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
14174 @dots{}))
14175 @end lisp
14176
14177 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
14178
14179 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
14180 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
14181 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
14182
14183 @item nntp-record-commands
14184 @vindex nntp-record-commands
14185 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
14186 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
14187 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
14188 that doesn't seem to work.
14189
14190 @item nntp-open-connection-function
14191 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
14192 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
14193 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
14194 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
14195 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
14196 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
14197 indirect ones (three pre-made).
14198
14199 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
14200 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
14201 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
14202 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
14203 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
14204 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
14205 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
14206 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
14207 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
14208
14209 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14210 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14211 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
14212 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
14213 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
14214 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
14215 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
14216
14217 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
14218 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
14219 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
14220 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
14221 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
14222 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
14223 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
14224
14225 @lisp
14226 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
14227 @end lisp
14228
14229 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
14230 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
14231
14232 @end table
14233
14234 @menu
14235 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
14236 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
14237 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
14238 * NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
14239 @end menu
14240
14241
14242 @node Direct Functions
14243 @subsubsection Direct Functions
14244 @cindex direct connection functions
14245
14246 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
14247 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
14248 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
14249 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14250
14251 @table @code
14252 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
14253 @item nntp-open-network-stream
14254 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
14255 remote system.
14256
14257 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
14258 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
14259 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14260 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
14261 installed. You then define a server as follows:
14262
14263 @lisp
14264 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14265 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
14266 ;;
14267 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
14268 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
14269 (nntp-port-number )
14270 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14271 @end lisp
14272
14273 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
14274 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
14275 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14276 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
14277 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
14278 then define a server as follows:
14279
14280 @lisp
14281 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14282 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
14283 ;;
14284 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
14285 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
14286 (nntp-port-number 563)
14287 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14288 @end lisp
14289
14290 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
14291 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
14292 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
14293 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
14294 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
14295 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
14296 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
14297 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
14298
14299 @lisp
14300 (nntp "socksified"
14301 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
14302 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
14303 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
14304 @end lisp
14305
14306 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
14307 session, which is not a good idea.
14308
14309 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
14310 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
14311 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
14312 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
14313 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
14314 not available. The previous example would turn into:
14315
14316 @lisp
14317 (nntp "socksified"
14318 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
14319 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
14320 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
14321 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
14322 @end lisp
14323 @end table
14324
14325
14326 @node Indirect Functions
14327 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
14328 @cindex indirect connection functions
14329
14330 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
14331 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14332 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
14333 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
14334 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
14335 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14336
14337 @table @code
14338 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14339 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14340 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
14341 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
14342 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
14343
14344 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
14345
14346 @table @code
14347 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14348 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14349 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14350 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14351
14352 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14353 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14354 List of strings to be used as the switches to
14355 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
14356 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
14357 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
14358 @end table
14359
14360 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14361 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14362 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
14363 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
14364 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
14365 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
14366
14367 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
14368
14369 @table @code
14370 @item nntp-telnet-command
14371 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
14372 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
14373 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
14374
14375 @item nntp-telnet-switches
14376 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
14377 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14378 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
14379
14380 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14381 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14382 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14383 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14384
14385 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14386 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14387 List of strings to be used as the switches to
14388 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
14389 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
14390 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
14391 host. The default is @code{nil}.
14392 @end table
14393
14394 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14395 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14396
14397 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14398 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14399 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
14400 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
14401
14402 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
14403
14404 @table @code
14405 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
14406 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
14407 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
14408 @samp{telnet}.
14409
14410 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
14411 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
14412 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14413 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
14414
14415 @item nntp-via-user-password
14416 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
14417 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
14418
14419 @item nntp-via-envuser
14420 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
14421 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
14422 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
14423 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
14424
14425 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
14426 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
14427 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
14428 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
14429
14430 @end table
14431
14432 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14433 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14434 @end table
14435
14436
14437 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14438 functions:
14439
14440 @table @code
14441
14442 @item nntp-via-user-name
14443 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
14444 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14445
14446 @item nntp-via-address
14447 @vindex nntp-via-address
14448 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14449
14450 @end table
14451
14452
14453 @node Common Variables
14454 @subsubsection Common Variables
14455
14456 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14457 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14458 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14459 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14460 variables individually).
14461
14462 @table @code
14463
14464 @item nntp-pre-command
14465 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14466 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14467 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14468 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14469 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14470
14471 @item nntp-address
14472 @vindex nntp-address
14473 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14474
14475 @item nntp-port-number
14476 @vindex nntp-port-number
14477 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14478 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14479 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14480 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14481 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14482 not work with named ports.
14483
14484 @item nntp-end-of-line
14485 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14486 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14487 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14488 using a non native telnet connection function.
14489
14490 @item nntp-netcat-command
14491 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14492 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14493 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14494 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14495 @samp{nc}.
14496
14497 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14498 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14499 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14500 is @samp{()}.
14501
14502 @end table
14503
14504 @node NNTP marks
14505 @subsubsection NNTP marks
14506 @cindex storing NNTP marks
14507
14508 Gnus stores marks (@pxref{Marking Articles}) for @acronym{NNTP}
14509 servers in marks files. A marks file records what marks you have set
14510 in a group and each file is specific to the corresponding server.
14511 Marks files are stored in @file{~/News/marks}
14512 (@code{nntp-marks-directory}) under a classic hierarchy resembling
14513 that of a news server, for example marks for the group
14514 @samp{gmane.discuss} on the news.gmane.org server will be stored in
14515 the file @file{~/News/marks/news.gmane.org/gmane/discuss/.marks}.
14516
14517 Marks files are useful because you can copy the @file{~/News/marks}
14518 directory (using rsync, scp or whatever) to another Gnus installation,
14519 and it will realize what articles you have read and marked. The data
14520 in @file{~/News/marks} has priority over the same data in
14521 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14522
14523 Note that marks files are very much server-specific: Gnus remembers
14524 the article numbers so if you don't use the same servers on both
14525 installations things are most likely to break (most @acronym{NNTP}
14526 servers do not use the same article numbers as any other server).
14527 However, if you use servers A, B, C on one installation and servers A,
14528 D, E on the other, you can sync the marks files for A and then you'll
14529 get synchronization for that server between the two installations.
14530
14531 Using @acronym{NNTP} marks can possibly incur a performance penalty so
14532 if Gnus feels sluggish, try setting the @code{nntp-marks-is-evil}
14533 variable to @code{t}. Marks will then be stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14534
14535 Related variables:
14536
14537 @table @code
14538
14539 @item nntp-marks-is-evil
14540 @vindex nntp-marks-is-evil
14541 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any marks files. The
14542 default is @code{nil}.
14543
14544 @item nntp-marks-directory
14545 @vindex nntp-marks-directory
14546 The directory where marks for nntp groups will be stored.
14547
14548 @end table
14549
14550
14551 @node News Spool
14552 @subsection News Spool
14553 @cindex nnspool
14554 @cindex news spool
14555
14556 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14557 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14558 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14559 instance.
14560
14561 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14562 anything else) as the address.
14563
14564 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14565 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14566 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14567 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14568
14569 @table @code
14570
14571 @item nnspool-inews-program
14572 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14573 Program used to post an article.
14574
14575 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14576 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14577 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14578
14579 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14580 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14581 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14582 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14583
14584 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14585 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14586 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14587 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14588
14589 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14590 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14591 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14592
14593 @item nnspool-active-file
14594 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14595 The name of the active file.
14596
14597 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14598 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14599 The name of the group descriptions file.
14600
14601 @item nnspool-history-file
14602 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14603 The name of the news history file.
14604
14605 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14606 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14607 The name of the active date file.
14608
14609 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14610 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14611 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14612 that it finds.
14613
14614 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14615 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14616 @cindex sed
14617 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14618 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14619 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14620 there.
14621
14622 @end table
14623
14624
14625 @node Getting Mail
14626 @section Getting Mail
14627 @cindex reading mail
14628 @cindex mail
14629
14630 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
14631 course.
14632
14633 @menu
14634 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14635 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14636 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14637 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14638 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14639 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14640 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14641 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14642 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14643 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14644 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14645 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14646 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14647 @end menu
14648
14649
14650 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14651 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14652
14653 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14654 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14655 of a culture shock.
14656
14657 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14658 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14659
14660 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14661 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14662 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14663 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14664
14665 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14666
14667 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14668 deleted? How awful!
14669
14670 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14671 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14672 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14673 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14674 Mail}.
14675
14676 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14677 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14678 they want to treat a message.
14679
14680 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14681 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14682 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14683 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14684 archived somewhere else.
14685
14686 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14687 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14688 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14689 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14690 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14691
14692 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14693 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14694 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14695
14696 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14697 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14698 differently.
14699
14700 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14701 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14702 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14703 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14704 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14705
14706 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14707 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14708 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14709 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14710 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14711 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14712 You Do.)
14713
14714
14715 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14716 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14717
14718 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14719 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14720 and things will happen automatically.
14721
14722 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14723 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14724
14725 @lisp
14726 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14727 @end lisp
14728
14729 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14730 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14731 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14732 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14733 like any other group.
14734
14735 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14736
14737 @lisp
14738 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14739 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14740 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14741 ("other" "")))
14742 @end lisp
14743
14744 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14745 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14746 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14747 last group.
14748
14749 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14750 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14751 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14752
14753
14754 @node Splitting Mail
14755 @subsection Splitting Mail
14756 @cindex splitting mail
14757 @cindex mail splitting
14758 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14759
14760 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14761 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14762 to be split into groups.
14763
14764 @lisp
14765 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14766 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14767 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14768 ("mail.other" "")))
14769 @end lisp
14770
14771 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14772 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14773 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14774 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14775 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14776 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14777 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14778
14779 @lisp
14780 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14781 @end lisp
14782
14783 @noindent
14784 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14785 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14786
14787 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14788 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14789 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14790 mail belongs in that group.
14791
14792 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14793 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14794 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14795 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14796 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14797 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14798 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14799 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14800 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14801 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14802
14803 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14804 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14805 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14806 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14807 thinks should carry this mail message.
14808
14809 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14810 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14811 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14812 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14813
14814 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14815 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14816 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14817 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14818 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14819
14820 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14821 @cindex crosspost
14822 @cindex links
14823 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14824 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14825 links. If that's the case for you, set
14826 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14827 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14828
14829 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14830 @findex nnmail-split-history
14831 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14832 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14833 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14834 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14835 Group Commands}).
14836
14837 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14838 Header lines longer than the value of
14839 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14840 function.
14841
14842 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14843 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14844 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14845 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14846 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14847 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14848 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14849 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14850 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14851 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14852 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14853 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14854
14855 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14856 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14857 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14858 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14859 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14860 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14861 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14862 other kinds of entries.)
14863
14864 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14865 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14866 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14867 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14868 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14869 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14870 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14871 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14872 month's rent money.
14873
14874
14875 @node Mail Sources
14876 @subsection Mail Sources
14877
14878 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14879 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14880 maildir, for instance.
14881
14882 @menu
14883 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14884 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14885 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14886 @end menu
14887
14888
14889 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14890 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14891 @cindex POP
14892 @cindex mail server
14893 @cindex procmail
14894 @cindex mail spool
14895 @cindex mail source
14896
14897 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14898 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14899
14900 Here's an example:
14901
14902 @lisp
14903 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14904 @end lisp
14905
14906 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14907 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14908 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14909 default values.
14910
14911 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14912 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14913 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14914 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14915 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14916 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14917 group might look like this:
14918
14919 @lisp
14920 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14921 @end lisp
14922
14923 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14924 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14925
14926 The following mail source types are available:
14927
14928 @table @code
14929 @item file
14930 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14931
14932 Keywords:
14933
14934 @table @code
14935 @item :path
14936 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14937 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14938 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14939
14940 @item :prescript
14941 @itemx :postscript
14942 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14943 @end table
14944
14945 An example file mail source:
14946
14947 @lisp
14948 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14949 @end lisp
14950
14951 Or using the default file name:
14952
14953 @lisp
14954 (file)
14955 @end lisp
14956
14957 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14958 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14959 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14960 mail spool while moving the mail.
14961
14962 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14963
14964 @lisp
14965 (setq mail-sources
14966 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14967 @end lisp
14968
14969 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14970
14971 @example
14972 #!/bin/sh
14973 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14974 # flu@@iki.fi
14975
14976 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14977 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14978 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14979 @end example
14980
14981 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14982 file you want to use.
14983
14984
14985 @item directory
14986 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14987 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14988 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14989 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14990 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14991 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14992 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14993 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14994 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14995 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14996
14997 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14998 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14999 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
15000 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
15001
15002 Keywords:
15003
15004 @table @code
15005 @item :path
15006 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
15007 value.
15008
15009 @item :suffix
15010 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
15011 @samp{.spool}.
15012
15013 @item :predicate
15014 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
15015 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
15016 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
15017 predicate are considered.
15018
15019 @item :prescript
15020 @itemx :postscript
15021 Script run before/after fetching mail.
15022
15023 @end table
15024
15025 An example directory mail source:
15026
15027 @lisp
15028 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
15029 :suffix ".prcml")
15030 @end lisp
15031
15032 @item pop
15033 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15034
15035 Keywords:
15036
15037 @table @code
15038 @item :server
15039 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
15040 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15041
15042 @item :port
15043 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
15044 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
15045 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
15046 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
15047 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
15048
15049 @item :user
15050 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
15051 name.
15052
15053 @item :password
15054 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
15055 the user is prompted.
15056
15057 @item :program
15058 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
15059 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
15060
15061 @example
15062 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
15063 @end example
15064
15065 The valid format specifier characters are:
15066
15067 @table @samp
15068 @item t
15069 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
15070 included in this string.
15071
15072 @item s
15073 The name of the server.
15074
15075 @item P
15076 The port number of the server.
15077
15078 @item u
15079 The user name to use.
15080
15081 @item p
15082 The password to use.
15083 @end table
15084
15085 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15086 corresponding keywords.
15087
15088 @item :prescript
15089 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15090 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15091
15092 @item :postscript
15093 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15094 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15095
15096 @item :function
15097 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
15098 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
15099 mail should be moved to.
15100
15101 @item :authentication
15102 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
15103 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
15104 @code{password}.
15105
15106 @end table
15107
15108 @vindex pop3-movemail
15109 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
15110 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
15111 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
15112 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
15113 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
15114 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
15115 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
15116 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
15117 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
15118
15119 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15120 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
15121 name, and default fetcher:
15122
15123 @lisp
15124 (pop)
15125 @end lisp
15126
15127 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
15128
15129 @lisp
15130 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
15131 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
15132 @end lisp
15133
15134 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
15135
15136 @lisp
15137 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
15138 @end lisp
15139
15140 @item maildir
15141 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
15142 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
15143 contains exactly one mail.
15144
15145 Keywords:
15146
15147 @table @code
15148 @item :path
15149 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
15150 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
15151 @file{~/Maildir/}.
15152 @item :subdirs
15153 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
15154 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
15155
15156 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
15157 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
15158 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
15159 @c below.
15160
15161 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
15162 from locking problems).
15163
15164 @end table
15165
15166 Two example maildir mail sources:
15167
15168 @lisp
15169 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
15170 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
15171 @end lisp
15172
15173 @lisp
15174 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
15175 :subdirs ("new"))
15176 @end lisp
15177
15178 @item imap
15179 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
15180 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
15181 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
15182 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
15183 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
15184
15185 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
15186 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
15187
15188 Keywords:
15189
15190 @table @code
15191 @item :server
15192 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
15193 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15194
15195 @item :port
15196 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
15197 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
15198
15199 @item :user
15200 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
15201 name.
15202
15203 @item :password
15204 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
15205 prompted.
15206
15207 @item :stream
15208 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
15209 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
15210 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
15211 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
15212
15213 @item :authentication
15214 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
15215 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
15216 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
15217 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
15218
15219 @item :program
15220 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
15221 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
15222 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
15223
15224 @example
15225 ssh %s imapd
15226 @end example
15227
15228 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
15229 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
15230 specifier characters are:
15231
15232 @table @samp
15233 @item s
15234 The name of the server.
15235
15236 @item l
15237 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
15238
15239 @item p
15240 The port number of the server.
15241 @end table
15242
15243 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15244 corresponding keywords.
15245
15246 @item :mailbox
15247 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
15248 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
15249
15250 @item :predicate
15251 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
15252 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
15253 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
15254 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
15255 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
15256 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
15257
15258 @item :fetchflag
15259 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
15260 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
15261 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
15262 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
15263
15264 @item :dontexpunge
15265 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
15266 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
15267
15268 @end table
15269
15270 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
15271
15272 @lisp
15273 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
15274 :stream kerberos4
15275 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
15276 @end lisp
15277
15278 @item webmail
15279 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
15280 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
15281 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
15282
15283 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
15284 required for url "4.0pre.46".
15285
15286 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
15287
15288 Keywords:
15289
15290 @table @code
15291 @item :subtype
15292 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
15293 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
15294
15295 @item :user
15296 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
15297 name.
15298
15299 @item :password
15300 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
15301 prompted.
15302
15303 @item :dontexpunge
15304 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
15305 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
15306
15307 @end table
15308
15309 An example webmail source:
15310
15311 @lisp
15312 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
15313 :user "user-name"
15314 :password "secret")
15315 @end lisp
15316
15317 @item group
15318 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
15319 @xref{Group Parameters}.
15320
15321 @end table
15322
15323 @table @dfn
15324 @item Common Keywords
15325 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15326
15327 Keywords:
15328
15329 @table @code
15330 @item :plugged
15331 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15332 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15333 example:
15334
15335 @lisp
15336 (setq mail-sources
15337 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15338 :suffix ""
15339 :plugged t)))
15340 @end lisp
15341
15342 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15343 useful when you use local mail and news.
15344
15345 @end table
15346 @end table
15347
15348 @subsubsection Function Interface
15349
15350 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15351 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15352 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15353 consider the following mail-source setting:
15354
15355 @lisp
15356 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15357 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15358 @end lisp
15359
15360 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15361 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15362 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15363 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15364 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15365
15366 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15367
15368
15369 @node Mail Source Customization
15370 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15371
15372 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15373 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15374 variables.
15375
15376 @table @code
15377 @item mail-source-crash-box
15378 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15379 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15380 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15381
15382 @cindex Incoming*
15383 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15384 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15385 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15386 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15387 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15388 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15389 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15390 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15391 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{2} in alpha Gnusae
15392 and @code{10} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15393
15394 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15395 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15396 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15397 files. This variable only applies when
15398 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15399
15400 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15401 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15402 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15403
15404 @item mail-source-directory
15405 @vindex mail-source-directory
15406 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15407 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15408 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15409 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15410
15411 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15412 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15413 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15414 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15415 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15416 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15417 number.
15418
15419 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15420 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15421 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
15422
15423 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15424 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15425 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15426 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15427
15428 @end table
15429
15430
15431 @node Fetching Mail
15432 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15433
15434 @vindex mail-sources
15435 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15436 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15437 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15438
15439 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15440 fetch mail by themselves.
15441
15442 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15443 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15444
15445 @lisp
15446 (setq mail-sources
15447 '((file)
15448 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15449 :password "secret")))
15450 @end lisp
15451
15452 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15453
15454 @lisp
15455 (setq mail-sources
15456 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15457 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15458 :user "user-name"
15459 :port "pop3"
15460 :password "secret")))
15461 @end lisp
15462
15463
15464 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15465 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15466 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15467 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15468 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15469 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15470
15471
15472
15473 @node Mail Back End Variables
15474 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15475
15476 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15477 mail back ends.
15478
15479 @table @code
15480 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15481 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15482 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15483 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15484
15485 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15486 @item nnmail-split-hook
15487 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15488 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15489 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15490 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15491 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15492 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15493 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15494 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15495 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15496 to this hook.
15497
15498 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15499 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15500 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15501 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15502 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15503 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15504 starting to handle the new mail) and
15505 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15506 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15507 default file modes the new mail files get:
15508
15509 @lisp
15510 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15511 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
15512
15513 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15514 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
15515 @end lisp
15516
15517 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15518 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15519 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15520 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15521 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15522 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15523 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15524
15525 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15526 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15527 @findex delete-file
15528 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15529
15530 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15531 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15532 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15533 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15534 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15535
15536 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15537 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15538 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15539 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15540 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15541
15542 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15543 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15544 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15545
15546 @end table
15547
15548
15549 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15550 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15551 @cindex mail splitting
15552 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15553
15554 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15555 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15556 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15557 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15558 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15559 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15560
15561 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15562
15563 @lisp
15564 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15565 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15566 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15567 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15568 "mail.misc"))
15569 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15570 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15571 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15572 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15573 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15574 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15575 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15576 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15577 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15578 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15579 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15580 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15581 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15582 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15583 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15584 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15585 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15586 "misc.misc")
15587 @end lisp
15588
15589 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15590 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15591 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15592
15593 @table @code
15594
15595 @item group
15596 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15597 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15598
15599 @c Don't fold this line.
15600 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15601 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15602 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15603 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15604 @var{split}.
15605
15606 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15607 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15608 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15609 @var{split} is processed.
15610
15611 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15612 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15613 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15614 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15615
15616 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15617 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15618 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15619 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15620 stored in one or more groups.
15621
15622 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15623 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15624 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15625
15626 @item junk
15627 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15628 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15629
15630 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15631 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15632 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15633 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15634
15635 @cindex body split
15636 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15637 body of the messages:
15638
15639 @lisp
15640 (defun split-on-body ()
15641 (save-excursion
15642 (save-restriction
15643 (widen)
15644 (goto-char (point-min))
15645 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15646 "string.group"))))
15647 @end lisp
15648
15649 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15650 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15651 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15652 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15653 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15654 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15655 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
15656
15657 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15658 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15659 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15660 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15661 should return a split.
15662
15663 @item nil
15664 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15665
15666 @end table
15667
15668 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15669
15670 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15671 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15672 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15673 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15674 for example,
15675
15676 @example
15677 (any "joe" "joemail")
15678 @end example
15679
15680 @noindent
15681 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15682 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15683 of the following three ways:
15684
15685 @enumerate
15686 @item
15687 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15688 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15689 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15690 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15691 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15692 @code{nil}.
15693
15694 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15695
15696 @item
15697 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15698 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15699 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15700 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15701 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15702
15703 @item
15704 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15705 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15706 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15707 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15708 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15709 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15710 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15711 @end enumerate
15712
15713 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15714 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15715 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15716 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15717 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15718 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15719 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15720
15721 @table @code
15722 @item from
15723 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15724 @item to
15725 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15726 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15727 @item any
15728 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15729 @end table
15730
15731 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15732 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15733 when all this splitting is performed.
15734
15735 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15736 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15737 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15738
15739 @example
15740 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15741 @end example
15742
15743 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15744 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15745
15746 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15747 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15748 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15749 groupings 1 through 9.
15750
15751 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15752 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15753 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15754 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15755 groups when users send to an address using different case
15756 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15757 is @code{t}.
15758
15759 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15760 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15761 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15762 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15763 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15764 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15765 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15766 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15767 it once per thread.
15768
15769 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15770 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15771 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15772 using the colon feature, like so:
15773 @lisp
15774 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15775 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15776 nnmail-split-fancy
15777 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15778 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15779 ))
15780 @end lisp
15781
15782 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15783 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15784 in the file specified by the variable
15785 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15786 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15787 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15788 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15789 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15790 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15791 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15792 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15793 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15794 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15795 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15796 300 kBytes in size.)
15797 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15798 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15799 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15800 messages goes into the new group.
15801
15802 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15803 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15804 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15805 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15806 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15807 ``outgoing'' group.
15808
15809
15810 @node Group Mail Splitting
15811 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15812 @cindex mail splitting
15813 @cindex group mail splitting
15814
15815 @findex gnus-group-split
15816 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15817 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15818 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15819 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15820 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15821 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15822 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15823 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15824
15825 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15826 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15827 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15828 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15829
15830 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15831 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15832 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15833 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15834 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15835 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15836 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15837
15838 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15839 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15840 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15841 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15842 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15843 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15844 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15845
15846 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15847 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15848 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15849 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15850 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15851 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15852 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15853 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15854 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15855 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15856 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15857 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15858 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15859
15860 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15861 been defined:
15862
15863 @example
15864 nnml:mail.bar:
15865 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15866 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15867 nnml:mail.foo:
15868 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15869 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15870 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15871 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15872 nnml:mail.others:
15873 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15874 @end example
15875
15876 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15877 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15878 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15879
15880 @lisp
15881 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15882 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15883 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15884 "mail.others")
15885 @end lisp
15886
15887 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15888 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15889 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15890 splits like this:
15891
15892 @lisp
15893 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15894 @end lisp
15895
15896 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15897 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15898 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15899 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15900 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15901 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15902 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15903 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15904 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15905
15906 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15907 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15908 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15909 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15910 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15911 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15912 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15913 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15914 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15915
15916 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15917 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15918 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15919 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15920 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15921 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15922
15923 @lisp
15924 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15925 @end lisp
15926
15927 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15928 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15929 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15930 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15931 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15932 value.
15933
15934 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15935 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15936 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15937 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15938
15939 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15940 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15941 @cindex incorporating old mail
15942 @cindex import old mail
15943
15944 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15945 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15946 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15947 your mail groups.
15948
15949 Doing so can be quite easy.
15950
15951 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15952 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15953 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15954 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15955 your @code{nnml} groups.
15956
15957 Here's how:
15958
15959 @enumerate
15960 @item
15961 Go to the group buffer.
15962
15963 @item
15964 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15965 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15966
15967 @item
15968 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15969
15970 @item
15971 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15972 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15973
15974 @item
15975 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15976 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15977 @end enumerate
15978
15979 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15980 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15981 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15982 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15983 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15984
15985 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15986 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15987 using the new mail back end.
15988
15989
15990 @node Expiring Mail
15991 @subsection Expiring Mail
15992 @cindex article expiry
15993 @cindex expiring mail
15994
15995 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15996 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15997 different approach to mail reading.
15998
15999 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
16000 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
16001 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
16002 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
16003 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
16004 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
16005 course.
16006
16007 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
16008 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
16009 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
16010 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
16011 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
16012 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
16013 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
16014 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
16015 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
16016
16017 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
16018 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
16019 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
16020 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
16021 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
16022 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
16023 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
16024 expirable.
16025
16026 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
16027 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
16028 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
16029 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
16030 into its own group.)
16031
16032 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
16033 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
16034 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
16035 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
16036 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
16037 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
16038 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
16039 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
16040 scoring.
16041
16042 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16043 Groups that match the regular expression
16044 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
16045 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
16046 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
16047
16048 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
16049 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
16050 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
16051 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
16052 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16053
16054 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
16055 @lisp
16056 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
16057 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
16058 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
16059 @end lisp
16060
16061 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
16062 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
16063 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
16064 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
16065 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
16066
16067 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
16068 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
16069
16070 @lisp
16071 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16072 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
16073 @end lisp
16074
16075 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
16076 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
16077
16078 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
16079 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
16080 don't really mix very well.
16081
16082 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
16083 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
16084 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
16085 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
16086 days.
16087
16088 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
16089 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
16090 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
16091 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
16092 everywhere else:
16093
16094 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16095 @lisp
16096 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16097 (lambda (group)
16098 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
16099 31)
16100 ((string= group "mail.junk")
16101 1)
16102 ((string= group "important")
16103 'never)
16104 (t
16105 6))))
16106 @end lisp
16107
16108 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
16109 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
16110
16111 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
16112 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
16113 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
16114 @code{never}.
16115
16116 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
16117 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
16118
16119 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
16120 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
16121 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
16122 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
16123 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
16124 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
16125 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
16126 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
16127 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
16128 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
16129 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
16130 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
16131 name or @code{delete}.
16132
16133 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
16134 @lisp
16135 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
16136 @end lisp
16137
16138 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16139 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16140 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
16141 expire mail to groups according to the variable
16142 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
16143
16144 @lisp
16145 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16146 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16147 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
16148 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
16149 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
16150 @end lisp
16151
16152 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
16153 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
16154 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
16155 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
16156 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
16157 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
16158
16159 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
16160 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
16161 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
16162 easier for procmail users.
16163
16164 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
16165 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
16166 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
16167 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
16168 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
16169 caution. Even more dangerous is the
16170 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
16171 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
16172 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
16173 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
16174 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
16175 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
16176 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
16177 with! So there!
16178
16179 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
16180
16181 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
16182 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
16183 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
16184 auto-expire turned on.
16185
16186
16187 @node Washing Mail
16188 @subsection Washing Mail
16189 @cindex mail washing
16190 @cindex list server brain damage
16191 @cindex incoming mail treatment
16192
16193 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
16194 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
16195 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
16196 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
16197 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
16198 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
16199
16200 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
16201 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
16202 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
16203 laugh.
16204
16205 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
16206 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
16207 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
16208 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
16209
16210 @table @code
16211 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16212 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16213 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
16214 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
16215 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
16216
16217 @table @code
16218 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16219 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16220 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
16221 Emacs running on MS machines.
16222
16223 @end table
16224
16225 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16226 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16227 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
16228 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
16229
16230 @table @code
16231 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16232 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16233 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
16234 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
16235
16236 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
16237 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
16238 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
16239 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
16240 into a feature by documenting it.)
16241
16242 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16243 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16244 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
16245 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
16246 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
16247 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
16248 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
16249 @code{\\(..\\)}.
16250
16251 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
16252 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
16253
16254 @lisp
16255 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
16256 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
16257 @end lisp
16258
16259 This can also be done non-destructively with
16260 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
16261
16262 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
16263 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
16264 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
16265
16266 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16267 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16268 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
16269 @cindex Eudora
16270 @cindex Pegasus
16271 Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
16272 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
16273 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
16274 contain a line matching the regular expression
16275 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
16276
16277 @end table
16278
16279 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16280 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16281 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
16282 include:
16283
16284 @table @code
16285 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
16286 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
16287 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
16288
16289 @end table
16290 @end table
16291
16292
16293 @node Duplicates
16294 @subsection Duplicates
16295
16296 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
16297 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
16298 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
16299 @cindex duplicate mails
16300 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
16301 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
16302 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16303 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
16304 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16305 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16306 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16307 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16308 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16309 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16310 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16311 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16312 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16313
16314 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16315 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16316 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16317 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16318
16319 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16320 @code{nil}.
16321
16322 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16323 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16324 methods:
16325
16326 @lisp
16327 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
16328 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16329 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16330 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16331 (any mail "mail.misc")
16332 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16333 [...] ))
16334 @end lisp
16335 @noindent
16336 Or something like:
16337 @lisp
16338 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16339 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16340 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16341 [...]))
16342 @end lisp
16343
16344 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16345 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16346 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16347 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16348 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16349
16350
16351 @node Not Reading Mail
16352 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16353
16354 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16355 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16356 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16357
16358 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16359 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16360 mail, which should help.
16361
16362 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16363 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16364 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16365 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16366 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16367 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16368 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
16369 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16370 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16371 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16372 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16373
16374 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16375 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16376 incoming mail.
16377
16378
16379 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16380 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16381
16382 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16383 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16384 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16385
16386 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16387 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16388 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16389 Spool}).
16390
16391 @menu
16392 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16393 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
16394 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16395 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16396 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16397 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16398 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16399 @end menu
16400
16401
16402 @node Unix Mail Box
16403 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16404 @cindex nnmbox
16405 @cindex unix mail box
16406
16407 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16408 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16409 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16410 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16411 which group it belongs in.
16412
16413 Virtual server settings:
16414
16415 @table @code
16416 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16417 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16418 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16419 @file{~/mbox}.
16420
16421 @item nnmbox-active-file
16422 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16423 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16424 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16425
16426 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16427 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16428 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16429 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16430 @end table
16431
16432
16433 @node Rmail Babyl
16434 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
16435 @cindex nnbabyl
16436 @cindex Rmail mbox
16437
16438 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16439 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16440 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
16441 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
16442 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
16443
16444 Virtual server settings:
16445
16446 @table @code
16447 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16448 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16449 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16450
16451 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16452 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16453 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
16454 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16455
16456 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16457 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16458 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16459 @code{t}
16460 @end table
16461
16462
16463 @node Mail Spool
16464 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16465 @cindex nnml
16466 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16467
16468 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16469 format. It should be used with some caution.
16470
16471 @vindex nnml-directory
16472 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16473 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16474 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16475 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16476
16477 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16478 care of all that.
16479
16480 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16481 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16482 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16483 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16484 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16485 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16486 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16487 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16488
16489 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16490 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16491 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16492 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16493
16494 @cindex self contained nnml servers
16495 @cindex marks
16496 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
16497 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16498 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16499 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
16500 for a group are usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
16501 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
16502 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
16503 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
16504 directory).
16505
16506 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
16507 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
16508 them next time it starts.
16509
16510 Virtual server settings:
16511
16512 @table @code
16513 @item nnml-directory
16514 @vindex nnml-directory
16515 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16516 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16517 is @file{~/Mail}).
16518
16519 @item nnml-active-file
16520 @vindex nnml-active-file
16521 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16522 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16523
16524 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16525 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16526 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16527 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16528
16529 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16530 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16531 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16532 @code{t}.
16533
16534 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16535 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16536 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16537 default is @code{nil}.
16538
16539 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16540 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16541 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16542
16543 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16544 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16545 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16546
16547 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
16548 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
16549 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16550 default is @code{nil}.
16551
16552 @item nnml-marks-file-name
16553 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
16554 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
16555
16556 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16557 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16558 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16559 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16560 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16561 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16562 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16563 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16564 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16565
16566 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16567 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16568 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16569 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16570 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16571
16572 @end table
16573
16574 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16575 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16576 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16577 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16578 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16579 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16580 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16581 Commands}).
16582
16583
16584 @node MH Spool
16585 @subsubsection MH Spool
16586 @cindex nnmh
16587 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16588
16589 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16590 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16591 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16592 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16593 for.
16594
16595 Virtual server settings:
16596
16597 @table @code
16598 @item nnmh-directory
16599 @vindex nnmh-directory
16600 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16601 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16602 @file{~/Mail})
16603
16604 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16605 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16606 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16607 @code{t}.
16608
16609 @item nnmh-be-safe
16610 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16611 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16612 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16613 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16614 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16615 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16616 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16617 @end table
16618
16619
16620 @node Maildir
16621 @subsubsection Maildir
16622 @cindex nnmaildir
16623 @cindex maildir
16624
16625 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16626 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16627 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16628 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16629 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16630 within a maildir.
16631
16632 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16633 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16634 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16635 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16636 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16637 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16638 that appear as group in Gnus.
16639
16640 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16641 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16642 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16643
16644 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16645 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16646 another, and you will keep your marks.
16647
16648 Virtual server settings:
16649
16650 @table @code
16651 @item directory
16652 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16653 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16654 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16655 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16656 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16657 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16658 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16659 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16660 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16661 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16662
16663 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16664 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16665 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16666 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16667 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16668 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16669 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16670 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16671 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16672 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16673 value.
16674
16675 @item target-prefix
16676 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16677 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16678 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16679 closed.
16680
16681 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16682 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16683 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16684 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16685 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16686 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16687 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16688 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16689 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16690
16691 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16692 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16693 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16694 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16695 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16696
16697 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16698 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16699 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16700 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16701 @code{force} argument.
16702
16703 @item directory-files
16704 This should be a function with the same interface as
16705 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16706 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16707 parameter is optional; the default is
16708 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16709 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16710 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16711 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16712 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16713 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16714
16715 @item get-new-mail
16716 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16717 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16718 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16719 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16720 value is @code{nil}.
16721
16722 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16723 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16724 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16725 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16726 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16727 @end table
16728
16729 @subsubsection Group parameters
16730
16731 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16732 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16733 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16734 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16735 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16736 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16737 another back end.
16738
16739 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16740 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16741 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16742 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16743 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16744 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16745 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16746 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16747 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16748
16749 @table @code
16750 @item expire-age
16751 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16752 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16753 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16754 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16755 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16756 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16757 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16758 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16759 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16760 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16761 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16762 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16763 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16764
16765 @item expire-group
16766 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16767 @example
16768 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16769 @end example
16770 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16771 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16772 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16773 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16774 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16775 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16776 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16777 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16778 article. So that form can refer to
16779 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16780 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16781 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16782 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16783
16784 @item read-only
16785 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16786 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16787 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16788 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16789 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16790 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16791 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16792 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16793 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16794 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16795 contain extra copies of the articles.
16796
16797 @item directory-files
16798 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16799 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16800 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16801 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16802
16803 @item distrust-Lines:
16804 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16805 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16806 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16807
16808 @item always-marks
16809 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16810 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16811 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16812 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16813 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16814 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16815
16816 @item never-marks
16817 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16818 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16819 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16820 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16821 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16822 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16823 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16824
16825 @item nov-cache-size
16826 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16827 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16828 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16829 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16830 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16831 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16832 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16833 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16834 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16835 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16836 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16837 @end table
16838
16839 @subsubsection Article identification
16840 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16841 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16842 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16843 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16844 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16845 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16846 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16847 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16848 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16849 request the article in the summary buffer.
16850
16851 @subsubsection NOV data
16852 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16853 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16854 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16855 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16856 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16857 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16858 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16859 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16860 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16861 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16862 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16863
16864 @subsubsection Article marks
16865 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16866 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16867 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16868 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16869 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16870 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16871 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16872 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16873
16874 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16875 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16876 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16877 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16878 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16879 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16880 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16881 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16882 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16883
16884
16885 @node Mail Folders
16886 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16887 @cindex nnfolder
16888 @cindex mbox folders
16889 @cindex mail folders
16890
16891 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16892 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16893 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16894 numbers and arrival dates.
16895
16896 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
16897 @cindex marks
16898 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
16899 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16900 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16901 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
16902 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
16903 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
16904 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
16905 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
16906 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
16907 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
16908
16909 Virtual server settings:
16910
16911 @table @code
16912 @item nnfolder-directory
16913 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16914 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16915 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16916 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16917
16918 @item nnfolder-active-file
16919 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16920 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16921
16922 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16923 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16924 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16925 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16926
16927 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16928 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16929 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16930 default is @code{t}
16931
16932 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16933 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16934 @cindex backup files
16935 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16936 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16937 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16938 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16939
16940 @lisp
16941 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16942 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16943
16944 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16945 @end lisp
16946
16947 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16948 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16949 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16950 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16951 extract some information from it before removing it.
16952
16953 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16954 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16955 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16956 default is @code{nil}.
16957
16958 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16959 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16960 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16961
16962 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16963 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16964 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16965 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16966
16967 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16968 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16969 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16970 default is @code{nil}.
16971
16972 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16973 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16974 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
16975
16976 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
16977 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
16978 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
16979 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16980
16981 @end table
16982
16983
16984 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16985 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16986 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16987 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16988 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16989 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16990 though.
16991
16992 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16993 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16994
16995 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16996 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16997 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16998 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16999 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
17000
17001 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
17002 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
17003 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
17004 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
17005 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
17006 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
17007 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
17008 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
17009 via NFS).
17010
17011 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
17012 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
17013 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
17014 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
17015
17016 @table @code
17017 @item nnmbox
17018
17019 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
17020 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
17021 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
17022 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
17023 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
17024 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
17025 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
17026 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
17027 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
17028 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
17029 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
17030 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
17031 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
17032 what's where.
17033
17034 @item nnbabyl
17035
17036 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
17037 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
17038 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
17039 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
17040 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
17041 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
17042 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
17043 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
17044 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
17045 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
17046 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
17047 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
17048 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
17049 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
17050
17051 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
17052 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
17053 look at your mail.
17054
17055 @item nnml
17056
17057 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
17058 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
17059 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
17060 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
17061 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
17062 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
17063 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
17064 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
17065 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
17066 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
17067 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
17068 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
17069 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
17070 provided by the active file and overviews.
17071
17072 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
17073 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
17074 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
17075 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
17076 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
17077 wins big.
17078
17079 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
17080 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
17081 tiny files.
17082
17083 @item nnmh
17084
17085 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
17086 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
17087 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
17088 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
17089 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
17090 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
17091 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
17092
17093 @item nnfolder
17094
17095 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
17096 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
17097 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
17098 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
17099 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
17100 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
17101 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
17102 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
17103 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
17104
17105 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
17106 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
17107 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
17108 friendly mail back end all over.
17109
17110 @item nnmaildir
17111
17112 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
17113 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
17114 mail back ends.
17115
17116 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
17117 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
17118 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
17119 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
17120 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
17121 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
17122 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
17123 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
17124 file system.
17125
17126 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
17127 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
17128 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
17129 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
17130 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
17131 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
17132 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
17133 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
17134 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
17135 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
17136 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
17137
17138 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
17139 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
17140 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
17141 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
17142 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
17143 @code{nnmaildir}.
17144
17145 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
17146 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
17147 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
17148 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
17149 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
17150 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
17151 removed in the future.
17152
17153 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
17154 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
17155 on your file system.
17156
17157 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
17158 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
17159
17160 @end table
17161
17162
17163 @node Browsing the Web
17164 @section Browsing the Web
17165 @cindex web
17166 @cindex browsing the web
17167 @cindex www
17168 @cindex http
17169
17170 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
17171 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
17172 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
17173 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
17174 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
17175 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
17176 even know what a news group is.
17177
17178 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
17179 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
17180 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
17181 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
17182 you mad in the end.
17183
17184 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
17185 to do it instead?
17186
17187 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
17188 interfaces to these sources.
17189
17190 @menu
17191 * Archiving Mail::
17192 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
17193 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
17194 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
17195 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
17196 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
17197 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
17198 @end menu
17199
17200 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
17201 alternatives to work.
17202
17203 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
17204 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
17205 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
17206 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
17207 though, you should be ok.
17208
17209 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
17210 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
17211 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
17212 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
17213 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
17214
17215 @node Archiving Mail
17216 @subsection Archiving Mail
17217 @cindex archiving mail
17218 @cindex backup of mail
17219
17220 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
17221 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
17222 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
17223 marks is fairly simple.
17224
17225 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
17226 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
17227 though.)
17228
17229 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
17230 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
17231 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
17232 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
17233 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
17234 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
17235 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
17236 before you restore the data.
17237
17238 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
17239 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
17240 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
17241 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
17242 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
17243 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
17244 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
17245 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
17246 is unnecessary in that case.
17247
17248 @node Web Searches
17249 @subsection Web Searches
17250 @cindex nnweb
17251 @cindex Google
17252 @cindex dejanews
17253 @cindex gmane
17254 @cindex Usenet searches
17255 @cindex searching the Usenet
17256
17257 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
17258 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
17259 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
17260 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
17261 searches without having to use a browser.
17262
17263 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
17264 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
17265 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
17266 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
17267 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
17268
17269 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
17270 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
17271 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
17272 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
17273 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
17274 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
17275 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
17276 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
17277 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
17278 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
17279 group as read.
17280
17281 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
17282 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
17283 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
17284 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
17285 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
17286 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
17287
17288 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
17289 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
17290 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
17291
17292 Virtual server variables:
17293
17294 @table @code
17295 @item nnweb-type
17296 @vindex nnweb-type
17297 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
17298 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
17299 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
17300
17301 @item nnweb-search
17302 @vindex nnweb-search
17303 The search string to feed to the search engine.
17304
17305 @item nnweb-max-hits
17306 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
17307 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
17308 999.
17309
17310 @item nnweb-type-definition
17311 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
17312 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
17313 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
17314 present:
17315
17316 @table @code
17317 @item article
17318 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
17319 understands.
17320
17321 @item map
17322 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
17323
17324 @item search
17325 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
17326
17327 @item address
17328 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
17329 to.
17330
17331 @item id
17332 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
17333 @end table
17334
17335 @end table
17336
17337
17338 @node Slashdot
17339 @subsection Slashdot
17340 @cindex Slashdot
17341 @cindex nnslashdot
17342
17343 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
17344 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
17345 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
17346
17347 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
17348 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17349
17350 @lisp
17351 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17352 '((nnslashdot "")))
17353 @end lisp
17354
17355 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
17356 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
17357 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
17358 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
17359 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
17360 Methods}).
17361
17362 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
17363 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
17364
17365 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
17366 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
17367 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
17368 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
17369 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
17370 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
17371 @acronym{HTML} forms.
17372
17373 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
17374
17375 @table @code
17376 @item nnslashdot-threaded
17377 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
17378 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
17379 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
17380 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
17381 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
17382 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
17383
17384 @item nnslashdot-login-name
17385 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
17386 The login name to use when posting.
17387
17388 @item nnslashdot-password
17389 @vindex nnslashdot-password
17390 The password to use when posting.
17391
17392 @item nnslashdot-directory
17393 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
17394 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
17395 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
17396
17397 @item nnslashdot-active-url
17398 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
17399 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
17400 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
17401 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
17402
17403 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
17404 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
17405 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
17406
17407 @item nnslashdot-article-url
17408 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
17409 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
17410 article. The default is
17411 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
17412
17413 @item nnslashdot-threshold
17414 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
17415 The score threshold. The default is -1.
17416
17417 @item nnslashdot-group-number
17418 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
17419 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
17420 updated. The default is 0.
17421
17422 @end table
17423
17424
17425
17426 @node Ultimate
17427 @subsection Ultimate
17428 @cindex nnultimate
17429 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
17430
17431 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
17432 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
17433 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
17434 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17435
17436 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
17437 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
17438 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
17439 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
17440 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
17441 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
17442 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
17443
17444 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
17445
17446 @table @code
17447 @item nnultimate-directory
17448 @vindex nnultimate-directory
17449 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
17450 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
17451 @end table
17452
17453
17454 @node Web Archive
17455 @subsection Web Archive
17456 @cindex nnwarchive
17457 @cindex Web Archive
17458
17459 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
17460 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
17461 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
17462 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
17463 groups updated.
17464
17465 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
17466 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
17467 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
17468 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
17469 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
17470 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
17471 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
17472 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
17473
17474 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
17475
17476 @table @code
17477 @item nnwarchive-directory
17478 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
17479 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
17480 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
17481
17482 @item nnwarchive-login
17483 @vindex nnwarchive-login
17484 The account name on the web server.
17485
17486 @item nnwarchive-passwd
17487 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
17488 The password for your account on the web server.
17489 @end table
17490
17491 @node RSS
17492 @subsection RSS
17493 @cindex nnrss
17494 @cindex RSS
17495
17496 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
17497 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
17498 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
17499 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
17500 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
17501
17502 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
17503 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17504
17505 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
17506 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
17507 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
17508 group names.
17509
17510 @kindex G R (Group)
17511 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
17512 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
17513 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
17514 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17515
17516 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17517 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17518 subscribe to groups.
17519
17520 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17521 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17522 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17523 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17524 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
17525 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
17526 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
17527 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
17528
17529 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17530 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17531 and a @samp{text/html} part.
17532
17533 @cindex OPML
17534 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17535 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17536 Markup Language).
17537
17538 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17539 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17540 file.
17541 @end defun
17542
17543 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17544 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17545 @acronym{OPML} format.
17546 @end defun
17547
17548 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17549
17550 @table @code
17551 @item nnrss-directory
17552 @vindex nnrss-directory
17553 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17554 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17555
17556 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17557 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17558 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17559 data files. The default is the value of
17560 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17561 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17562
17563 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17564 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17565 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17566 e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17567 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17568 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17569 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17570 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17571
17572 @item nnrss-use-local
17573 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17574 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17575 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17576 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17577 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17578 download script using @command{wget}.
17579
17580 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
17581 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
17582 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
17583 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
17584 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
17585 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
17586 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
17587 @samp{text/html} parts.
17588 @end table
17589
17590 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17591 the summary buffer.
17592
17593 @lisp
17594 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17595 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17596
17597 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17598 (let ((descr
17599 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17600 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17601 @end lisp
17602
17603 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17604 summary buffer.
17605
17606 @lisp
17607 (require 'browse-url)
17608
17609 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17610 (interactive "p")
17611 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17612 (mail-header-extra
17613 (gnus-data-header
17614 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17615 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17616 (if url
17617 (progn
17618 (browse-url (cdr url))
17619 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17620 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17621
17622 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17623 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17624 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17625 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17626 @end lisp
17627
17628 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17629 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17630 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17631 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17632 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17633 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17634 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17635 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17636 @code{nnrss} groups:
17637
17638 @lisp
17639 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17640 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17641 '(add-to-list
17642 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17643 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17644 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17645
17646 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17647 (add-to-list
17648 'gnus-parameters
17649 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17650 @end lisp
17651
17652
17653 @node Customizing W3
17654 @subsection Customizing W3
17655 @cindex W3
17656 @cindex html
17657 @cindex url
17658 @cindex Netscape
17659
17660 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17661 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17662 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17663 users.
17664
17665 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17666 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17667 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17668
17669 @lisp
17670 (eval-after-load "w3"
17671 '(progn
17672 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17673 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17674 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17675 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17676 (browse-url url)
17677 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17678 @end lisp
17679
17680 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17681 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17682 follow the link.
17683
17684
17685 @node IMAP
17686 @section IMAP
17687 @cindex nnimap
17688 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
17689
17690 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
17691 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
17692 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
17693 specify the network address of the server.
17694
17695 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
17696 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
17697 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
17698 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
17699 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
17700 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
17701
17702 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
17703 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
17704 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
17705 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
17706
17707 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
17708 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
17709 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
17710 usage explained in this section.
17711
17712 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
17713 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
17714 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
17715 see below.)
17716
17717 @lisp
17718 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17719 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
17720 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
17721 (nnimap "dolk"
17722 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17723 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
17724 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
17725 (nnimap "barbar"
17726 (nnimap-server-port 143)
17727 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17728 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
17729 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
17730 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
17731 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
17732 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
17733 (nnimap-stream network))
17734 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
17735 (nnimap "vic20"
17736 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
17737 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
17738 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
17739 @end lisp
17740
17741 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
17742 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
17743 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
17744 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
17745
17746 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
17747 server:
17748
17749 @table @code
17750
17751 @item nnimap-address
17752 @vindex nnimap-address
17753
17754 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
17755 server name if not specified.
17756
17757 @item nnimap-server-port
17758 @vindex nnimap-server-port
17759 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
17760
17761 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
17762
17763 @lisp
17764 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
17765 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
17766 @end lisp
17767
17768 @item nnimap-list-pattern
17769 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
17770 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
17771 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
17772 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
17773 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
17774 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
17775
17776 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
17777 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
17778 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
17779 mailbox.
17780
17781 Example server specification:
17782
17783 @lisp
17784 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
17785 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
17786 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
17787 @end lisp
17788
17789 @item nnimap-stream
17790 @vindex nnimap-stream
17791 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
17792 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
17793 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
17794 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
17795 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
17796
17797 Example server specification:
17798
17799 @lisp
17800 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
17801 (nnimap-stream ssl))
17802 @end lisp
17803
17804 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
17805
17806 @itemize @bullet
17807 @item
17808 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
17809 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
17810 @item
17811 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
17812 @item
17813 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
17814 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
17815 @samp{starttls}.
17816 @item
17817 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
17818 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
17819 @item
17820 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
17821 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
17822 @item
17823 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
17824 @item
17825 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
17826 @end itemize
17827
17828 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
17829 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
17830 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
17831 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
17832 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
17833 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
17834 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
17835 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
17836 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
17837 program.
17838
17839 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
17840 needed. It is available from
17841 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
17842
17843 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
17844 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
17845 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
17846 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
17847 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
17848 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
17849 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
17850 tried.
17851
17852 @vindex imap-ssl-program
17853 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
17854 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
17855 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
17856 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
17857 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
17858 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
17859 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
17860
17861 @vindex imap-shell-program
17862 @vindex imap-shell-host
17863 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the
17864 variable @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call. Make
17865 sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g., don't
17866 forget to redirect the error output to the void.
17867
17868 @item nnimap-authenticator
17869 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
17870
17871 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
17872 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
17873
17874 Example server specification:
17875
17876 @lisp
17877 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
17878 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
17879 @end lisp
17880
17881 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
17882
17883 @itemize @bullet
17884 @item
17885 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
17886 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
17887 @item
17888 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
17889 @code{imtest}.
17890 @item
17891 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
17892 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
17893 @item
17894 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
17895 @item
17896 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
17897 @item
17898 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
17899 @end itemize
17900
17901 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
17902 @cindex expunging
17903 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
17904 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
17905 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
17906 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
17907 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
17908 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
17909 similar).
17910
17911 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
17912 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
17913 running in circles yet?
17914
17915 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
17916 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
17917 variable.
17918
17919 The possible options are:
17920
17921 @table @code
17922
17923 @item always
17924 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
17925 closing a mailbox.
17926 @item never
17927 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
17928 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
17929 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
17930 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
17931 @item ask
17932 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
17933 articles or not.
17934
17935 @end table
17936
17937 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
17938 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
17939
17940 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
17941 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
17942 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
17943 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
17944 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
17945 has only one.)
17946
17947 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
17948 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
17949
17950 @lisp
17951 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
17952 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
17953 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
17954 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
17955 @end lisp
17956
17957 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
17958 as ticked for other users.
17959
17960 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
17961 @cindex expunging
17962 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
17963 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
17964
17965 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
17966 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
17967 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
17968 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
17969
17970 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
17971 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
17972 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
17973 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
17974
17975 However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
17976 is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
17977 is reversed, as described below.
17978
17979 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
17980 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
17981
17982 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
17983 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
17984 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
17985 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
17986
17987 @example
17988 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
17989 @end example
17990
17991 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
17992 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
17993 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
17994 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
17995 @code{port imap}.
17996
17997 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
17998 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
17999
18000 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
18001 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
18002 Courier 1.7.1 did.
18003
18004 @item nnimap-nov-is-evil
18005 @vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
18006 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18007 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
18008
18009 Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
18010 value of @code{gnus-agent}.
18011
18012 Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
18013 faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
18014 slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
18015 Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
18016 the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
18017 and false otherwise.
18018
18019 @item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18020 @vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18021 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18022 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18023
18024 Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
18025 @var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
18026 (notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
18027 @var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
18028
18029 When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
18030 list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
18031 these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
18032 like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
18033 to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
18034 see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
18035 @emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
18036 much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
18037 question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
18038
18039 This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
18040 everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
18041 messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
18042 if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
18043 cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
18044
18045 @item nnimap-logout-timeout
18046 @vindex nnimap-logout-timeout
18047
18048 There is a case where a connection to a @acronym{IMAP} server is unable
18049 to close, when connecting to the server via a certain kind of network,
18050 e.g. @acronym{VPN}. In that case, it will be observed that a connection
18051 between Emacs and the local network looks alive even if the server has
18052 closed a connection for some reason (typically, a timeout).
18053 Consequently, Emacs continues waiting for a response from the server for
18054 the @code{LOGOUT} command that Emacs sent, or hangs in other words. If
18055 you are in such a network, setting this variable to a number of seconds
18056 will be helpful. If it is set, a hung connection will be closed
18057 forcibly, after this number of seconds from the time Emacs sends the
18058 @code{LOGOUT} command. It should not be too small value but too large
18059 value will be inconvenient too. Perhaps the value 1.0 will be a good
18060 candidate but it might be worth trying some other values.
18061
18062 Example server specification:
18063
18064 @lisp
18065 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
18066 (nnimap-logout-timeout 1.0))
18067 @end lisp
18068
18069 @end table
18070
18071 @menu
18072 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
18073 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
18074 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
18075 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
18076 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
18077 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
18078 @end menu
18079
18080
18081
18082 @node Splitting in IMAP
18083 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
18084 @cindex splitting imap mail
18085
18086 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
18087 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
18088 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
18089 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
18090 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
18091
18092 And it does.
18093
18094 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
18095 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
18096 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
18097
18098 Here are the variables of interest:
18099
18100 @table @code
18101
18102 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
18103 @cindex splitting, crosspost
18104 @cindex crosspost
18105 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
18106
18107 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
18108 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
18109 found will be used.
18110
18111 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
18112
18113 @item nnimap-split-inbox
18114 @cindex splitting, inbox
18115 @cindex inbox
18116 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
18117
18118 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
18119 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
18120 splitting is disabled!
18121
18122 @lisp
18123 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
18124 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
18125 @end lisp
18126
18127 No nnmail equivalent.
18128
18129 @item nnimap-split-rule
18130 @cindex splitting, rules
18131 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
18132
18133 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
18134 this variable.
18135
18136 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
18137 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
18138 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
18139 Neither did I, we need examples.
18140
18141 @lisp
18142 (setq nnimap-split-rule
18143 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
18144 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
18145 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
18146 ("INBOX.private" "")))
18147 @end lisp
18148
18149 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
18150 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
18151 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
18152
18153 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
18154 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
18155 instance:
18156
18157 @lisp
18158 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
18159 @end lisp
18160
18161 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
18162 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
18163
18164 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
18165 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
18166 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
18167 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
18168
18169 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
18170 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
18171 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
18172 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
18173 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
18174 them every time you fetch new mail.)
18175
18176 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
18177 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
18178 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
18179
18180 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
18181 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
18182 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18183
18184 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
18185
18186 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
18187 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
18188 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
18189
18190 @lisp
18191 (setq nnimap-split-rule
18192 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
18193 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
18194 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
18195 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
18196 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
18197 @end lisp
18198
18199 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
18200 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
18201 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
18202 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
18203 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
18204 group/function elements.
18205
18206 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
18207
18208 @item nnimap-split-predicate
18209 @cindex splitting
18210 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
18211
18212 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
18213 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
18214
18215 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
18216 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
18217 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
18218 @samp{UNDELETED}.
18219
18220 @item nnimap-split-fancy
18221 @cindex splitting, fancy
18222 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
18223 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
18224
18225 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18226 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
18227 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
18228
18229 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
18230 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18231 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
18232 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18233
18234 Example:
18235
18236 @lisp
18237 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
18238 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
18239 @end lisp
18240
18241 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
18242
18243 @item nnimap-split-download-body
18244 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
18245 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
18246
18247 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
18248 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
18249 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
18250 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
18251
18252 @end table
18253
18254 @node Expiring in IMAP
18255 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
18256 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18257
18258 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
18259 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
18260 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
18261 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
18262 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
18263 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
18264 process.
18265
18266 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
18267 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
18268 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
18269 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
18270 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
18271 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
18272 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
18273 messages. Most do, fortunately.
18274
18275 If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
18276 variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
18277
18278 @table @code
18279
18280 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
18281 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
18282
18283 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
18284 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
18285
18286 @item nnmail-expiry-target
18287
18288 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
18289 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
18290 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
18291 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
18292
18293 @end table
18294
18295 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
18296 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
18297 @cindex editing imap acls
18298 @cindex Access Control Lists
18299 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
18300 @kindex G l (Group)
18301 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
18302
18303 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
18304 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
18305 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
18306 doesn't.
18307
18308 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
18309 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
18310 editing window with detailed instructions.
18311
18312 Some possible uses:
18313
18314 @itemize @bullet
18315 @item
18316 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
18317 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
18318 follow the list without subscribing to it.
18319 @item
18320 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
18321 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
18322 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
18323 INBOX.mailbox).
18324 @end itemize
18325
18326 @node Expunging mailboxes
18327 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
18328 @cindex expunging
18329
18330 @cindex expunge
18331 @cindex manual expunging
18332 @kindex G x (Group)
18333 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
18334
18335 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
18336 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
18337 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
18338
18339 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
18340 delete them.
18341
18342 @node A note on namespaces
18343 @subsection A note on namespaces
18344 @cindex IMAP namespace
18345 @cindex namespaces
18346
18347 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
18348 by the following text in the RFC2060:
18349
18350 @display
18351 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
18352
18353 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
18354 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
18355 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
18356 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
18357
18358 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
18359 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
18360 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
18361 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
18362 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
18363 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
18364 @end display
18365
18366 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
18367 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
18368 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
18369
18370 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
18371 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
18372 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
18373 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
18374 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
18375 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
18376 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
18377 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
18378 Gnus.
18379
18380 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
18381 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
18382 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
18383
18384 @node Debugging IMAP
18385 @subsection Debugging IMAP
18386 @cindex IMAP debugging
18387 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
18388
18389 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
18390 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
18391 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
18392 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
18393
18394 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
18395 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
18396 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
18397 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
18398 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
18399 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
18400 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
18401
18402
18403 @vindex imap-log
18404 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
18405 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
18406 follows:
18407
18408 @lisp
18409 (setq imap-log t)
18410 @end lisp
18411
18412 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
18413 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
18414 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
18415 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
18416 data.
18417
18418 @node Other Sources
18419 @section Other Sources
18420
18421 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
18422 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
18423 newsgroups.
18424
18425 @menu
18426 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
18427 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
18428 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
18429 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
18430 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
18431 @end menu
18432
18433
18434 @node Directory Groups
18435 @subsection Directory Groups
18436 @cindex nndir
18437 @cindex directory groups
18438
18439 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
18440 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
18441 names, of course.
18442
18443 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
18444 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
18445 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
18446 back end to read directories. Big deal.
18447
18448 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
18449 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
18450 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
18451 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
18452 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
18453
18454 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
18455
18456 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
18457 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
18458 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
18459 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
18460
18461
18462 @node Anything Groups
18463 @subsection Anything Groups
18464 @cindex nneething
18465
18466 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
18467 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
18468 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
18469 true.
18470
18471 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
18472 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
18473 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
18474 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
18475 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
18476 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
18477 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
18478 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
18479 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
18480 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
18481 elements.
18482
18483 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
18484 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
18485 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
18486 in the article buffer, just as usual.
18487
18488 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
18489 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
18490 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
18491 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
18492
18493 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
18494 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
18495 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
18496 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
18497 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
18498 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
18499 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
18500 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
18501
18502 Some variables:
18503
18504 @table @code
18505 @item nneething-map-file-directory
18506 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
18507 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
18508 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
18509
18510 @item nneething-exclude-files
18511 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
18512 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
18513 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
18514
18515 @item nneething-include-files
18516 @vindex nneething-include-files
18517 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
18518 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
18519
18520 @item nneething-map-file
18521 @vindex nneething-map-file
18522 Name of the map files.
18523 @end table
18524
18525
18526 @node Document Groups
18527 @subsection Document Groups
18528 @cindex nndoc
18529 @cindex documentation group
18530 @cindex help group
18531
18532 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
18533 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
18534
18535 @table @code
18536 @cindex Babyl
18537 @cindex Rmail mbox
18538 @item babyl
18539 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
18540
18541 @cindex mbox
18542 @cindex Unix mbox
18543 @item mbox
18544 The standard Unix mbox file.
18545
18546 @cindex MMDF mail box
18547 @item mmdf
18548 The MMDF mail box format.
18549
18550 @item news
18551 Several news articles appended into a file.
18552
18553 @cindex rnews batch files
18554 @item rnews
18555 The rnews batch transport format.
18556
18557 @item nsmail
18558 Netscape mail boxes.
18559
18560 @item mime-parts
18561 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
18562
18563 @item standard-digest
18564 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
18565
18566 @item mime-digest
18567 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
18568
18569 @item lanl-gov-announce
18570 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
18571
18572 @cindex forwarded messages
18573 @item rfc822-forward
18574 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
18575
18576 @item outlook
18577 The Outlook mail box.
18578
18579 @item oe-dbx
18580 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
18581
18582 @item exim-bounce
18583 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
18584
18585 @item forward
18586 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
18587
18588 @item rfc934
18589 An RFC934-forwarded message.
18590
18591 @item mailman
18592 A mailman digest.
18593
18594 @item clari-briefs
18595 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
18596
18597 @item slack-digest
18598 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
18599
18600 @item mail-in-mail
18601 The last resort.
18602 @end table
18603
18604 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
18605 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
18606 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
18607 file is.
18608
18609 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
18610 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
18611 group. And that's it.
18612
18613 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
18614 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
18615 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
18616 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
18617 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
18618 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
18619 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
18620 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
18621 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
18622 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
18623
18624 Virtual server variables:
18625
18626 @table @code
18627 @item nndoc-article-type
18628 @vindex nndoc-article-type
18629 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
18630 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
18631 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
18632 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
18633 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
18634
18635 @item nndoc-post-type
18636 @vindex nndoc-post-type
18637 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
18638 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
18639 and @code{news}.
18640 @end table
18641
18642 @menu
18643 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
18644 @end menu
18645
18646
18647 @node Document Server Internals
18648 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
18649
18650 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
18651 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
18652 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
18653 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
18654
18655 First, here's an example document type definition:
18656
18657 @example
18658 (mmdf
18659 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
18660 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
18661 @end example
18662
18663 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
18664 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
18665 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
18666 types can be defined with very few settings:
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @item first-article
18670 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
18671 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
18672 totally ignored.
18673
18674 @item article-begin
18675 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
18676 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
18677 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
18678 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
18679
18680 @item article-begin-function
18681 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
18682 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
18683
18684 @item head-begin
18685 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
18686 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
18687 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
18688
18689 @item head-begin-function
18690 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
18691 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
18692
18693 @item head-end
18694 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
18695 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
18696
18697 @item body-begin
18698 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
18699 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
18700 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
18701
18702 @item body-begin-function
18703 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
18704 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
18705
18706 @item body-end
18707 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
18708 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
18709 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
18710
18711 @item body-end-function
18712 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
18713 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
18714
18715 @item file-begin
18716 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
18717 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
18718
18719 @item file-end
18720 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
18721 regexp will be totally ignored.
18722
18723 @end table
18724
18725 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
18726 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
18727 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
18728 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
18729 something that's palatable for Gnus:
18730
18731 @table @code
18732 @item prepare-body-function
18733 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
18734 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
18735 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
18736
18737 @item article-transform-function
18738 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
18739 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
18740 body of the article.
18741
18742 @item generate-head-function
18743 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
18744 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
18745 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
18746 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
18747
18748 @item generate-article-function
18749 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
18750 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
18751 parameter when requesting all articles.
18752
18753 @item dissection-function
18754 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
18755 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
18756 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
18757 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
18758 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
18759 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
18760
18761 @end table
18762
18763 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
18764 digests:
18765
18766 @example
18767 (standard-digest
18768 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18769 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18770 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
18771 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
18772 (head-end . "^ ?$")
18773 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
18774 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
18775 (subtype digest guess))
18776 @end example
18777
18778 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
18779 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
18780 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
18781 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
18782 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
18783
18784 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
18785 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
18786 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
18787 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
18788 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
18789 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
18790 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
18791 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
18792 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
18793 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
18794 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
18795 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
18796
18797
18798 @node SOUP
18799 @subsection SOUP
18800 @cindex SOUP
18801 @cindex offline
18802
18803 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
18804 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
18805 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
18806
18807 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
18808 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
18809 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
18810 newsreaders.
18811
18812 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
18813 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
18814 that interested in doing things properly.
18815
18816 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
18817 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
18818 fiddly.
18819
18820 First some terminology:
18821
18822 @table @dfn
18823
18824 @item server
18825 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
18826 get news and/or mail from.
18827
18828 @item home machine
18829 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
18830 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
18831
18832 @item packet
18833 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
18834 of packets:
18835
18836 @table @dfn
18837 @item message packets
18838 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
18839 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
18840 default, where @var{x} is a number.
18841
18842 @item response packets
18843 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
18844 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
18845 default, where @var{x} is a number.
18846
18847 @end table
18848
18849 @end table
18850
18851
18852 @enumerate
18853
18854 @item
18855 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
18856 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
18857 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
18858 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
18859
18860 @item
18861 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
18862
18863 @item
18864 You put the packet in your home directory.
18865
18866 @item
18867 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
18868 the native or secondary server.
18869
18870 @item
18871 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
18872 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
18873
18874 @item
18875 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
18876 packet.
18877
18878 @item
18879 You transfer this packet to the server.
18880
18881 @item
18882 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
18883
18884 @item
18885 You then repeat until you die.
18886
18887 @end enumerate
18888
18889 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
18890 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
18891
18892 @menu
18893 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
18894 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
18895 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
18896 @end menu
18897
18898
18899 @node SOUP Commands
18900 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
18901
18902 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
18903
18904 @table @kbd
18905 @item G s b
18906 @kindex G s b (Group)
18907 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
18908 Pack all unread articles in the current group
18909 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
18910 process/prefix convention.
18911
18912 @item G s w
18913 @kindex G s w (Group)
18914 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
18915 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
18916
18917 @item G s s
18918 @kindex G s s (Group)
18919 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
18920 Send all replies from the replies packet
18921 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
18922
18923 @item G s p
18924 @kindex G s p (Group)
18925 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
18926 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
18927
18928 @item G s r
18929 @kindex G s r (Group)
18930 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
18931 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
18932
18933 @item O s
18934 @kindex O s (Summary)
18935 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
18936 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
18937 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
18938 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18939
18940 @end table
18941
18942
18943 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
18944 thingies:
18945
18946 @table @code
18947
18948 @item gnus-soup-directory
18949 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
18950 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
18951 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
18952
18953 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
18954 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
18955 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
18956 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
18957
18958 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
18959 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
18960 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
18961 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
18962
18963 @item gnus-soup-packer
18964 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
18965 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
18966 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
18967
18968 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
18969 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
18970 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
18971 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
18972
18973 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
18974 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
18975 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
18976
18977 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
18978 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
18979 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
18980 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
18981
18982 @end table
18983
18984
18985 @node SOUP Groups
18986 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
18987 @cindex nnsoup
18988
18989 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
18990 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
18991 you can read them at leisure.
18992
18993 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
18994
18995 @table @code
18996
18997 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
18998 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
18999 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
19000 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
19001
19002 @item nnsoup-directory
19003 @vindex nnsoup-directory
19004 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
19005 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
19006
19007 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
19008 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
19009 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
19010 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
19011
19012 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
19013 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
19014 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
19015 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
19016 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
19017
19018 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
19019 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
19020 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
19021 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
19022
19023 @item nnsoup-active-file
19024 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
19025 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
19026 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
19027 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
19028 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
19029
19030 @item nnsoup-packer
19031 @vindex nnsoup-packer
19032 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
19033 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
19034
19035 @item nnsoup-unpacker
19036 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
19037 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
19038 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
19039
19040 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
19041 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
19042 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
19043 @file{~/}.
19044
19045 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
19046 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
19047 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
19048 @samp{Soupout}.
19049
19050 @item nnsoup-always-save
19051 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
19052 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
19053
19054 @end table
19055
19056
19057 @node SOUP Replies
19058 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
19059
19060 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
19061 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
19062 more for that to happen.
19063
19064 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
19065 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
19066 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
19067 @sc{soup} system.
19068
19069 In specific, this is what it does:
19070
19071 @lisp
19072 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
19073 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
19074 @end lisp
19075
19076 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
19077 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
19078 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
19079
19080
19081 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
19082 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
19083 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
19084 @cindex gateways
19085
19086 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
19087 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
19088 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
19089
19090 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
19091 used to post with.
19092
19093 Server variables:
19094
19095 @table @code
19096 @item nngateway-address
19097 @vindex nngateway-address
19098 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
19099
19100 @item nngateway-header-transformation
19101 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
19102 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
19103 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
19104 transformation should be called, and defaults to
19105 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
19106 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
19107 gateway address.
19108
19109 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
19110 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
19111 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
19112
19113 @example
19114 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
19115 @end example
19116
19117 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
19118
19119 @example
19120 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
19121 @end example
19122
19123 The following pre-defined functions exist:
19124
19125 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19126 @table @code
19127
19128 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19129 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19130 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
19131
19132 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19133
19134 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19135 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19136 @code{nngateway-address}.
19137 @end table
19138
19139 @end table
19140
19141 Here's an example:
19142
19143 @lisp
19144 (setq gnus-post-method
19145 '(nngateway
19146 "mail2news@@replay.com"
19147 (nngateway-header-transformation
19148 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
19149 @end lisp
19150
19151 So, to use this, simply say something like:
19152
19153 @lisp
19154 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
19155 @end lisp
19156
19157
19158
19159 @node Combined Groups
19160 @section Combined Groups
19161
19162 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
19163 groups.
19164
19165 @menu
19166 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
19167 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
19168 @end menu
19169
19170
19171 @node Virtual Groups
19172 @subsection Virtual Groups
19173 @cindex nnvirtual
19174 @cindex virtual groups
19175 @cindex merging groups
19176
19177 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
19178 other groups.
19179
19180 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
19181 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
19182 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
19183
19184 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
19185 regexp to match component groups.
19186
19187 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
19188 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
19189 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
19190 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
19191 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
19192 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
19193 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
19194 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
19195
19196 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
19197 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
19198
19199 @lisp
19200 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
19201 @end lisp
19202
19203 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
19204 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
19205
19206 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
19207 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
19208 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
19209 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
19210
19211 @example
19212 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
19213 @end example
19214
19215 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
19216 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
19217 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
19218
19219 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
19220 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
19221 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
19222 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
19223 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
19224
19225 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
19226 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
19227 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
19228
19229 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
19230 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
19231 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
19232 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
19233 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
19234 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
19235 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
19236 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
19237 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
19238 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
19239 it---it'll have much the same effect.
19240
19241 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
19242 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
19243 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
19244 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
19245 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
19246 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
19247 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
19248
19249 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
19250 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
19251
19252 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
19253 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
19254 inherited.
19255
19256
19257 @node Kibozed Groups
19258 @subsection Kibozed Groups
19259 @cindex nnkiboze
19260 @cindex kibozing
19261
19262 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
19263 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
19264 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
19265 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
19266
19267 @kindex G k (Group)
19268 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
19269 buffer.
19270
19271 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
19272 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
19273 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
19274 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
19275
19276 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
19277 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
19278 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
19279
19280 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
19281 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
19282 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
19283 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
19284 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
19285 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
19286 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
19287 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
19288
19289 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
19290 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
19291 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
19292 Stranger things have happened.
19293
19294 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
19295 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
19296
19297 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
19298 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
19299 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
19300 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
19301 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
19302 information on what groups have been searched through to find
19303 component articles.
19304
19305 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
19306 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
19307
19308
19309 @node Email Based Diary
19310 @section Email Based Diary
19311 @cindex diary
19312 @cindex email based diary
19313 @cindex calendar
19314
19315 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
19316 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
19317 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
19318 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
19319 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
19320 namely, as event reminders.
19321
19322 Here is a typical scenario:
19323
19324 @itemize @bullet
19325 @item
19326 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
19327 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
19328 @item
19329 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
19330 @item
19331 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
19332 @item
19333 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
19334 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
19335 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
19336 @item
19337 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
19338 of the night you're gonna have.
19339 @item
19340 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
19341 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
19342 @end itemize
19343
19344 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
19345 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
19346 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
19347 explained in the sections below.
19348
19349 @menu
19350 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
19351 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
19352 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
19353 @end menu
19354
19355
19356 @node The NNDiary Back End
19357 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
19358 @cindex nndiary
19359 @cindex the nndiary back end
19360
19361 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
19362 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
19363 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
19364 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
19365 directory per group.
19366
19367 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
19368 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
19369 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
19370 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
19371
19372 @menu
19373 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
19374 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
19375 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
19376 @end menu
19377
19378 @node Diary Messages
19379 @subsubsection Diary Messages
19380 @cindex nndiary messages
19381 @cindex nndiary mails
19382
19383 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
19384 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
19385 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
19386 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
19387 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
19388 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
19389 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
19390
19391 @itemize @bullet
19392 @item
19393 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
19394 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
19395 (separated by a comma).
19396 @item
19397 A field is either an integer, or a range.
19398 @item
19399 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
19400 @item
19401 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
19402 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
19403 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
19404 @item
19405 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
19406 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
19407 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
19408 @item
19409 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
19410 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
19411 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
19412 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
19413 list of available time zone values, see the variable
19414 @code{nndiary-headers}.
19415 @end itemize
19416
19417 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
19418 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
19419 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
19420 what to do then):
19421
19422 @example
19423 X-Diary-Minute: 0
19424 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
19425 X-Diary-Dom: 1
19426 X-Diary-Month: *
19427 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
19428 X-Diary-Dow: 1
19429 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
19430 @end example
19431
19432 @node Running NNDiary
19433 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
19434 @cindex running nndiary
19435 @cindex nndiary operation modes
19436
19437 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
19438 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
19439 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
19440 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
19441 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
19442 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
19443
19444 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
19445 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
19446 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
19447 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
19448 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
19449 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
19450 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
19451 mode.
19452
19453 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
19454 things to do:
19455
19456 @itemize @bullet
19457 @item
19458 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
19459 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19460
19461 @lisp
19462 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
19463 @end lisp
19464 @item
19465 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
19466 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
19467 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
19468 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
19469 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
19470
19471 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
19472 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
19473
19474 @example
19475 :0 HD :
19476 * ^X-Diary
19477 .nndiary
19478 @end example
19479 @end itemize
19480
19481 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
19482 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
19483
19484 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
19485 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19486 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
19487 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
19488 @end defvar
19489
19490 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
19491 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19492 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
19493 @end defvar
19494
19495 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
19496 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
19497 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
19498
19499 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
19500 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
19501 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
19502 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
19503 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
19504
19505 @node Customizing NNDiary
19506 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
19507 @cindex customizing nndiary
19508 @cindex nndiary customization
19509
19510 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
19511 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
19512 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
19513 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
19514
19515 @defvar nndiary-reminders
19516 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
19517 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
19518 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
19519 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
19520 mail.
19521 @end defvar
19522
19523 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
19524 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
19525 default).
19526 @end defvar
19527
19528
19529 @node The Gnus Diary Library
19530 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
19531 @cindex gnus-diary
19532 @cindex the gnus diary library
19533
19534 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
19535 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
19536 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
19537 useful things for you.
19538
19539 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19540
19541 @lisp
19542 (require 'gnus-diary)
19543 @end lisp
19544
19545 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
19546 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
19547 (sorry if you used them before).
19548
19549
19550 @menu
19551 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
19552 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
19553 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
19554 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
19555 @end menu
19556
19557 @node Diary Summary Line Format
19558 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
19559 @cindex diary summary buffer line
19560 @cindex diary summary line format
19561
19562 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
19563 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
19564 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
19565 see the event's date.
19566
19567 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
19568 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
19569 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
19570 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
19571 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
19572
19573 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
19574 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
19575 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
19576
19577 @example
19578 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
19579 @end example
19580
19581 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
19582 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
19583
19584 @lisp
19585 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
19586 @end lisp
19587
19588 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
19589 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
19590 with the following user options:
19591
19592 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
19593 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
19594 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
19595 diary groups'parameters.
19596 @end defvar
19597
19598 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
19599 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
19600 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
19601 @end defvar
19602
19603 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
19604 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
19605 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
19606 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
19607 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
19608 @end defvar
19609
19610 @node Diary Articles Sorting
19611 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
19612 @cindex diary articles sorting
19613 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
19614 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
19615 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
19616 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
19617
19618 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
19619 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
19620 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
19621 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
19622 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
19623
19624 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
19625 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
19626 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
19627 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
19628 Parameters}).
19629
19630 @node Diary Headers Generation
19631 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
19632 @cindex diary headers generation
19633 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
19634
19635 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
19636 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
19637 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
19638 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
19639 needed.
19640
19641 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
19642 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
19643 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
19644 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
19645 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
19646
19647 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
19648 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
19649 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
19650 instance.
19651
19652 @node Diary Group Parameters
19653 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
19654 @cindex diary group parameters
19655
19656 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
19657 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
19658 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
19659 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
19660 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
19661 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
19662 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
19663 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
19664
19665 @node Sending or Not Sending
19666 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
19667
19668 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
19669 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
19670
19671 @itemize @bullet
19672 @item
19673 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
19674 messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
19675 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
19676 sending the diary message to them as well.
19677 @item
19678 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
19679 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
19680 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
19681 comes in very handy for private appointments.
19682 @end itemize
19683
19684 @node Gnus Unplugged
19685 @section Gnus Unplugged
19686 @cindex offline
19687 @cindex unplugged
19688 @cindex agent
19689 @cindex Gnus agent
19690 @cindex Gnus unplugged
19691
19692 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
19693 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
19694 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
19695 read news. Believe it or not.
19696
19697 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
19698 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
19699 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
19700 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
19701 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
19702
19703 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
19704 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
19705 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
19706 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
19707 reading news on a machine.
19708
19709 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
19710 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
19711 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
19712
19713 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
19714
19715 @menu
19716 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
19717 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
19718 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
19719 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
19720 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
19721 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
19722 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
19723 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
19724 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
19725 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
19726 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
19727 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
19728 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
19729 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
19730 @end menu
19731
19732
19733 @node Agent Basics
19734 @subsection Agent Basics
19735
19736 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
19737
19738 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
19739 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
19740 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
19741 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
19742
19743 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
19744 connected to the net continuously.
19745
19746 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
19747 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
19748
19749 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
19750 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
19751 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
19752 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
19753 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
19754
19755 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
19756 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
19757 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
19758 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
19759 they're kinda like plugged always).
19760
19761 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
19762 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
19763 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
19764 the culprit.
19765
19766 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
19767 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
19768 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
19769 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
19770 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
19771
19772 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
19773
19774 @itemize @bullet
19775
19776 @item
19777 @findex gnus-unplugged
19778 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
19779 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
19780 already fetched while in this mode.
19781
19782 @item
19783 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
19784 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
19785 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
19786 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
19787 Source Specifiers}).
19788
19789 @item
19790 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
19791 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
19792 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
19793 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
19794 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
19795
19796 @item
19797 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
19798 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
19799 then you read the news offline.
19800
19801 @item
19802 And then you go to step 2.
19803 @end itemize
19804
19805 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
19806 the Agent.
19807
19808 @itemize @bullet
19809
19810 @item
19811 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
19812 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
19813 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
19814 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
19815 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
19816 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
19817 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
19818 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
19819
19820 @item
19821 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
19822 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
19823 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
19824 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
19825
19826 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
19827 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
19828 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
19829 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
19830 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
19831 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
19832 configure them.
19833
19834 @item
19835 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
19836 @end itemize
19837
19838
19839 @node Agent Categories
19840 @subsection Agent Categories
19841
19842 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
19843 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
19844 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
19845 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
19846 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
19847 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
19848 you're interested in the articles anyway.
19849
19850 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
19851 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
19852 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
19853 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
19854 buffer for creating and managing categories.
19855
19856 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
19857 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
19858 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
19859 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
19860 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
19861 sink.
19862
19863 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
19864 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
19865 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
19866 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
19867 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
19868 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
19869 your settings.
19870
19871 @menu
19872 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
19873 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
19874 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
19875 @end menu
19876
19877
19878 @node Category Syntax
19879 @subsubsection Category Syntax
19880
19881 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
19882 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
19883 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
19884 listed below.
19885
19886 @cindex Agent Parameters
19887 @table @code
19888 @item agent-groups
19889 The list of groups that are in this category.
19890
19891 @item agent-predicate
19892 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
19893 are eligible for downloading; and
19894
19895 @item agent-score
19896 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
19897 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
19898 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
19899
19900 @item agent-enable-expiration
19901 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
19902 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
19903 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
19904 only groups that should not be expired.
19905
19906 @item agent-days-until-old
19907 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
19908 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
19909
19910 @item agent-low-score
19911 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
19912
19913 @item agent-high-score
19914 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
19915
19916 @item agent-short-article
19917 an integer that overrides the value of
19918 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
19919
19920 @item agent-long-article
19921 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
19922
19923 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
19924 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
19925 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
19926 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
19927 undownloaded faces.
19928 @end table
19929
19930 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
19931 created.
19932
19933 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
19934 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
19935 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
19936 category.
19937
19938 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
19939 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
19940 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
19941 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
19942
19943 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
19944 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
19945 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
19946
19947 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
19948 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
19949 operators sprinkled in between.
19950
19951 Perhaps some examples are in order.
19952
19953 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
19954 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
19955
19956 @lisp
19957 short
19958 @end lisp
19959
19960 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
19961 short (for some value of ``short'').
19962
19963 Here's a more complex predicate:
19964
19965 @lisp
19966 (or high
19967 (and
19968 (not low)
19969 (not long)))
19970 @end lisp
19971
19972 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
19973 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
19974 drift.
19975
19976 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
19977 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
19978 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
19979
19980 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
19981 you want to do, you can write your own.
19982
19983 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
19984 bound to the value determined by calling
19985 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
19986 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
19987 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
19988 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
19989 predicate to individual groups.
19990
19991 @table @code
19992 @item short
19993 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
19994 lines; default 100.
19995
19996 @item long
19997 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
19998 lines; default 200.
19999
20000 @item low
20001 True if the article has a download score less than
20002 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
20003
20004 @item high
20005 True if the article has a download score greater than
20006 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
20007
20008 @item spam
20009 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
20010 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
20011 checksum and sees whether articles match.
20012
20013 @item true
20014 Always true.
20015
20016 @item false
20017 Always false.
20018 @end table
20019
20020 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
20021 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
20022 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
20023 useful values.
20024
20025 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
20026 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
20027 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
20028 something along the lines of the following:
20029
20030 @lisp
20031 (defun my-article-old-p ()
20032 "Say whether an article is old."
20033 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
20034 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
20035 @end lisp
20036
20037 with the predicate then defined as:
20038
20039 @lisp
20040 (not my-article-old-p)
20041 @end lisp
20042
20043 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
20044 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
20045 wherever.
20046
20047 @lisp
20048 (require 'gnus-agent)
20049 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
20050 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
20051 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
20052 @end lisp
20053
20054 and simply specify your predicate as:
20055
20056 @lisp
20057 (not old)
20058 @end lisp
20059
20060 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
20061 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
20062 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
20063 just don't give a damn.
20064
20065 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
20066 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
20067 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
20068 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
20069 parameters like so:
20070
20071 @lisp
20072 (agent-predicate . short)
20073 @end lisp
20074
20075 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
20076 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
20077 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
20078
20079 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
20080
20081 @lisp
20082 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
20083 @end lisp
20084
20085 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
20086 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
20087 predicate is assumed to be a list.
20088
20089
20090 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
20091 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
20092 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
20093 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
20094 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
20095 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
20096
20097 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
20098 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
20099 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
20100 if it's to be specific to that group.
20101
20102 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
20103 three forms:
20104
20105 @enumerate
20106 @item
20107 Score rule
20108
20109 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
20110 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
20111
20112 example:
20113
20114 @itemize @bullet
20115 @item
20116 Category specification
20117
20118 @lisp
20119 (("from"
20120 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20121 ("lines"
20122 (500 -100 nil <)))
20123 @end lisp
20124
20125 @item
20126 Group/Topic Parameter specification
20127
20128 @lisp
20129 (agent-score ("from"
20130 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20131 ("lines"
20132 (500 -100 nil <)))
20133 @end lisp
20134
20135 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
20136 @end itemize
20137
20138 @item
20139 Agent score file
20140
20141 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
20142 keywords stated above.
20143
20144 example:
20145
20146 @itemize @bullet
20147 @item
20148 Category specification
20149
20150 @lisp
20151 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
20152 @end lisp
20153
20154 or perhaps
20155
20156 @lisp
20157 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
20158 @end lisp
20159
20160 @item
20161 Group Parameter specification
20162
20163 @lisp
20164 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
20165 @end lisp
20166
20167 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
20168 about parenthesis?
20169 @end itemize
20170
20171 @item
20172 Use @code{normal} score files
20173
20174 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
20175 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
20176 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
20177 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
20178
20179 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
20180 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
20181 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
20182 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
20183
20184 @itemize @bullet
20185 @item
20186 Category Specification
20187
20188 @lisp
20189 file
20190 @end lisp
20191
20192 @item
20193 Group Parameter specification
20194
20195 @lisp
20196 (agent-score . file)
20197 @end lisp
20198 @end itemize
20199 @end enumerate
20200
20201 @node Category Buffer
20202 @subsubsection Category Buffer
20203
20204 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
20205 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
20206 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
20207
20208 The following commands are available in this buffer:
20209
20210 @table @kbd
20211 @item q
20212 @kindex q (Category)
20213 @findex gnus-category-exit
20214 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
20215
20216 @item e
20217 @kindex e (Category)
20218 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
20219 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
20220 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
20221
20222 @item k
20223 @kindex k (Category)
20224 @findex gnus-category-kill
20225 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
20226
20227 @item c
20228 @kindex c (Category)
20229 @findex gnus-category-copy
20230 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
20231
20232 @item a
20233 @kindex a (Category)
20234 @findex gnus-category-add
20235 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
20236
20237 @item p
20238 @kindex p (Category)
20239 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
20240 Edit the predicate of the current category
20241 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
20242
20243 @item g
20244 @kindex g (Category)
20245 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
20246 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
20247 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
20248
20249 @item s
20250 @kindex s (Category)
20251 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
20252 Edit the download score rule of the current category
20253 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
20254
20255 @item l
20256 @kindex l (Category)
20257 @findex gnus-category-list
20258 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
20259 @end table
20260
20261
20262 @node Category Variables
20263 @subsubsection Category Variables
20264
20265 @table @code
20266 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
20267 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
20268 Hook run in category buffers.
20269
20270 @item gnus-category-line-format
20271 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
20272 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
20273 Variables}). Valid elements are:
20274
20275 @table @samp
20276 @item c
20277 The name of the category.
20278
20279 @item g
20280 The number of groups in the category.
20281 @end table
20282
20283 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
20284 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
20285 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
20286
20287 @item gnus-agent-short-article
20288 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
20289 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
20290
20291 @item gnus-agent-long-article
20292 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
20293 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
20294
20295 @item gnus-agent-low-score
20296 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
20297 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
20298 0.
20299
20300 @item gnus-agent-high-score
20301 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
20302 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
20303 0.
20304
20305 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
20306 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20307 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
20308 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
20309 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
20310 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
20311 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
20312 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
20313 read.
20314 Default 7.
20315
20316 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20317 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20318 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
20319 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
20320 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
20321 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
20322 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
20323
20324 @end table
20325
20326
20327 @node Agent Commands
20328 @subsection Agent Commands
20329 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
20330 @kindex J j (Agent)
20331
20332 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
20333 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
20334 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
20335
20336
20337 @menu
20338 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
20339 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
20340 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
20341 @end menu
20342
20343
20344
20345
20346 @node Group Agent Commands
20347 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
20348
20349 @table @kbd
20350 @item J u
20351 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
20352 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
20353 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
20354 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
20355
20356 @item J c
20357 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
20358 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
20359 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
20360
20361 @item J s
20362 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
20363 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
20364 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
20365 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
20366
20367 @item J S
20368 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
20369 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
20370 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
20371 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
20372
20373 @item J a
20374 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
20375 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
20376 Add the current group to an Agent category
20377 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
20378 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20379
20380 @item J r
20381 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
20382 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
20383 Remove the current group from its category, if any
20384 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
20385 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20386
20387 @item J Y
20388 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
20389 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20390 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
20391
20392
20393 @end table
20394
20395
20396 @node Summary Agent Commands
20397 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
20398
20399 @table @kbd
20400 @item J #
20401 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
20402 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
20403 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
20404
20405 @item J M-#
20406 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
20407 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
20408 Remove the downloading mark from the article
20409 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
20410
20411 @cindex %
20412 @item @@
20413 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
20414 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
20415 Toggle whether to download the article
20416 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
20417 default.
20418
20419 @item J c
20420 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
20421 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
20422 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
20423
20424 @item J S
20425 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
20426 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
20427 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
20428 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
20429
20430 @item J s
20431 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
20432 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
20433 Download all processable articles in this group.
20434 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
20435
20436 @item J u
20437 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
20438 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
20439 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
20440 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
20441
20442 @end table
20443
20444
20445 @node Server Agent Commands
20446 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
20447
20448 @table @kbd
20449 @item J a
20450 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
20451 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
20452 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
20453 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
20454
20455 @item J r
20456 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
20457 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
20458 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
20459 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
20460
20461 @end table
20462
20463
20464 @node Agent Visuals
20465 @subsection Agent Visuals
20466
20467 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
20468 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
20469 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
20470 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
20471 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
20472 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
20473 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
20474 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
20475 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
20476 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
20477
20478 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
20479 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
20480 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
20481 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
20482 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
20483 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
20484 the download status of each article so that you always know which
20485 articles will be available when unplugged.
20486
20487 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
20488 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
20489 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
20490 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
20491 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
20492 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
20493 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
20494 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
20495
20496 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
20497 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
20498 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
20499 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
20500 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
20501 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
20502 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
20503 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
20504 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
20505
20506 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
20507 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
20508 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
20509 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
20510 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
20511 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
20512 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
20513 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
20514 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
20515 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
20516
20517 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
20518 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
20519 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
20520 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
20521 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
20522 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
20523
20524 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
20525 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
20526 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
20527 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
20528 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
20529 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
20530 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
20531 expiring'' articles.
20532
20533 @node Agent as Cache
20534 @subsection Agent as Cache
20535
20536 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
20537 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
20538 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
20539 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
20540 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
20541 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
20542 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
20543 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
20544 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
20545
20546 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
20547 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
20548 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
20549 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
20550 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
20551
20552 @node Agent Expiry
20553 @subsection Agent Expiry
20554
20555 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20556 @findex gnus-agent-expire
20557 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
20558 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
20559 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
20560 @cindex agent expiry
20561 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
20562 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
20563
20564 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
20565 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
20566 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
20567 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
20568 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
20569 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
20570 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
20571 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
20572
20573 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
20574 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
20575 synchronized with the group.
20576
20577 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
20578 prevent expiration in selected groups.
20579
20580 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
20581 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
20582 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
20583 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
20584 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
20585 be kept indefinitely.
20586
20587 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
20588 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
20589 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
20590 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
20591
20592 @node Agent Regeneration
20593 @subsection Agent Regeneration
20594
20595 @cindex agent regeneration
20596 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
20597 @cindex regeneration
20598
20599 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
20600 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
20601 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
20602 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
20603 internal inconsistencies.
20604
20605 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
20606 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
20607 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
20608 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
20609 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
20610 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
20611
20612 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
20613 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
20614 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
20615 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
20616 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
20617 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
20618
20619 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20620 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20621 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
20622 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
20623 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
20624 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
20625 agent as unread.
20626
20627 @node Agent and flags
20628 @subsection Agent and flags
20629
20630 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
20631 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
20632 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
20633 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
20634 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
20635 to the flags in its own files.
20636
20637 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
20638 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
20639 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
20640
20641 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20642 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20643 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20644 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20645 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20646 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20647
20648 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
20649 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
20650 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
20651 in the group buffer.
20652
20653 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
20654 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
20655 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
20656 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
20657 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
20658 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
20659 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
20660 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
20661
20662 @node Agent and IMAP
20663 @subsection Agent and IMAP
20664
20665 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
20666 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
20667 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
20668 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
20669
20670 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
20671 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
20672
20673 @itemize @bullet
20674
20675 @item
20676 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
20677
20678 @item
20679 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
20680
20681 @end itemize
20682
20683 @node Outgoing Messages
20684 @subsection Outgoing Messages
20685
20686 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
20687 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
20688 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
20689
20690 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
20691 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
20692 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
20693
20694 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
20695 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
20696 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
20697 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
20698 mail at any time.
20699
20700 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
20701 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
20702 ask you to confirm your action (see
20703 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
20704
20705 @node Agent Variables
20706 @subsection Agent Variables
20707
20708 @table @code
20709 @item gnus-agent
20710 @vindex gnus-agent
20711 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
20712 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
20713 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
20714 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
20715
20716 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
20717 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
20718
20719
20720 @item gnus-agent-directory
20721 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
20722 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
20723 @file{~/News/agent/}.
20724
20725 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
20726 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
20727 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
20728 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
20729 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
20730 by default.
20731
20732 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20733 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20734 Hook run when connecting to the network.
20735
20736 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20737 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20738 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
20739
20740 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20741 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20742 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
20743
20744 @item gnus-agent-cache
20745 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
20746 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
20747 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
20748 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
20749
20750 @item gnus-agent-go-online
20751 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
20752 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
20753 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
20754 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
20755 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
20756 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
20757 online status.
20758
20759 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20760 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20761 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
20762 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
20763 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
20764 read. The default is @code{t}.
20765
20766 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20767 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20768 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20769 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20770 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20771 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20772 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20773
20774 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20775 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20776 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
20777 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
20778 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
20779 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
20780 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
20781 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
20782 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
20783 over and over again.
20784
20785 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20786 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20787 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
20788 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
20789 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
20790 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
20791 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
20792 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
20793 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
20794 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
20795 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
20796 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
20797 see any cycling.
20798
20799 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
20800 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
20801 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
20802 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
20803 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
20804 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
20805 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
20806 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
20807 is only valid if the Agent is used.
20808
20809 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20810 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20811 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
20812 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
20813 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
20814 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
20815
20816 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
20817 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
20818 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
20819 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
20820 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
20821
20822 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
20823 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
20824 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
20825 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
20826 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
20827 mail. The default is @code{t}.
20828
20829 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20830 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20831 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
20832 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
20833 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
20834
20835 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20836 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20837 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
20838 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
20839 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
20840 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
20841 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
20842 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
20843 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
20844 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
20845 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
20846
20847 @end table
20848
20849
20850 @node Example Setup
20851 @subsection Example Setup
20852
20853 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
20854 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
20855 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
20856
20857 @lisp
20858 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
20859 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
20860 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
20861
20862 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
20863 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
20864 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
20865
20866 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
20867 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
20868
20869 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
20870 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
20871 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
20872 @end lisp
20873
20874 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
20875 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
20876 gnus}.
20877
20878 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
20879 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
20880 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
20881 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
20882 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
20883 once.
20884
20885 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
20886 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
20887 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
20888 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
20889 back all the killed groups.)
20890
20891 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
20892 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
20893 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
20894
20895
20896 @node Batching Agents
20897 @subsection Batching Agents
20898 @findex gnus-agent-batch
20899
20900 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
20901 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
20902 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
20903
20904 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
20905 following incantation:
20906
20907 @example
20908 #!/bin/sh
20909 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
20910 @end example
20911
20912
20913 @node Agent Caveats
20914 @subsection Agent Caveats
20915
20916 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
20917 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
20918 may ask:
20919
20920 @table @dfn
20921 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
20922
20923 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
20924 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
20925 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
20926
20927 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
20928 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
20929
20930 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
20931
20932 @end table
20933
20934 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
20935 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
20936 locally stored articles.
20937
20938
20939 @node Scoring
20940 @chapter Scoring
20941 @cindex scoring
20942
20943 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
20944 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
20945 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
20946 attention!
20947
20948 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
20949 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
20950 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
20951 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
20952 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
20953
20954 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
20955 before generating the summary buffer.
20956
20957 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
20958 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
20959 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
20960
20961 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
20962 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
20963 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
20964 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
20965
20966 @menu
20967 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
20968 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
20969 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
20970 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
20971 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
20972 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
20973 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
20974 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
20975 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
20976 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
20977 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
20978 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
20979 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
20980 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
20981 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
20982 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
20983 @end menu
20984
20985
20986 @node Summary Score Commands
20987 @section Summary Score Commands
20988 @cindex score commands
20989
20990 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
20991 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
20992 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
20993 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
20994 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
20995
20996 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
20997 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
20998 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
20999 score file the current one.
21000
21001 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
21002
21003 @table @kbd
21004
21005 @item V s
21006 @kindex V s (Summary)
21007 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
21008 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
21009
21010 @item V S
21011 @kindex V S (Summary)
21012 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
21013 Display the score of the current article
21014 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
21015
21016 @item V t
21017 @kindex V t (Summary)
21018 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
21019 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
21020 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
21021 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
21022 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
21023 score file and edit it.
21024
21025 @item V w
21026 @kindex V w (Summary)
21027 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
21028 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
21029
21030 @item V R
21031 @kindex V R (Summary)
21032 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
21033 Run the current summary through the scoring process
21034 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
21035 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
21036 effect you're having.
21037
21038 @item V c
21039 @kindex V c (Summary)
21040 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
21041 Make a different score file the current
21042 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
21043
21044 @item V e
21045 @kindex V e (Summary)
21046 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
21047 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
21048 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
21049 File Editing}).
21050
21051 @item V f
21052 @kindex V f (Summary)
21053 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
21054 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
21055 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
21056
21057 @item V F
21058 @kindex V F (Summary)
21059 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21060 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
21061 after editing score files.
21062
21063 @item V C
21064 @kindex V C (Summary)
21065 @findex gnus-score-customize
21066 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
21067 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
21068
21069 @end table
21070
21071 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
21072
21073 @table @kbd
21074
21075 @item V m
21076 @kindex V m (Summary)
21077 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
21078 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
21079 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
21080
21081 @item V x
21082 @kindex V x (Summary)
21083 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
21084 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
21085 expunge all articles below this score
21086 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
21087 @end table
21088
21089 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
21090 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
21091 them.)
21092
21093 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
21094 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
21095
21096 @enumerate
21097 @item
21098 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
21099 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
21100 @item
21101 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
21102 keys are available:
21103 @table @kbd
21104
21105 @item a
21106 Score on the author name.
21107
21108 @item s
21109 Score on the subject line.
21110
21111 @item x
21112 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
21113
21114 @item r
21115 Score on the @code{References} line.
21116
21117 @item d
21118 Score on the date.
21119
21120 @item l
21121 Score on the number of lines.
21122
21123 @item i
21124 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
21125
21126 @item e
21127 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
21128 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
21129
21130 @item f
21131 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
21132 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
21133 @file{ADAPT} files.)
21134
21135 @item b
21136 Score on the body.
21137
21138 @item h
21139 Score on the head.
21140
21141 @item t
21142 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
21143 files.)
21144
21145 @end table
21146
21147 @item
21148 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
21149 what headers you are scoring on.
21150
21151 @table @code
21152
21153 @item strings
21154
21155 @table @kbd
21156
21157 @item e
21158 Exact matching.
21159
21160 @item s
21161 Substring matching.
21162
21163 @item f
21164 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
21165
21166 @item r
21167 Regexp matching
21168 @end table
21169
21170 @item date
21171 @table @kbd
21172
21173 @item b
21174 Before date.
21175
21176 @item a
21177 After date.
21178
21179 @item n
21180 This date.
21181 @end table
21182
21183 @item number
21184 @table @kbd
21185
21186 @item <
21187 Less than number.
21188
21189 @item =
21190 Equal to number.
21191
21192 @item >
21193 Greater than number.
21194 @end table
21195 @end table
21196
21197 @item
21198 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
21199 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
21200 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
21201 file.
21202 @table @kbd
21203
21204 @item t
21205 Temporary score entry.
21206
21207 @item p
21208 Permanent score entry.
21209
21210 @item i
21211 Immediately scoring.
21212 @end table
21213
21214 @item
21215 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
21216 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
21217 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
21218
21219 @end enumerate
21220
21221 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
21222 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
21223 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
21224 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
21225
21226 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
21227 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
21228 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
21229 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
21230 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
21231
21232 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
21233 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
21234 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
21235 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
21236 current score file.
21237
21238 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
21239 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
21240 pretend they are keymaps or not.
21241
21242
21243 @node Group Score Commands
21244 @section Group Score Commands
21245 @cindex group score commands
21246
21247 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
21248
21249 @table @kbd
21250
21251 @item W e
21252 @kindex W e (Group)
21253 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
21254 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
21255 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
21256
21257 @item W f
21258 @kindex W f (Group)
21259 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21260 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
21261 all the time. This command will flush the cache
21262 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
21263
21264 @end table
21265
21266 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
21267
21268 @findex gnus-batch-score
21269 @cindex batch scoring
21270 @example
21271 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
21272 @end example
21273
21274
21275 @node Score Variables
21276 @section Score Variables
21277 @cindex score variables
21278
21279 @table @code
21280
21281 @item gnus-use-scoring
21282 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
21283 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
21284 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
21285
21286 @item gnus-kill-killed
21287 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
21288 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
21289 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
21290 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
21291 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
21292 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
21293 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
21294
21295 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
21296 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
21297 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
21298 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
21299 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
21300
21301 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
21302 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
21303 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
21304 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
21305
21306 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21307 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21308 @cindex score cache
21309 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
21310 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
21311 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
21312 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
21313 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
21314 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
21315 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
21316 be cached.
21317
21318 @item gnus-save-score
21319 @vindex gnus-save-score
21320 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
21321 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
21322 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
21323
21324 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
21325 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
21326 across group visits.
21327
21328 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21329 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21330 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
21331 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
21332 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
21333 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
21334 manually entered data.
21335
21336 @item gnus-summary-default-score
21337 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
21338 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
21339
21340 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
21341 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
21342 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
21343 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
21344 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
21345 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
21346
21347 @item gnus-score-over-mark
21348 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
21349 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
21350 default. Default is @samp{+}.
21351
21352 @item gnus-score-below-mark
21353 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
21354 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
21355 default. Default is @samp{-}.
21356
21357 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21358 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21359 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
21360 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
21361
21362 Predefined functions available are:
21363 @table @code
21364
21365 @item gnus-score-find-single
21366 @findex gnus-score-find-single
21367 Only apply the group's own score file.
21368
21369 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
21370 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
21371 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
21372 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
21373 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
21374 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
21375 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
21376 then a regexp match is done.
21377
21378 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
21379 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
21380
21381 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
21382 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
21383 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
21384 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
21385
21386 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21387 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21388 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
21389 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
21390 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
21391 server.
21392
21393 @end table
21394 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
21395 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
21396 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
21397 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
21398 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
21399 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
21400 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
21401 Phu.
21402
21403 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
21404 overall score file, you could use the value
21405 @example
21406 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
21407 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
21408 @end example
21409
21410 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
21411 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
21412 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
21413 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
21414 are expired. It's 7 by default.
21415
21416 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21417 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21418 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
21419 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
21420 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
21421 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
21422 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
21423 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
21424
21425 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21426 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21427 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
21428
21429 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
21430 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
21431 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
21432 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
21433 threading---according to the current value of
21434 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
21435 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
21436 simplified in this manner.
21437
21438 @end table
21439
21440
21441 @node Score File Format
21442 @section Score File Format
21443 @cindex score file format
21444
21445 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
21446 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
21447 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
21448
21449 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
21450
21451 @lisp
21452 (("from"
21453 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
21454 ("Per Abrahamsen")
21455 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
21456 ("subject"
21457 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
21458 ("xref"
21459 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
21460 ("lines"
21461 (2 -100 nil <))
21462 (mark 0)
21463 (expunge -1000)
21464 (mark-and-expunge -10)
21465 (read-only nil)
21466 (orphan -10)
21467 (adapt t)
21468 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
21469 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
21470 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
21471 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
21472 (eval (ding)))
21473 @end lisp
21474
21475 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
21476 Scoring}, for a different approach.
21477
21478 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
21479 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
21480 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
21481
21482 Six keys are supported by this alist:
21483
21484 @table @code
21485
21486 @item STRING
21487 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
21488 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
21489 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
21490 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
21491 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
21492 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
21493 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
21494 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
21495 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
21496 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
21497 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
21498 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
21499 to articles that matches these score entries.
21500
21501 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
21502 score entry has one to four elements.
21503 @enumerate
21504
21505 @item
21506 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
21507 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
21508 integer.
21509
21510 @item
21511 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
21512 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
21513 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
21514 is successful. If this element is not present, the
21515 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
21516 instead. This is 1000 by default.
21517
21518 @item
21519 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
21520 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
21521 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
21522 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
21523 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
21524
21525 @item
21526 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
21527 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
21528 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
21529 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
21530 @table @dfn
21531
21532 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
21533 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
21534 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
21535 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
21536 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
21537 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
21538 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
21539 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
21540 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
21541 instead, if you feel like.
21542
21543 @item Extra
21544 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
21545 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
21546 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
21547 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
21548 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
21549 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
21550 overviews:
21551
21552 @lisp
21553 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
21554 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
21555 @end lisp
21556
21557 @item Lines, Chars
21558 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
21559 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
21560
21561 These predicates are true if
21562
21563 @example
21564 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
21565 @end example
21566
21567 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
21568 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
21569 following form:
21570
21571 @lisp
21572 (< header-value 4)
21573 @end lisp
21574
21575 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
21576 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
21577 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
21578 it's not. I think.)
21579
21580 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
21581 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
21582 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
21583 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
21584
21585 @item Date
21586 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
21587 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
21588 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
21589 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
21590 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
21591 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
21592 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
21593
21594 @cindex ISO8601
21595 @cindex date
21596 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
21597 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
21598 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
21599 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
21600 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
21601 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
21602 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
21603 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
21604 whole family, eh?)
21605
21606 @item Head, Body, All
21607 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
21608 header uses.
21609
21610 @item Followup
21611 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
21612 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
21613 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
21614 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
21615 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
21616 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
21617 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
21618 files.)
21619
21620 @item Thread
21621 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
21622 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
21623 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
21624 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
21625 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
21626 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
21627 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
21628 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
21629 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
21630 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
21631 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
21632 @end table
21633 @end enumerate
21634
21635 @cindex score file atoms
21636 @item mark
21637 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21638 lower than this number will be marked as read.
21639
21640 @item expunge
21641 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21642 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
21643
21644 @item mark-and-expunge
21645 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21646 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
21647 summary buffer.
21648
21649 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
21650 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
21651 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
21652 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
21653 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
21654
21655 @item files
21656 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
21657 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
21658 this one was.
21659
21660 @item exclude-files
21661 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
21662 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
21663 other.
21664
21665 @item eval
21666 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
21667 ignored when handling global score files.
21668
21669 @item read-only
21670 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
21671 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
21672 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
21673 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
21674
21675 @item orphan
21676 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
21677 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
21678 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
21679 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
21680
21681 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
21682
21683 @example
21684 (orphan -500)
21685 (mark-and-expunge -100)
21686 @end example
21687
21688 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
21689 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
21690 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
21691 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
21692 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
21693
21694 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
21695 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
21696 scoring rules exist.
21697
21698 @item adapt
21699 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
21700 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
21701 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
21702 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
21703 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
21704 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
21705 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21706 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
21707 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
21708 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
21709 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
21710 it.
21711
21712 @item adapt-file
21713 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
21714 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
21715 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
21716 file for a number of groups.
21717
21718 @item local
21719 @cindex local variables
21720 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
21721 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
21722 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
21723 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
21724 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
21725 be evaluated.
21726 @end table
21727
21728
21729 @node Score File Editing
21730 @section Score File Editing
21731
21732 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
21733 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
21734 with a mode for that.
21735
21736 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
21737 additional commands:
21738
21739 @table @kbd
21740
21741 @item C-c C-c
21742 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
21743 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
21744 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
21745 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
21746
21747 @item C-c C-d
21748 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
21749 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
21750 Insert the current date in numerical format
21751 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
21752 you were wondering.
21753
21754 @item C-c C-p
21755 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
21756 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
21757 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
21758 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
21759 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
21760 you.
21761
21762 @end table
21763
21764 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
21765
21766 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
21767 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
21768
21769 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
21770 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
21771
21772
21773 @node Adaptive Scoring
21774 @section Adaptive Scoring
21775 @cindex adaptive scoring
21776
21777 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
21778 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
21779 stupidity, to be precise.
21780
21781 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
21782 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
21783 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
21784 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
21785 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21786 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
21787 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
21788 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
21789 variable to @code{(word line)}.
21790
21791 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21792 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
21793 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
21794 might look something like this:
21795
21796 @lisp
21797 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21798 '((gnus-unread-mark)
21799 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
21800 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
21801 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
21802 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
21803 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
21804 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
21805 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
21806 (gnus-ancient-mark)
21807 (gnus-low-score-mark)
21808 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
21809 @end lisp
21810
21811 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
21812 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
21813 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
21814 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
21815 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
21816 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
21817 entries.
21818
21819 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
21820 will be applied to each article.
21821
21822 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
21823 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
21824 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
21825 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
21826
21827 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
21828 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
21829 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
21830 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
21831
21832 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
21833 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
21834 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
21835 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
21836
21837 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
21838 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
21839 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
21840 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
21841 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
21842 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
21843
21844 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
21845 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
21846 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
21847
21848 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
21849 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
21850 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
21851
21852 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
21853 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
21854 let you use different rules in different groups.
21855
21856 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
21857 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
21858 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
21859 is @file{ADAPT}.
21860
21861 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
21862 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
21863 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
21864 deafult) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
21865
21866 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
21867 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
21868 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
21869 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
21870 the length of the match is less than
21871 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
21872 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
21873 this problem.
21874
21875 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21876 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
21877 headers. If you adapt on words, the
21878 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
21879 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
21880
21881 @lisp
21882 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21883 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
21884 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
21885 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
21886 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
21887 @end lisp
21888
21889 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
21890 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
21891 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
21892 score with 30 points.
21893
21894 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
21895 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
21896 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
21897 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
21898 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
21899
21900 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
21901 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
21902 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
21903 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
21904 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
21905
21906 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
21907 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
21908 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
21909 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
21910
21911 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
21912 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
21913 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
21914 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
21915
21916 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
21917 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
21918 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
21919 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
21920 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
21921
21922 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
21923 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
21924 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
21925
21926 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
21927 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
21928 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
21929 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
21930
21931
21932 @node Home Score File
21933 @section Home Score File
21934
21935 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
21936 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
21937 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
21938 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
21939
21940 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
21941 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
21942 could perhaps use the same home score file.
21943
21944 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
21945 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
21946 be:
21947
21948 @enumerate
21949 @item
21950 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
21951 groups.
21952
21953 @item
21954 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
21955 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
21956 parameter.
21957
21958 @item
21959 A list. The elements in this list can be:
21960
21961 @enumerate
21962 @item
21963 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
21964 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
21965
21966 @item
21967 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
21968 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
21969 name of the group as the parameter.
21970
21971 @item
21972 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
21973 @end enumerate
21974
21975 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
21976 for matches.
21977
21978 @end enumerate
21979
21980 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
21981
21982 @lisp
21983 (setq gnus-home-score-file
21984 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
21985 @end lisp
21986
21987 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
21988 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
21989
21990 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
21991 @lisp
21992 (setq gnus-home-score-file
21993 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
21994 @end lisp
21995
21996 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
21997 Other functions include
21998
21999 @table @code
22000 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
22001 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
22002 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
22003 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
22004
22005 @end table
22006
22007 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
22008 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
22009 their own home score files:
22010
22011 @lisp
22012 (setq gnus-home-score-file
22013 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
22014 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
22015 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
22016 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
22017 @end lisp
22018
22019 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
22020 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
22021 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
22022 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
22023 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
22024
22025 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
22026 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
22027 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
22028 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
22029 precedence over this variable.
22030
22031
22032 @node Followups To Yourself
22033 @section Followups To Yourself
22034
22035 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
22036 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
22037 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
22038 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
22039 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
22040 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
22041
22042 @table @code
22043
22044 @item gnus-score-followup-article
22045 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
22046 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
22047 article.
22048
22049 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
22050 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
22051 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
22052 your own article.
22053 @end table
22054
22055 @vindex message-sent-hook
22056 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
22057 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
22058 @lisp
22059 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
22060 @end lisp
22061
22062
22063 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
22064 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
22065 mine:
22066
22067 @example
22068 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22069 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22070 @end example
22071
22072 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
22073 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
22074 myself:
22075
22076 @lisp
22077 ("references"
22078 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
22079 1000 nil r))
22080 @end lisp
22081
22082 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
22083 is system-dependent.
22084
22085
22086 @node Scoring On Other Headers
22087 @section Scoring On Other Headers
22088 @cindex scoring on other headers
22089
22090 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
22091 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
22092 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
22093 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
22094 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
22095
22096 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
22097 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
22098 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
22099 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
22100 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
22101 inhibited for all groups.
22102
22103 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
22104 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
22105 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
22106 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
22107 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
22108
22109 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22110
22111 @lisp
22112 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
22113 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
22114 @end lisp
22115
22116 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
22117 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
22118 time if you have much mail.
22119
22120 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
22121 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
22122
22123 See? Simple.
22124
22125
22126 @node Scoring Tips
22127 @section Scoring Tips
22128 @cindex scoring tips
22129
22130 @table @dfn
22131
22132 @item Crossposts
22133 @cindex crossposts
22134 @cindex scoring crossposts
22135 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
22136 the @code{Xref} header.
22137 @lisp
22138 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
22139 @end lisp
22140
22141 @item Multiple crossposts
22142 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
22143 more than, say, 3 groups:
22144 @lisp
22145 ("xref"
22146 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
22147 -1000 nil r))
22148 @end lisp
22149
22150 @item Matching on the body
22151 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
22152 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
22153 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
22154 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
22155 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
22156 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
22157 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
22158 the matches.
22159
22160 @item Marking as read
22161 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
22162 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
22163 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
22164 @lisp
22165 ((mark -100))
22166 @end lisp
22167 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
22168
22169 @item Negated character classes
22170 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
22171 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
22172 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
22173 @end table
22174
22175
22176 @node Reverse Scoring
22177 @section Reverse Scoring
22178 @cindex reverse scoring
22179
22180 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
22181 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
22182 like this in your score file:
22183
22184 @lisp
22185 (("subject"
22186 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
22187 (mark 1)
22188 (expunge 1))
22189 @end lisp
22190
22191 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
22192 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
22193
22194
22195 @node Global Score Files
22196 @section Global Score Files
22197 @cindex global score files
22198
22199 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
22200 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
22201 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
22202
22203 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
22204 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
22205 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
22206
22207 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
22208 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
22209 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
22210 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
22211 files are applicable to which group.
22212
22213 To use the score file
22214 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
22215 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
22216 say this:
22217
22218 @lisp
22219 (setq gnus-global-score-files
22220 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
22221 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
22222 @end lisp
22223
22224 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
22225 @noindent
22226 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
22227 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
22228 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
22229 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
22230
22231 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
22232 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
22233
22234 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
22235 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
22236 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
22237 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
22238 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
22239 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
22240
22241 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
22242 head:
22243
22244 @itemize @bullet
22245
22246 @item
22247 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
22248 @item
22249 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
22250 @item
22251 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
22252 @item
22253 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
22254 lowered out of existence.
22255 @item
22256 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
22257 articles completely.
22258
22259 @item
22260 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
22261 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
22262 old articles for a long time.
22263 @end itemize
22264
22265 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
22266 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
22267 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
22268 holding our breath yet?
22269
22270
22271 @node Kill Files
22272 @section Kill Files
22273 @cindex kill files
22274
22275 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
22276 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
22277 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
22278
22279 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
22280 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
22281 files into score files.
22282
22283 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
22284 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
22285 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
22286 that isn't a very good idea.
22287
22288 Normal kill files look like this:
22289
22290 @lisp
22291 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22292 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
22293 (gnus-expunge "X")
22294 @end lisp
22295
22296 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
22297 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
22298
22299 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
22300 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
22301 interpreting it.
22302
22303 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
22304
22305 @table @kbd
22306
22307 @item M-k
22308 @kindex M-k (Summary)
22309 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
22310 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
22311
22312 @item M-K
22313 @kindex M-K (Summary)
22314 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
22315 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
22316 @end table
22317
22318 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
22319
22320 @table @kbd
22321
22322 @item M-k
22323 @kindex M-k (Group)
22324 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
22325 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
22326
22327 @item M-K
22328 @kindex M-K (Group)
22329 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
22330 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
22331 @end table
22332
22333 Kill file variables:
22334
22335 @table @code
22336 @item gnus-kill-file-name
22337 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
22338 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
22339 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
22340 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
22341 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
22342 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
22343
22344 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22345 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22346 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
22347 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
22348 kills.
22349
22350 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
22351 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
22352 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
22353 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
22354 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
22355 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
22356 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
22357 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
22358 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
22359
22360 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22361 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22362 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
22363
22364 @end table
22365
22366
22367 @node Converting Kill Files
22368 @section Converting Kill Files
22369 @cindex kill files
22370 @cindex converting kill files
22371
22372 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
22373 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
22374 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
22375 by hand.
22376
22377 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
22378 You can fetch it from
22379 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
22380
22381 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
22382 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
22383 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
22384 before.
22385
22386
22387 @node Advanced Scoring
22388 @section Advanced Scoring
22389
22390 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
22391 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
22392 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
22393 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
22394 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
22395
22396 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
22397 scoring patterns.
22398
22399 @menu
22400 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
22401 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
22402 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
22403 @end menu
22404
22405
22406 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
22407 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
22408
22409 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
22410 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
22411 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
22412 non-@code{nil} value.
22413
22414 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
22415 operator, and various match operators.
22416
22417 Logical operators:
22418
22419 @table @code
22420 @item &
22421 @itemx and
22422 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22423 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
22424 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
22425 @code{true}.
22426
22427 @item |
22428 @itemx or
22429 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22430 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
22431 then this operator will return @code{false}.
22432
22433 @item !
22434 @itemx not
22435 @itemx ¬
22436 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
22437 logical negation of the value of its argument.
22438
22439 @end table
22440
22441 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
22442 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
22443 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
22444 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
22445 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
22446 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
22447 the ancestry you want to go.
22448
22449 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
22450 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
22451 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
22452 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
22453 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
22454
22455
22456 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
22457 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
22458
22459 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
22460 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
22461 of parentheses.
22462
22463 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
22464 when he's talking about Gnus:
22465
22466 @example
22467 @group
22468 ((&
22469 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22470 ("subject" "Gnus"))
22471 1000)
22472 @end group
22473 @end example
22474
22475 Quite simple, huh?
22476
22477 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
22478
22479 @example
22480 ((&
22481 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22482 (|
22483 ("subject" "Gnus")
22484 ("lines" 100 >)))
22485 1000)
22486 @end example
22487
22488 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
22489 really don't want to read what he's written:
22490
22491 @example
22492 ((&
22493 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22494 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
22495 -100000)
22496 @end example
22497
22498 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
22499 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
22500 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
22501 very interesting:
22502
22503 @example
22504 ((&
22505 (1-
22506 (&
22507 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
22508 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
22509 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
22510 ("body" "white.*socks"))
22511 1000)
22512 @end example
22513
22514 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
22515 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
22516 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
22517 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
22518
22519 @example
22520 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
22521 -200)
22522 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
22523 200)
22524 @end example
22525
22526 The possibilities are endless.
22527
22528 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
22529 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
22530
22531 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
22532 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
22533 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
22534 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
22535 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
22536 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
22537 @samp{subject}) first.
22538
22539 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
22540 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
22541 something like:
22542
22543 @example
22544 ...
22545 (1-
22546 (1-
22547 ("from" "lars")))
22548 ...
22549 @end example
22550
22551 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
22552 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
22553
22554 @example
22555 (1-
22556 (&
22557 ("from" "Lars")
22558 ("subject" "Gnus")))
22559 @end example
22560
22561 than it is to say:
22562
22563 @example
22564 (&
22565 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
22566 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
22567 @end example
22568
22569
22570 @node Score Decays
22571 @section Score Decays
22572 @cindex score decays
22573 @cindex decays
22574
22575 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
22576 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
22577 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
22578 use them in any sensible way.
22579
22580 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
22581 @findex gnus-decay-score
22582 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
22583 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
22584 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
22585 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
22586 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
22587 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
22588 regexp are treated. E.g. you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
22589 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
22590 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
22591 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
22592 function:
22593
22594 @lisp
22595 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
22596 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
22597 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
22598 (let ((n (- score
22599 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
22600 (min (abs score)
22601 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
22602 (* (abs score)
22603 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
22604 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
22605 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
22606 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
22607 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
22608 (string-to-number
22609 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
22610 (floor n))))
22611 @end lisp
22612
22613 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
22614 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
22615 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
22616 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
22617
22618 @enumerate
22619 @item
22620 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
22621
22622 @item
22623 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
22624
22625 @item
22626 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
22627 score.
22628 @end enumerate
22629
22630 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
22631 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
22632 the new score, which should be an integer.
22633
22634 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
22635 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
22636
22637 @iftex
22638 @iflatex
22639 @chapter Message
22640 @include message.texi
22641 @chapter Emacs MIME
22642 @include emacs-mime.texi
22643 @chapter Sieve
22644 @include sieve.texi
22645 @chapter PGG
22646 @include pgg.texi
22647 @chapter SASL
22648 @include sasl.texi
22649 @end iflatex
22650 @end iftex
22651
22652 @node Various
22653 @chapter Various
22654
22655 @menu
22656 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22657 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22658 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22659 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22660 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22661 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22662 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
22663 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22664 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22665 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
22666 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22667 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
22668 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22669 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22670 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22671 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22672 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22673 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22674 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22675 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22676 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22677 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22678 @end menu
22679
22680
22681 @node Process/Prefix
22682 @section Process/Prefix
22683 @cindex process/prefix convention
22684
22685 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22686 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22687
22688 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22689 command to be performed on.
22690
22691 It goes like this:
22692
22693 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22694 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22695 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22696 with the current one.
22697
22698 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22699 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22700 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22701
22702 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22703 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22704 the process mark.
22705
22706 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22707 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22708
22709 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22710 are avoided.
22711
22712 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22713 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22714 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22715 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22716
22717 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22718 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22719 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22720 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22721 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22722 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22723 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22724 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22725
22726 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22727 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22728 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22729 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22730 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22731
22732
22733 @node Interactive
22734 @section Interactive
22735 @cindex interaction
22736
22737 @table @code
22738
22739 @item gnus-novice-user
22740 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22741 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22742 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22743 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22744 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22745 default.
22746
22747 @item gnus-expert-user
22748 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22749 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22750 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
22751 matter how strange.
22752
22753 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22754 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22755 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22756 is @code{t} by default.
22757
22758 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22759 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22760 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
22761 default.
22762 @end table
22763
22764
22765 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22766 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22767 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22768
22769 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22770 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22771 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22772 rule of 900 to the current article.
22773
22774 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22775 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22776 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22777 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22778 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22779 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22780 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22781
22782 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22783 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22784 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22785 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22786 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22787 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22788 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22789 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22790 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22791
22792 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22793 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22794 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22795
22796 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22797 Interactive}.
22798
22799
22800 @node Formatting Variables
22801 @section Formatting Variables
22802 @cindex formatting variables
22803
22804 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22805 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22806 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22807 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22808 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22809 be annoyed by.
22810
22811 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22812 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22813 lots of percentages everywhere.
22814
22815 @menu
22816 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22817 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22818 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22819 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22820 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22821 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22822 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22823 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22824 @end menu
22825
22826 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22827 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22828 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22829 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22830 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22831 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22832 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22833 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22834
22835 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22836 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22837
22838 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22839 @findex gnus-update-format
22840 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22841 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22842 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22843 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22844
22845
22846
22847 @node Formatting Basics
22848 @subsection Formatting Basics
22849
22850 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22851 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22852 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22853
22854 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22855 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22856 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22857 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22858 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22859 the right instead.
22860
22861 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22862 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22863 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22864 less than 4 characters wide.
22865
22866 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22867 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22868
22869
22870 @node Mode Line Formatting
22871 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22872
22873 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22874 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22875 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22876 with the following two differences:
22877
22878 @enumerate
22879
22880 @item
22881 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22882
22883 @item
22884 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22885 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22886 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22887 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22888 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22889 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22890 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22891
22892 @end enumerate
22893
22894
22895 @node Advanced Formatting
22896 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22897
22898 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22899 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22900 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22901 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22902
22903 These are the valid modifiers:
22904
22905 @table @code
22906 @item pad
22907 @itemx pad-left
22908 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22909 length.
22910
22911 @item pad-right
22912 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22913 length.
22914
22915 @item max
22916 @itemx max-left
22917 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22918
22919 @item max-right
22920 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22921 length.
22922
22923 @item cut
22924 @itemx cut-left
22925 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22926
22927 @item cut-right
22928 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22929
22930 @item ignore
22931 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22932
22933 @item form
22934 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22935 used.
22936
22937 Here's an example:
22938
22939 @lisp
22940 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22941 @end lisp
22942
22943 @end table
22944
22945 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22946 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22947 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22948 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22949 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22950 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22951 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22952
22953 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22954 last operation, padding.
22955
22956 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
22957 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
22958 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
22959 @xref{Compilation}.
22960
22961
22962 @node User-Defined Specs
22963 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22964
22965 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22966 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22967 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22968 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22969 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22970 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22971 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22972 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22973 should protect against that.
22974
22975 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22976 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22977
22978 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22979 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22980 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22981 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22982 inserted.
22983
22984
22985 @node Formatting Fonts
22986 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22987
22988 @cindex %(, %)
22989 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22990 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22991 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22992 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22993 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22994 over it.
22995
22996 @cindex %@{, %@}
22997 @vindex gnus-face-0
22998 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22999 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
23000 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
23001 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
23002 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
23003 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
23004
23005 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
23006 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
23007 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
23008 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
23009 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
23010 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
23011 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
23012 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
23013 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
23014 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
23015 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
23016 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
23017 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
23018 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
23019 paragraph.)
23020
23021 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
23022
23023 @lisp
23024 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
23025 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
23026 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
23027
23028 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
23029 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
23030 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
23031 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
23032 ;; @r{Set the color.}
23033 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
23034 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
23035
23036 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
23037 (setq gnus-group-line-format
23038 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
23039 @end lisp
23040
23041 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
23042 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
23043
23044 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
23045 mode-line variables.
23046
23047 @node Positioning Point
23048 @subsection Positioning Point
23049
23050 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
23051 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
23052 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
23053
23054 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
23055
23056 @findex gnus-goto-colon
23057 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
23058 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
23059
23060 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
23061 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
23062 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
23063 place point there.
23064
23065
23066 @node Tabulation
23067 @subsection Tabulation
23068
23069 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
23070 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
23071 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
23072 about lining up the following text afterwards.
23073
23074 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
23075 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
23076
23077 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
23078 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
23079 This is the soft tabulator.
23080
23081 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
23082 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
23083 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
23084
23085
23086 @node Wide Characters
23087 @subsection Wide Characters
23088
23089 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
23090 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
23091 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
23092
23093 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
23094 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
23095 these countries, that's not true.
23096
23097 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
23098 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
23099 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
23100 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
23101 for Emacs.
23102
23103
23104 @node Window Layout
23105 @section Window Layout
23106 @cindex window layout
23107
23108 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
23109
23110 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
23111 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
23112 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
23113 @code{t} by default.
23114
23115 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
23116 glitches. Use at your own peril.
23117
23118 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
23119 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
23120 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
23121
23122 @lisp
23123 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
23124 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
23125 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
23126 (article 1.0))))
23127 @end lisp
23128
23129 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
23130 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
23131 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
23132 possible names is listed below.
23133
23134 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
23135 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
23136
23137 @lisp
23138 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
23139 (article 1.0)))
23140 @end lisp
23141
23142 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
23143 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
23144 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
23145 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
23146 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
23147 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
23148 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
23149 size spec per split.
23150
23151 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
23152 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
23153 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
23154 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
23155 present) gets focus.
23156
23157 Here's a more complicated example:
23158
23159 @lisp
23160 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
23161 (summary 0.25 point)
23162 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
23163 (article 1.0)))
23164 @end lisp
23165
23166 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
23167 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
23168 occupy, not a percentage.
23169
23170 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
23171 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
23172 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
23173 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
23174 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
23175 is non-@code{nil}.
23176
23177 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
23178
23179 @lisp
23180 (article (horizontal 1.0
23181 (vertical 0.5
23182 (group 1.0)
23183 (gnus-carpal 4))
23184 (vertical 1.0
23185 (summary 0.25 point)
23186 (summary-carpal 4)
23187 (article 1.0))))
23188 @end lisp
23189
23190 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
23191 @code{horizontal} thingie?
23192
23193 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
23194 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
23195 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
23196 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
23197 the screen is to be given to this strip.
23198
23199 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
23200 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
23201 lines from the splits.
23202
23203 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
23204 may look like:
23205
23206 @example
23207 @group
23208 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
23209 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
23210 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
23211 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
23212 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
23213 size = number | frame-params
23214 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
23215 @end group
23216 @end example
23217
23218 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
23219 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
23220 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
23221 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
23222
23223 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
23224 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
23225 @cindex window height
23226 @cindex window width
23227 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
23228 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
23229 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
23230 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
23231 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
23232 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
23233
23234 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
23235 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
23236 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
23237 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
23238
23239 @findex gnus-configure-frame
23240 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
23241 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
23242 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
23243 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
23244 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
23245 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
23246 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
23247 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
23248 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
23249 configuration list.
23250
23251 @lisp
23252 (gnus-configure-frame
23253 '(horizontal 1.0
23254 (vertical 10
23255 (group 1.0)
23256 (article 0.3 point))
23257 (vertical 1.0
23258 (article 1.0)
23259 (horizontal 4
23260 (group 1.0)
23261 (article 10)))))
23262 @end lisp
23263
23264 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
23265 @code{frame} split:
23266
23267 @lisp
23268 (gnus-configure-frame
23269 '(frame 1.0
23270 (vertical 1.0
23271 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
23272 (article 1.0))
23273 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
23274 (user-position . t)
23275 (left . -1) (top . 1))
23276 (picon 1.0))))
23277
23278 @end lisp
23279
23280 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
23281 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
23282 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
23283 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
23284 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
23285 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
23286 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
23287 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
23288 is such a plist.
23289 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
23290 be found in its default value.
23291
23292 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
23293 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
23294 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
23295 might be used:
23296
23297 @lisp
23298 (message (horizontal 1.0
23299 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
23300 (vertical 0.24
23301 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
23302 '(summary 0.5))
23303 (group 1.0))))
23304 @end lisp
23305
23306 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
23307 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
23308 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
23309
23310 @lisp
23311 (message
23312 (frame 1.0
23313 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
23314 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
23315 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
23316 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
23317 (name . "Message"))
23318 (message 1.0 point))))
23319 @end lisp
23320
23321 @findex gnus-add-configuration
23322 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
23323 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
23324 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
23325 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
23326
23327 @lisp
23328 (gnus-add-configuration
23329 '(article (vertical 1.0
23330 (group 4)
23331 (summary .25 point)
23332 (article 1.0))))
23333 @end lisp
23334
23335 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
23336 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
23337 Gnus has been loaded.
23338
23339 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
23340 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
23341 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
23342 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
23343 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
23344
23345 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
23346 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
23347 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
23348 windows resized.
23349
23350 @subsection Example Window Configurations
23351
23352 @itemize @bullet
23353 @item
23354 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
23355 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
23356
23357 @ifinfo
23358 @example
23359 +---+---------+
23360 | G | Summary |
23361 | r +---------+
23362 | o | |
23363 | u | Article |
23364 | p | |
23365 +---+---------+
23366 @end example
23367 @end ifinfo
23368
23369 @lisp
23370 (gnus-add-configuration
23371 '(article
23372 (horizontal 1.0
23373 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
23374 (vertical 1.0
23375 (summary 0.16 point)
23376 (article 1.0)))))
23377
23378 (gnus-add-configuration
23379 '(summary
23380 (horizontal 1.0
23381 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
23382 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
23383 @end lisp
23384
23385 @end itemize
23386
23387
23388 @node Faces and Fonts
23389 @section Faces and Fonts
23390 @cindex faces
23391 @cindex fonts
23392 @cindex colors
23393
23394 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
23395 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
23396 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
23397 interface.
23398
23399
23400 @node Compilation
23401 @section Compilation
23402 @cindex compilation
23403 @cindex byte-compilation
23404
23405 @findex gnus-compile
23406
23407 Remember all those line format specification variables?
23408 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
23409 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
23410 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
23411 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
23412 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
23413 course.)
23414
23415 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
23416 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
23417 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
23418 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
23419 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
23420 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
23421 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
23422
23423
23424 @node Mode Lines
23425 @section Mode Lines
23426 @cindex mode lines
23427
23428 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
23429 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
23430 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
23431 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
23432 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
23433 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
23434 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
23435 quicker.
23436
23437 @cindex display-time
23438
23439 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
23440 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
23441 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
23442 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
23443 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
23444 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
23445 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
23446 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
23447 this variable:
23448
23449 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
23450 @lisp
23451 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
23452 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23453 (+ 21
23454 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23455 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23456 (length display-time-string)))))
23457 @end lisp
23458
23459 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23460 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23461 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23462 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23463 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23464
23465
23466 @node Highlighting and Menus
23467 @section Highlighting and Menus
23468 @cindex visual
23469 @cindex highlighting
23470 @cindex menus
23471
23472 @vindex gnus-visual
23473 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23474 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23475 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23476 file.
23477
23478 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23479 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23480
23481 @table @code
23482 @item group-highlight
23483 Do highlights in the group buffer.
23484 @item summary-highlight
23485 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23486 @item article-highlight
23487 Do highlights in the article buffer.
23488 @item highlight
23489 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23490 @item group-menu
23491 Create menus in the group buffer.
23492 @item summary-menu
23493 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23494 @item article-menu
23495 Create menus in the article buffer.
23496 @item browse-menu
23497 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23498 @item server-menu
23499 Create menus in the server buffer.
23500 @item score-menu
23501 Create menus in the score buffers.
23502 @item menu
23503 Create menus in all buffers.
23504 @end table
23505
23506 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23507 buffers, you could say something like:
23508
23509 @lisp
23510 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23511 @end lisp
23512
23513 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23514
23515 @lisp
23516 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23517 @end lisp
23518
23519 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23520 in all Gnus buffers.
23521
23522 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23523
23524 @table @code
23525 @item gnus-mouse-face
23526 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23527 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23528 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23529
23530 @end table
23531
23532 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23533
23534 @table @code
23535
23536 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23537 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23538 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23539
23540 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23541 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23542 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23543
23544 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23545 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23546 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23547
23548 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23549 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23550 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23551
23552 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23553 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23554 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23555
23556 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23557 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23558 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23559
23560 @end table
23561
23562
23563 @node Buttons
23564 @section Buttons
23565 @cindex buttons
23566 @cindex mouse
23567 @cindex click
23568
23569 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
23570 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
23571 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
23572 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
23573 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
23574
23575 Right.
23576
23577 @vindex gnus-carpal
23578 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
23579 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
23580 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
23581
23582
23583 @table @code
23584
23585 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
23586 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
23587 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
23588
23589 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
23590 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
23591 Face used on buttons.
23592
23593 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
23594 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
23595 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
23596
23597 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
23598 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
23599 Buttons in the group buffer.
23600
23601 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
23602 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
23603 Buttons in the summary buffer.
23604
23605 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
23606 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
23607 Buttons in the server buffer.
23608
23609 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
23610 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
23611 Buttons in the browse buffer.
23612 @end table
23613
23614 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
23615 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
23616 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
23617
23618
23619 @node Daemons
23620 @section Daemons
23621 @cindex demons
23622 @cindex daemons
23623
23624 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23625 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23626 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23627 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23628 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23629
23630 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23631 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23632 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23633
23634 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23635 been idle for thirty minutes:
23636
23637 @lisp
23638 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23639 @end lisp
23640
23641 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23642 Emacs is idle:
23643
23644 @lisp
23645 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23646 @end lisp
23647
23648 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23649 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23650 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23651
23652 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23653 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23654 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23655 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23656
23657 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23658 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23659 @var{idle} minutes.
23660
23661 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23662 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23663 minutes.
23664
23665 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23666 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23667 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23668
23669 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23670 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23671 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23672 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23673
23674 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23675 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23676
23677 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23678 @lisp
23679 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23680 @end lisp
23681
23682 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
23683 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23684 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23685 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23686 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23687 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23688 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23689 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23690 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23691 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23692 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23693
23694 @findex gnus-demon-init
23695 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23696 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23697 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23698 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23699 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23700
23701 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23702 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23703 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23704 behave.
23705
23706
23707 @node NoCeM
23708 @section NoCeM
23709 @cindex nocem
23710 @cindex spam
23711
23712 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
23713 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
23714
23715 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
23716 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
23717 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
23718 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
23719 away.
23720
23721 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
23722 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
23723 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
23724 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
23725
23726 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
23727 this will make spam disappear.
23728
23729 There are some variables to customize, of course:
23730
23731 @table @code
23732 @item gnus-use-nocem
23733 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
23734 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
23735 by default.
23736
23737 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
23738 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
23739 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
23740 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
23741 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
23742 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
23743 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
23744 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
23745
23746 @item gnus-nocem-groups
23747 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
23748 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
23749 default is
23750 @lisp
23751 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
23752 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
23753 @end lisp
23754
23755 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
23756 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
23757 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
23758 people you want to listen to. The default is
23759 @lisp
23760 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
23761 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
23762 @end lisp
23763 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
23764
23765 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
23766 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
23767
23768 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
23769 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
23770 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
23771 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
23772 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
23773 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
23774 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
23775 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
23776 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
23777 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
23778
23779 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
23780 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
23781
23782 @lisp
23783 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
23784 @end lisp
23785
23786 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
23787 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
23788
23789 @lisp
23790 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
23791 @end lisp
23792
23793 The specs are applied left-to-right.
23794
23795
23796 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
23797 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
23798 @findex pgg-verify
23799 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
23800 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
23801 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
23802 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
23803 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
23804 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
23805
23806 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
23807 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
23808 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
23809 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
23810
23811 @item gnus-nocem-directory
23812 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
23813 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
23814 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
23815
23816 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
23817 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
23818 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
23819 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
23820 might then see old spam.
23821
23822 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
23823 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
23824 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
23825 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
23826 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
23827 issuers.
23828
23829 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
23830 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
23831 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
23832 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
23833
23834 @end table
23835
23836 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
23837 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
23838 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
23839 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
23840
23841
23842 @node Undo
23843 @section Undo
23844 @cindex undo
23845
23846 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23847 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23848 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23849
23850 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23851 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23852 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23853 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23854 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23855 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23856 @code{undo} function.
23857
23858 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23859 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23860 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23861 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23862 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23863 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23864 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23865 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23866 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23867 never be totally undoable.
23868
23869 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23870 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23871 @findex gnus-undo
23872 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23873 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23874 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23875 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23876 command.
23877
23878
23879 @node Predicate Specifiers
23880 @section Predicate Specifiers
23881 @cindex predicate specifiers
23882
23883 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23884 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23885 to type all that much.
23886
23887 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23888
23889 Here's an example:
23890
23891 @lisp
23892 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23893 gnus-article-unread-p)
23894 @end lisp
23895
23896 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23897 functions all take one parameter.
23898
23899 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23900 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23901 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23902 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23903 specifier.
23904
23905
23906 @node Moderation
23907 @section Moderation
23908 @cindex moderation
23909
23910 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23911 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23912 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23913 get a copy.
23914
23915 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23916 buffers. Put
23917
23918 @lisp
23919 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23920 @end lisp
23921
23922 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23923
23924 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23925 supposed to work:
23926
23927 @enumerate
23928 @item
23929 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23930 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23931 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23932
23933 @item
23934 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23935 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23936
23937 @item
23938 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23939 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23940 @kbd{c} command.
23941 @end enumerate
23942
23943 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23944
23945 @lisp
23946 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23947 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23948 @end lisp
23949
23950
23951 @node Fetching a Group
23952 @section Fetching a Group
23953 @cindex fetching a group
23954
23955 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23956 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23957 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23958 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23959 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23960 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23961
23962
23963 @node Image Enhancements
23964 @section Image Enhancements
23965
23966 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23967 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23968 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23969
23970 @menu
23971 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23972 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23973 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23974 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23975 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23976 @end menu
23977
23978
23979 @node X-Face
23980 @subsection X-Face
23981 @cindex x-face
23982
23983 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23984 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23985 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23986 readers.
23987
23988 @cindex x-face
23989 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23990 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23991 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23992 @iftex
23993 @iflatex
23994 \include{xface}
23995 @end iflatex
23996 @end iftex
23997 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23998
23999 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
24000 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
24001 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
24002 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
24003 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
24004 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
24005 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
24006 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
24007 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
24008 @code{display} program.
24009
24010 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
24011 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
24012 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
24013 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
24014 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
24015 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
24016 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
24017 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
24018
24019 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
24020 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
24021 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
24022 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
24023 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
24024 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
24025
24026 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
24027 @code{xface}).
24028
24029 @noindent
24030 Face and variable:
24031
24032 @table @code
24033 @item gnus-x-face
24034 @vindex gnus-x-face
24035 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
24036 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
24037 default colors are black and white.
24038
24039 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
24040 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
24041 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
24042 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
24043 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
24044 XEmacs. Here are examples:
24045
24046 @lisp
24047 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
24048 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
24049 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
24050 (png . (:ascent 80))))
24051
24052 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
24053 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
24054 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
24055 (png . (:relief -2))))
24056 @end lisp
24057
24058 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
24059 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
24060 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
24061 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
24062 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
24063 @samp{libcompface} library.
24064 @end table
24065
24066 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
24067 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
24068 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
24069 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
24070 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
24071 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
24072
24073 @findex gnus-random-x-face
24074 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
24075 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
24076 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
24077 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
24078 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
24079 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
24080 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
24081 header data as a string.
24082
24083 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
24084 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
24085 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
24086 randomly generated data.
24087
24088 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
24089 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
24090 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
24091 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
24092 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
24093
24094 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
24095 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24096
24097 @lisp
24098 (setq message-required-news-headers
24099 (nconc message-required-news-headers
24100 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
24101 @end lisp
24102
24103 Using the last function would be something like this:
24104
24105 @lisp
24106 (setq message-required-news-headers
24107 (nconc message-required-news-headers
24108 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
24109 (gnus-x-face-from-file
24110 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
24111 @end lisp
24112
24113
24114 @node Face
24115 @subsection Face
24116 @cindex face
24117
24118 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
24119
24120 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
24121 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
24122 represent the author of the message.
24123
24124 @cindex face
24125 @findex gnus-article-display-face
24126 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
24127 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
24128 specifications.
24129
24130 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
24131 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
24132
24133 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
24134 PNG images.
24135 @c Maybe add this:
24136 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
24137 @c (featurep 'png)
24138 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
24139
24140 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
24141 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
24142
24143 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
24144 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
24145 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
24146
24147 @findex gnus-face-from-file
24148 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
24149 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
24150 converts the file to Face format by using the
24151 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
24152
24153 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
24154 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24155
24156 @lisp
24157 (setq message-required-news-headers
24158 (nconc message-required-news-headers
24159 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
24160 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
24161 @end lisp
24162
24163
24164 @node Smileys
24165 @subsection Smileys
24166 @cindex smileys
24167
24168 @iftex
24169 @iflatex
24170 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
24171 \input{smiley}
24172 @end iflatex
24173 @end iftex
24174
24175 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
24176 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
24177
24178 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
24179 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24180
24181 @lisp
24182 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
24183 @end lisp
24184
24185 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
24186 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
24187 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
24188 text and maps that to file names.
24189
24190 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
24191 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
24192 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
24193 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
24194 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
24195 displayed.
24196
24197 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
24198
24199 @table @code
24200
24201 @item smiley-style
24202 @vindex smiley-style
24203 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
24204 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
24205 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
24206 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
24207 face.
24208
24209 @item smiley-data-directory
24210 @vindex smiley-data-directory
24211 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
24212 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
24213
24214 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
24215 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
24216 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
24217
24218 @end table
24219
24220
24221 @node Picons
24222 @subsection Picons
24223
24224 @iftex
24225 @iflatex
24226 \include{picons}
24227 @end iflatex
24228 @end iftex
24229
24230 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
24231 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
24232 over your shoulder as you read news.
24233
24234 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
24235
24236 @iftex
24237 @iflatex
24238 \margindex{}
24239 @end iflatex
24240 @end iftex
24241
24242 @quotation
24243 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
24244 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
24245 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
24246 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
24247 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
24248 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
24249 @code{GIF} formats.
24250 @end quotation
24251
24252 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
24253 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
24254 point your Web browser at
24255 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
24256
24257 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
24258 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
24259
24260 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
24261 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
24262 Picons databases.
24263
24264 @vindex gnus-picon-style
24265 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
24266 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
24267 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
24268
24269 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
24270
24271 @table @code
24272
24273 @item gnus-picon-databases
24274 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
24275 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
24276 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
24277 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
24278 "/usr/local/faces")}.
24279
24280 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
24281 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
24282 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
24283 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
24284
24285 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
24286 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
24287 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
24288 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
24289
24290 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
24291 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
24292 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
24293 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
24294 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
24295
24296 @item gnus-picon-file-types
24297 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
24298 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
24299 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
24300
24301 @end table
24302
24303
24304 @node XVarious
24305 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
24306
24307 @table @code
24308 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
24309 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
24310 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
24311 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
24312 unusual directory structure.
24313
24314 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
24315 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
24316 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
24317 default.
24318
24319 @end table
24320
24321 @subsubsection Toolbar
24322
24323 @table @code
24324
24325 @item gnus-use-toolbar
24326 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
24327 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
24328 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
24329 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
24330 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
24331 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
24332 names show. The default is @code{default}.
24333
24334 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
24335 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
24336 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
24337 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
24338 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
24339 The default is that of the default toolbar.
24340
24341 @item gnus-group-toolbar
24342 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
24343 The toolbar in the group buffer.
24344
24345 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
24346 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
24347 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
24348
24349 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
24350 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
24351 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
24352
24353 @end table
24354
24355 @iftex
24356 @iflatex
24357 \margindex{}
24358 @end iflatex
24359 @end iftex
24360
24361
24362 @node Fuzzy Matching
24363 @section Fuzzy Matching
24364 @cindex fuzzy matching
24365
24366 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
24367 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
24368
24369 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
24370 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
24371 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
24372
24373 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
24374 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
24375 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
24376 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
24377 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
24378
24379
24380 @node Thwarting Email Spam
24381 @section Thwarting Email Spam
24382 @cindex email spam
24383 @cindex spam
24384 @cindex UCE
24385 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
24386
24387 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
24388 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
24389 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
24390 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
24391 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
24392 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
24393 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
24394 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
24395 in the end.
24396
24397 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
24398 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
24399 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
24400 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
24401 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
24402 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
24403
24404 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
24405
24406 @menu
24407 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
24408 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
24409 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
24410 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
24411 @end menu
24412
24413 @node The problem of spam
24414 @subsection The problem of spam
24415 @cindex email spam
24416 @cindex spam filtering approaches
24417 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
24418 @cindex UCE
24419 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
24420
24421 First, some background on spam.
24422
24423 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
24424 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
24425 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
24426 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
24427 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
24428 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
24429 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
24430 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
24431 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
24432
24433 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
24434 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
24435 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
24436 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
24437 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
24438 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
24439 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
24440 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
24441 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
24442 and processing.
24443
24444 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
24445 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
24446 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
24447 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
24448 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
24449 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
24450 from Bulgarian IPs.
24451
24452 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
24453 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
24454 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
24455 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
24456
24457 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
24458 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
24459 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
24460 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
24461
24462 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
24463 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
24464 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
24465 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
24466 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
24467 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
24468 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
24469 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
24470 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
24471
24472 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
24473 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
24474 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
24475 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
24476 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
24477 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
24478 down for some time because of the incident.
24479
24480 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
24481 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
24482 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
24483 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
24484 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
24485 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
24486 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
24487 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
24488 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
24489 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
24490 the server that it has misclassified mail.
24491
24492 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
24493 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
24494 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
24495 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
24496 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
24497 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
24498 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
24499 spam plague.
24500
24501 @node Anti-Spam Basics
24502 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
24503 @cindex email spam
24504 @cindex spam
24505 @cindex UCE
24506 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
24507
24508 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
24509 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
24510
24511 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
24512 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
24513 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
24514 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
24515 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
24516 part of the mail address.)
24517
24518 @lisp
24519 (setq message-default-news-headers
24520 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
24521 @end lisp
24522
24523 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24524 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24525
24526 @lisp
24527 (...
24528 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
24529 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
24530 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
24531 "spam"))
24532 ...)
24533 @end lisp
24534
24535 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
24536 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
24537 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
24538 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
24539
24540 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
24541 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
24542 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
24543 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
24544 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
24545 your fancy split rule in this way:
24546
24547 @lisp
24548 (
24549 ...
24550 (to "larsi" "misc")
24551 "spam")
24552 @end lisp
24553
24554 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
24555 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
24556 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
24557 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
24558 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
24559
24560 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
24561 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
24562 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
24563 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
24564
24565 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
24566
24567
24568 @node SpamAssassin
24569 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
24570 @cindex SpamAssassin
24571 @cindex Vipul's Razor
24572 @cindex DCC
24573
24574 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
24575 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
24576 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
24577 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
24578 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
24579 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
24580 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
24581
24582 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
24583 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24584 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24585 recipes.
24586
24587 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24588 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24589 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24590 Specifiers}) follow.
24591
24592 @lisp
24593 (setq mail-sources
24594 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24595 (pop :user "jrl"
24596 :server "pophost"
24597 :postscript
24598 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24599 @end lisp
24600
24601 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
24602 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
24603 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24604
24605 @lisp
24606 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24607 ...))
24608 @end lisp
24609
24610 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24611
24612 @lisp
24613 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24614 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24615 ...))
24616 @end lisp
24617
24618 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24619 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24620 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24621 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24622
24623 @lisp
24624 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24625 ...))
24626 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24627 (save-excursion
24628 (save-restriction
24629 (widen)
24630 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24631 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24632 "spam"))))
24633 @end lisp
24634
24635 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24636 downloaded by default. You need to set
24637 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24638 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
24639
24640 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24641 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24642 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24643
24644 @lisp
24645 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24646 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24647 (interactive)
24648 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
24649 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
24650 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24651 @end lisp
24652
24653 @node Hashcash
24654 @subsection Hashcash
24655 @cindex hashcash
24656
24657 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24658 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24659 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24660 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24661 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24662
24663 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24664 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24665 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24666 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24667 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24668 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24669 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24670 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24671 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24672 one of them separately.
24673
24674 @cindex X-Hashcash
24675 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24676 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24677 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24678 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24679 need to install to use this feature, see
24680 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24681 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24682
24683 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24684 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24685 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24686
24687 @lisp
24688 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24689 @end lisp
24690
24691 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24692
24693 @table @code
24694
24695 @item hashcash-default-payment
24696 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24697 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24698 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24699 include 17 to 29.
24700
24701 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24702 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24703 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24704 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24705 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24706 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24707 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24708 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24709 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24710
24711 @item hashcash-path
24712 @vindex hashcash-path
24713 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24714 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24715 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24716 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24717 when you generate hashcash payments.
24718
24719 @end table
24720
24721 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24722 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24723 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24724 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24725 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24726 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24727 Hashcash Payments}).
24728
24729 @node Spam Package
24730 @section Spam Package
24731 @cindex spam filtering
24732 @cindex spam
24733
24734 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24735 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24736 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24737 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24738
24739 @menu
24740 * Spam Package Introduction::
24741 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24742 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24743 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24744 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24745 * Spam Back Ends::
24746 * Extending the Spam package::
24747 * Spam Statistics Package::
24748 @end menu
24749
24750 @node Spam Package Introduction
24751 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24752 @cindex spam filtering
24753 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24754 @cindex spam
24755
24756 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24757 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24758
24759 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24760 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24761
24762 @cindex spam-initialize
24763 @vindex spam-use-stat
24764 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24765 @code{spam-initialize}:
24766
24767 @example
24768 (spam-initialize)
24769 @end example
24770
24771 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24772 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24773 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24774 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24775 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24776
24777 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24778 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24779
24780 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24781 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24782
24783 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24784 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24785 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24786 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24787 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24788
24789 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24790 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24791 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24792 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24793 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24794 Groups}.
24795
24796 @cindex spam back ends
24797 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24798 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24799 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24800 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24801 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24802
24803 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24804 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24805
24806 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24807 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24808 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24809 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24810 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24811 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24812 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24813
24814 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24815 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24816 point, the Spam package does several things:
24817
24818 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24819 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24820 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24821 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24822 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24823 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24824 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24825 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24826 Ham Processors}.
24827
24828 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24829 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24830 group:
24831
24832 @table @kbd
24833 @item M-d
24834 @itemx M s x
24835 @itemx S x
24836 @kindex M-d
24837 @kindex S x
24838 @kindex M s x
24839 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24840 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24841 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24842 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24843 @end table
24844
24845 @noindent
24846 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24847 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24848
24849 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24850 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24851 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24852 to be processed as ham by setting
24853 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24854 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24855
24856 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24857 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24858 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24859 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24860 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24861 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24862 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24863 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24864 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24865 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24866 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24867 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24868
24869 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24870 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24871 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24872 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24873 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24874 Configuration Examples}.
24875
24876 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24877 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24878 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24879 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24880
24881 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24882 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24883
24884 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24885 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24886 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24887
24888 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24889 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24890 @cindex spam filtering
24891 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24892 @cindex spam
24893
24894 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24895 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24896 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24897 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24898 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24899
24900 @example
24901 (: spam-split)
24902 @end example
24903
24904 @vindex spam-split-group
24905 @noindent
24906 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24907 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24908 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24909 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24910 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24911 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24912 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24913 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24914 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24915
24916 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24917
24918 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24919 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24920 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24921 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
24922 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
24923 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
24924 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
24925 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
24926 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24927 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
24928 in IMAP}.
24929
24930 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24931 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24932 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24933 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24934 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24935 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24936 ends, and the following split rule:
24937
24938 @example
24939 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24940 (any "ding" "ding")
24941 (: spam-split)
24942 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24943 "mail")
24944 @end example
24945
24946 @noindent
24947 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24948 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24949 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24950 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24951 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24952 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24953
24954 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24955 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24956 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24957 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24958
24959 @example
24960 nnimap-split-fancy
24961 '(|
24962 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24963 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24964 (any "ding" "ding")
24965 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24966 (: spam-split)
24967 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24968 "mail")
24969 @end example
24970
24971 @noindent
24972 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24973 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24974 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24975 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24976 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24977 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24978 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24979
24980 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24981 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24982 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24983 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24984
24985 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24986 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24987 @c don't.}
24988
24989 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24990 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24991
24992 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24993 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24994 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24995 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24996
24997 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24998 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24999 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
25000 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
25001
25002 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
25003 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
25004 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
25005
25006 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
25007 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
25008 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
25009 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
25010 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
25011 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
25012 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
25013
25014 @node Spam and Ham Processors
25015 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
25016 @cindex spam filtering
25017 @cindex spam filtering variables
25018 @cindex spam variables
25019 @cindex spam
25020
25021 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
25022 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
25023 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
25024 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
25025 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
25026 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
25027 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
25028
25029 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
25030 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
25031 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
25032 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
25033
25034 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
25035 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
25036 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
25037 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
25038 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
25039 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
25040 by customizing the corresponding variable
25041 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
25042 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
25043 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
25044 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
25045 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
25046 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
25047 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
25048 default.
25049
25050 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
25051 @cindex $
25052 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
25053 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
25054 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
25055 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
25056 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
25057 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
25058 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
25059 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
25060 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
25061 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
25062 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
25063 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
25064 processor which will study them as spam samples.
25065
25066 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
25067 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
25068 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
25069 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
25070 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
25071 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
25072 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
25073 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
25074
25075 @defvar ham-marks
25076 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
25077 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
25078 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
25079 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
25080 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
25081 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
25082 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
25083 happy for you.
25084 @end defvar
25085
25086 @defvar spam-marks
25087 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
25088 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
25089 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
25090 you really want to.
25091 @end defvar
25092
25093 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
25094 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
25095 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
25096 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
25097 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
25098 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
25099 and nothing else.
25100
25101 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
25102 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
25103 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
25104 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
25105 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
25106 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
25107 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
25108 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
25109 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
25110 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
25111 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
25112 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
25113 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
25114 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
25115 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
25116
25117 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
25118 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
25119
25120 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
25121 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
25122 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
25123
25124 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
25125 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
25126
25127 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
25128 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
25129 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
25130 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
25131 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
25132
25133 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
25134 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
25135 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
25136 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
25137 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
25138 it there.
25139
25140 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
25141 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
25142 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
25143 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
25144 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
25145 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
25146 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
25147 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
25148 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
25149 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
25150 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
25151 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
25152 group buffer then you need it here as well.
25153
25154 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
25155 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
25156
25157 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
25158 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
25159 training} groups.
25160
25161 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
25162 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
25163 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
25164 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
25165 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
25166 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
25167 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
25168
25169 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
25170 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
25171 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
25172 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
25173
25174 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
25175 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
25176 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
25177 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
25178 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
25179 from the mail server.
25180
25181 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
25182 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
25183 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
25184 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
25185
25186 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
25187 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
25188 @cindex spam filtering
25189 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
25190 @cindex spam configuration examples
25191 @cindex spam
25192
25193 @subsubheading Ted's setup
25194
25195 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
25196 @example
25197 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
25198 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
25199 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25200 (spam-initialize)
25201
25202 (setq
25203 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
25204 spam-use-BBDB t
25205 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
25206 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
25207 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
25208 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
25209 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
25210 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
25211 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
25212 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
25213 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
25214 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
25215 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
25216 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
25217 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25218 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
25219 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
25220 (any "ding" "ding")
25221 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
25222 (: spam-split)
25223 ;; @r{default mailbox}
25224 "mail"))
25225
25226 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
25227
25228 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
25229 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
25230 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
25231 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
25232
25233 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
25234
25235 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
25236 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
25237 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
25238 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
25239 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
25240
25241 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
25242 ((spam-autodetect . t))
25243
25244 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
25245
25246 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
25247 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
25248
25249 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
25250 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
25251 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
25252
25253 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
25254
25255 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
25256 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
25257
25258 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
25259 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
25260 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
25261 (ham-marks
25262 (gnus-ticked-mark))
25263 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
25264 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
25265 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
25266
25267 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
25268 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
25269 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
25270
25271 @end example
25272
25273 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
25274 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
25275
25276 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
25277 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
25278 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
25279 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
25280 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
25281 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
25282 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
25283 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
25284 @samp{training.spam} folders.
25285
25286 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
25287 does most of the job for me:
25288
25289 @lisp
25290 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
25291 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
25292 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
25293 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
25294 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
25295 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
25296 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
25297 @end lisp
25298
25299 @itemize
25300
25301 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
25302
25303 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
25304 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
25305 bogofilter or DCC).
25306
25307 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
25308 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
25309 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
25310 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
25311 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
25312 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
25313 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
25314
25315 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
25316 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
25317 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
25318 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
25319 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
25320 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
25321
25322 @item @b{Ham folders:}
25323
25324 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
25325 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
25326 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
25327 @samp{training.spam}.
25328 @end itemize
25329
25330 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
25331
25332 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
25333
25334 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
25335 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
25336 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
25337
25338 @lisp
25339 ("^gmane\\."
25340 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
25341 @end lisp
25342
25343 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
25344 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
25345 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
25346 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
25347 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
25348
25349 @node Spam Back Ends
25350 @subsection Spam Back Ends
25351 @cindex spam back ends
25352
25353 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
25354 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
25355 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
25356 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
25357 Processors}).
25358
25359 @menu
25360 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
25361 * BBDB Whitelists::
25362 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
25363 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
25364 * Blackholes::
25365 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
25366 * Bogofilter::
25367 * SpamAssassin back end::
25368 * ifile spam filtering::
25369 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
25370 * SpamOracle::
25371 @end menu
25372
25373 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
25374 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
25375 @cindex spam filtering
25376 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
25377 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
25378 @cindex spam
25379
25380 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
25381
25382 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
25383 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
25384 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
25385 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
25386 be spammers.
25387
25388 @end defvar
25389
25390 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
25391
25392 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
25393 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
25394 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
25395 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
25396 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
25397
25398 @end defvar
25399
25400 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
25401
25402 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
25403 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
25404 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
25405
25406 @end defvar
25407
25408 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
25409
25410 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25411 customizing the group parameters or the
25412 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25413 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
25414 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
25415
25416 @emph{WARNING}
25417
25418 Instead of the obsolete
25419 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
25420 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
25421 the same way, we promise.
25422
25423 @end defvar
25424
25425 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
25426
25427 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25428 customizing the group parameters or the
25429 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25430 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
25431 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
25432 whitelist.
25433
25434 @emph{WARNING}
25435
25436 Instead of the obsolete
25437 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
25438 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
25439 the same way, we promise.
25440
25441 @end defvar
25442
25443 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
25444 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
25445 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
25446 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
25447 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
25448
25449 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
25450 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
25451 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
25452 Emacs regular expression syntax.
25453
25454 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
25455 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
25456 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
25457 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
25458 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
25459 @file{blacklist} respectively.
25460
25461 @node BBDB Whitelists
25462 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
25463 @cindex spam filtering
25464 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
25465 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
25466 @cindex spam
25467
25468 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
25469
25470 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
25471 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
25472 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
25473 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
25474 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
25475 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
25476 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
25477
25478 @end defvar
25479
25480 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
25481
25482 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
25483 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
25484 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
25485 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
25486 classified as spammers.
25487
25488 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
25489 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
25490 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
25491 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
25492 will be exclusive.
25493
25494 @end defvar
25495
25496 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
25497
25498 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25499 customizing the group parameters or the
25500 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25501 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
25502 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
25503 BBDB.
25504
25505 @emph{WARNING}
25506
25507 Instead of the obsolete
25508 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
25509 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
25510 the same way, we promise.
25511
25512 @end defvar
25513
25514 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
25515 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
25516 @cindex spam reporting
25517 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
25518 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
25519 @cindex spam
25520
25521 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
25522
25523 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25524 customizing the group parameters or the
25525 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25526 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25527 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
25528 HTTP request.
25529
25530 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
25531
25532 @emph{WARNING}
25533
25534 Instead of the obsolete
25535 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
25536 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
25537 same way, we promise.
25538
25539 @end defvar
25540
25541 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
25542
25543 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
25544 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
25545 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
25546 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
25547 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
25548
25549 @end defvar
25550
25551 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
25552
25553 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
25554 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
25555 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
25556
25557 @end defvar
25558
25559 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25560 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25561 @cindex spam filtering
25562 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
25563 @cindex spam
25564
25565 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
25566
25567 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
25568 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
25569 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
25570 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
25571 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
25572 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
25573
25574 @end defvar
25575
25576 @node Blackholes
25577 @subsubsection Blackholes
25578 @cindex spam filtering
25579 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
25580 @cindex spam
25581
25582 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
25583
25584 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25585 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25586 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25587 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25588 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25589 contains outdated servers.
25590
25591 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
25592 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
25593 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25594 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25595 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25596 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25597
25598 @end defvar
25599
25600 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25601
25602 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25603
25604 @end defvar
25605
25606 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25607
25608 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25609 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25610
25611 @end defvar
25612
25613 @defvar spam-use-dig
25614
25615 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25616 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25617
25618 @end defvar
25619
25620 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25621 ham processor for blackholes.
25622
25623 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25624 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25625 @cindex spam filtering
25626 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25627 @cindex spam
25628
25629 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25630
25631 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25632 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25633 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25634 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25635 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25636 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25637
25638 @end defvar
25639
25640 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25641
25642 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25643 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25644
25645 @end defvar
25646
25647 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25648
25649 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25650 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25651
25652 @end defvar
25653
25654 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25655 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25656
25657 @node Bogofilter
25658 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25659 @cindex spam filtering
25660 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25661 @cindex spam
25662
25663 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25664
25665 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25666 speedy Bogofilter.
25667
25668 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25669 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25670 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25671 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25672 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25673 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25674
25675 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25676 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25677 documentation.
25678
25679 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25680 processing will be turned off.
25681
25682 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25683
25684 @end defvar
25685
25686 @table @kbd
25687 @item M s t
25688 @itemx S t
25689 @kindex M s t
25690 @kindex S t
25691 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25692 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25693 @end table
25694
25695 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25696
25697 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25698 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25699 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25700 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25701 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25702 installation documents for details.
25703
25704 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25705
25706 @end defvar
25707
25708 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25709 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25710 customizing the group parameters or the
25711 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25712 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25713 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25714
25715 @emph{WARNING}
25716
25717 Instead of the obsolete
25718 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25719 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25720 the same way, we promise.
25721 @end defvar
25722
25723 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25724 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25725 customizing the group parameters or the
25726 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25727 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25728 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25729 of non-spam messages.
25730
25731 @emph{WARNING}
25732
25733 Instead of the obsolete
25734 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25735 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25736 the same way, we promise.
25737 @end defvar
25738
25739 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25740
25741 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25742 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25743 database directory.
25744
25745 @end defvar
25746
25747 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25748 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25749 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25750 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25751 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25752 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25753
25754 @node SpamAssassin back end
25755 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25756 @cindex spam filtering
25757 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25758 @cindex spam
25759
25760 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25761
25762 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25763
25764 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25765 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25766 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25767 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25768 mode.
25769
25770 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25771 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25772 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25773 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25774 instead.
25775
25776 You should not enable this if you use
25777 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25778
25779 @end defvar
25780
25781 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25782
25783 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25784 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25785
25786 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25787
25788 @end defvar
25789
25790 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25791
25792 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25793 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25794 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25795 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25796
25797 @end defvar
25798
25799 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25800 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25801 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25802 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25803 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25804 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25805 to test this functionality.
25806
25807 @node ifile spam filtering
25808 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25809 @cindex spam filtering
25810 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25811 @cindex spam
25812
25813 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25814
25815 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25816 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25817
25818 @end defvar
25819
25820 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25821
25822 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25823 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25824 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25825
25826 @end defvar
25827
25828 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25829
25830 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25831 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25832 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25833 @end defvar
25834
25835 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25836
25837 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25838 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25839
25840 @end defvar
25841
25842 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25843 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25844 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25845 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25846 functionality.
25847
25848 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25849 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25850 @cindex spam filtering
25851 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25852 @cindex spam-stat
25853 @cindex spam
25854
25855 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25856 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25857 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25858 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25859 spam-stat dictionary}.
25860
25861 @defvar spam-use-stat
25862
25863 @end defvar
25864
25865 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25866 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25867 customizing the group parameters or the
25868 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25869 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25870 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25871
25872 @emph{WARNING}
25873
25874 Instead of the obsolete
25875 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25876 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25877 the same way, we promise.
25878 @end defvar
25879
25880 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25881 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25882 customizing the group parameters or the
25883 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25884 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25885 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25886 of non-spam messages.
25887
25888 @emph{WARNING}
25889
25890 Instead of the obsolete
25891 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25892 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25893 the same way, we promise.
25894 @end defvar
25895
25896 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25897 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25898 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25899 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25900 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25901
25902 @node SpamOracle
25903 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25904 @cindex spam filtering
25905 @cindex SpamOracle
25906 @cindex spam
25907
25908 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25909 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25910 installed separately.
25911
25912 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25913 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25914 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25915 mail as a spam mail or not.
25916
25917 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25918 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25919 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25920
25921 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25922 call SpamOracle.
25923
25924 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25925 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25926 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25927 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25928 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25929 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25930 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25931 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25932
25933 @example
25934 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25935 spam-split-group "Junk"
25936 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25937 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
25938 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25939 @end example
25940
25941 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25942 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25943 SpamOracle.
25944 @end defvar
25945
25946 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25947 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25948 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25949 can be customized.
25950 @end defvar
25951
25952 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25953 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25954 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25955 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25956 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25957 database to live somewhere special, set
25958 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25959 @end defvar
25960
25961 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25962 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25963 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25964 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25965 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25966 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25967 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25968 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25969 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25970 @xref{Spam Package}.
25971
25972 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25973 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25974 customizing the group parameter or the
25975 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25976 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25977 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25978
25979 @emph{WARNING}
25980
25981 Instead of the obsolete
25982 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25983 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25984 the same way, we promise.
25985 @end defvar
25986
25987 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25988 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25989 customizing the group parameter or the
25990 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25991 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25992 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25993 messages.
25994
25995 @emph{WARNING}
25996
25997 Instead of the obsolete
25998 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25999 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
26000 the same way, we promise.
26001 @end defvar
26002
26003 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
26004 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
26005 messages.
26006 @example
26007 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
26008 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
26009 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
26010 @end example
26011 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
26012 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
26013 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
26014 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
26015 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
26016 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
26017
26018 @node Extending the Spam package
26019 @subsection Extending the Spam package
26020 @cindex spam filtering
26021 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
26022 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
26023
26024 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
26025 incoming mail, provide the following:
26026
26027 @enumerate
26028
26029 @item
26030 Code
26031
26032 @lisp
26033 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
26034 "True if blackbox should be used.")
26035 @end lisp
26036
26037 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
26038
26039 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
26040 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
26041 register/unregister routines as a start, or other restister/unregister
26042 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
26043 register/unregister spam and ham.
26044
26045 @item
26046 Functionality
26047
26048 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
26049 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
26050 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
26051 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
26052 why you aren't.
26053
26054 @end enumerate
26055
26056 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
26057
26058 @enumerate
26059
26060 @item
26061 Code
26062
26063 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
26064 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
26065
26066 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
26067 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
26068 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
26069 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
26070
26071 @lisp
26072 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
26073 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
26074 Only applicable to spam groups.")
26075
26076 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
26077 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
26078 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
26079
26080 @end lisp
26081
26082 @item
26083 Gnus parameters
26084
26085 Add
26086 @lisp
26087 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
26088 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
26089 @end lisp
26090 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
26091 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
26092 variable customization.
26093
26094 Add
26095 @lisp
26096 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
26097 @end lisp
26098 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
26099 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
26100
26101 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
26102 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
26103
26104
26105 @enumerate
26106
26107 @item
26108 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
26109
26110 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
26111 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
26112 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
26113
26114 @item
26115 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
26116
26117 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
26118 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
26119 such a back end.
26120
26121 @item
26122 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
26123
26124 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
26125 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
26126 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
26127 back ends.
26128
26129 @item
26130 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
26131
26132 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
26133 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
26134 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
26135
26136 @item
26137 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
26138
26139 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
26140 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
26141 set up this way.
26142
26143 @item
26144 @code{spam-install-backend}
26145
26146 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
26147 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
26148 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
26149
26150 @item
26151 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
26152
26153 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
26154 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
26155 never install such a back end.
26156 @end enumerate
26157
26158 @end enumerate
26159
26160 @node Spam Statistics Package
26161 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
26162 @cindex Paul Graham
26163 @cindex Graham, Paul
26164 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
26165 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
26166 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
26167
26168 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
26169 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
26170 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
26171 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
26172 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
26173 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
26174 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
26175 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
26176 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
26177 or not.
26178
26179 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
26180 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
26181 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
26182 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
26183 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
26184 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
26185 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
26186 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
26187
26188 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
26189 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
26190 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
26191
26192 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
26193 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
26194 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
26195 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
26196 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
26197
26198 @menu
26199 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
26200 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
26201 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
26202 @end menu
26203
26204 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
26205 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
26206
26207 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
26208 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
26209 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
26210 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
26211 need several hundred emails in both collections.
26212
26213 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
26214 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
26215 per mail. Use the following:
26216
26217 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
26218 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
26219 is treated as one spam mail.
26220 @end defun
26221
26222 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
26223 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
26224 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
26225 @end defun
26226
26227 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
26228 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
26229 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
26230 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
26231 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
26232 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
26233
26234 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
26235 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
26236 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
26237 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
26238 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
26239
26240 @defvar spam-stat
26241 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
26242 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
26243 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
26244 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
26245 @end defvar
26246
26247 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
26248 reset the dictionary.
26249
26250 @defun spam-stat-reset
26251 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
26252 @end defun
26253
26254 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
26255 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
26256 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
26257 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
26258 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
26259 only non-spam mails.
26260
26261 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
26262 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
26263 to update the dictionary incrementally.
26264 @end defun
26265
26266 @defun spam-stat-save
26267 Save the dictionary.
26268 @end defun
26269
26270 @defvar spam-stat-file
26271 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
26272 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
26273 @end defvar
26274
26275 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
26276 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
26277
26278 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
26279 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
26280
26281 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
26282
26283 @lisp
26284 (require 'spam-stat)
26285 (spam-stat-load)
26286 @end lisp
26287
26288 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
26289 created.
26290
26291 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
26292 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
26293 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
26294 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
26295
26296 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
26297 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
26298 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
26299 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
26300
26301 @lisp
26302 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
26303 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
26304 "mail.misc"))
26305 @end lisp
26306
26307 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
26308 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
26309 @end defvar
26310
26311 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
26312 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
26313 expression are considered potential spam.
26314
26315 @lisp
26316 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
26317 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
26318 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
26319 "mail.misc"))
26320 @end lisp
26321
26322 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
26323 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
26324 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
26325 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
26326 mails, when creating the dictionary!
26327
26328 @lisp
26329 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
26330 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
26331 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
26332 "mail.misc"))
26333 @end lisp
26334
26335 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
26336 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
26337 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
26338 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
26339 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
26340 dictionary!
26341
26342 @lisp
26343 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
26344 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
26345 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
26346 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
26347 "mail.misc"))
26348 @end lisp
26349
26350
26351 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
26352 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
26353
26354 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
26355
26356 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
26357 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
26358 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
26359 @end defun
26360
26361 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
26362 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
26363 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
26364 @end defun
26365
26366 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
26367 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
26368 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
26369 already been processed as non-spam.
26370 @end defun
26371
26372 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
26373 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
26374 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
26375 been processed as spam.
26376 @end defun
26377
26378 @defun spam-stat-save
26379 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
26380 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
26381 @end defun
26382
26383 @defun spam-stat-load
26384 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
26385 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
26386 @end defun
26387
26388 @defun spam-stat-score-word
26389 Return the spam score for a word.
26390 @end defun
26391
26392 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
26393 Return the spam score for a buffer.
26394 @end defun
26395
26396 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
26397 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
26398 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
26399 @end defun
26400
26401 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
26402 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
26403
26404 @lisp
26405 (require 'spam-stat)
26406 (spam-stat-load)
26407 @end lisp
26408
26409 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
26410
26411 @smallexample
26412 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
26413 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
26414 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
26415 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
26416 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
26417 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
26418 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
26419 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
26420 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
26421 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
26422 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
26423 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
26424 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
26425 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
26426 @end smallexample
26427
26428 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
26432 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
26433 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
26434 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
26435 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
26436 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
26437 @end smallexample
26438
26439 @node Other modes
26440 @section Interaction with other modes
26441
26442 @subsection Dired
26443 @cindex dired
26444
26445 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26446 buffers. It is enabled with
26447 @lisp
26448 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26449 @end lisp
26450
26451 @table @kbd
26452 @item C-c C-m C-a
26453 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26454 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26455 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26456 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26457
26458 @item C-c C-m C-l
26459 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26460 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26461 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26462 buffer.
26463
26464 @item C-c C-m C-p
26465 @findex gnus-dired-print
26466 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26467 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26468 @end table
26469
26470 @node Various Various
26471 @section Various Various
26472 @cindex mode lines
26473 @cindex highlights
26474
26475 @table @code
26476
26477 @item gnus-home-directory
26478 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26479 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26480 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26481
26482 @item gnus-directory
26483 @vindex gnus-directory
26484 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26485 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26486 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26487
26488 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26489 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26490 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26491 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26492
26493 @item gnus-default-directory
26494 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26495 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26496 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26497 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26498 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26499 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26500 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26501
26502 @item gnus-verbose
26503 @vindex gnus-verbose
26504 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26505 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26506 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26507 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26508 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26509
26510 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26511 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26512 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26513 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26514
26515 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26516 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26517 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26518 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26519 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26520 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26521 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26522 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26523 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26524 displayed in the echo area.
26525
26526 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26527 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26528 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26529 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26530 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26531 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26532 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26533 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26534 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26535 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26536
26537 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26538 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26539 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26540 read when doing the operation described above.
26541
26542 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26543 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26544 @cindex file names
26545 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26546 @cindex characters in file names
26547 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26548 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26549 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26550
26551 @lisp
26552 @group
26553 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26554 '((?: . ?_)))
26555 @end group
26556 @end lisp
26557
26558 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26559 Windows (phooey) systems.
26560
26561 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26562 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26563 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26564 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26565 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26566
26567 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26568 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26569 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26570 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26571 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26572
26573 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26574 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26575 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26576
26577 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26578 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26579
26580 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26581 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26582 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26583 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26584 group).
26585
26586 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26587
26588
26589 @end table
26590
26591 @node The End
26592 @chapter The End
26593
26594 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26595 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26596
26597 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26598
26599 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26600
26601 @quotation
26602 @strong{Te Deum}
26603
26604 @sp 1
26605 Not because of victories @*
26606 I sing,@*
26607 having none,@*
26608 but for the common sunshine,@*
26609 the breeze,@*
26610 the largess of the spring.
26611
26612 @sp 1
26613 Not for victory@*
26614 but for the day's work done@*
26615 as well as I was able;@*
26616 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26617 but at the common table.@*
26618 @end quotation
26619
26620
26621 @node Appendices
26622 @chapter Appendices
26623
26624 @menu
26625 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26626 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26627 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26628 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26629 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26630 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26631 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26632 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26633 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26634 @end menu
26635
26636
26637 @node XEmacs
26638 @section XEmacs
26639 @cindex XEmacs
26640 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26641
26642 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26643 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26644 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26645 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26646 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26647 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26648
26649
26650 @node History
26651 @section History
26652
26653 @cindex history
26654 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26655 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26656
26657 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26658 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26659 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26660 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26661 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26662
26663 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26664 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26665 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26666 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26667 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26668 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26669
26670 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26671 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26672 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26673 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26674
26675 @menu
26676 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26677 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
26678 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26679 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26680 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26681 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26682 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26683 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26684 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26685 @end menu
26686
26687
26688 @node Gnus Versions
26689 @subsection Gnus Versions
26690 @cindex ding Gnus
26691 @cindex September Gnus
26692 @cindex Red Gnus
26693 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26694 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26695 @cindex Oort Gnus
26696 @cindex No Gnus
26697 @cindex Gnus versions
26698
26699 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26700 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26701 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26702
26703 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26704 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26705
26706 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26707 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26708
26709 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26710 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26711
26712 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26713 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26714 1999.
26715
26716 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26717 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26718
26719 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26720
26721 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
26722 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26723 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
26724 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
26725 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
26726 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
26727
26728
26729 @node Other Gnus Versions
26730 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
26731 @cindex Semi-gnus
26732
26733 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
26734 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
26735 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
26736 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
26737
26738 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
26739 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
26740 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
26741 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
26742 Japanese users.
26743
26744
26745 @node Why?
26746 @subsection Why?
26747
26748 What's the point of Gnus?
26749
26750 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26751 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26752 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26753 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26754 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26755 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26756 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26757 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26758 keep track of millions of people who post?
26759
26760 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26761 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26762 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26763 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26764 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26765 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26766 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26767 every one of you to explore and invent.
26768
26769 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26770 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26771
26772
26773 @node Compatibility
26774 @subsection Compatibility
26775
26776 @cindex compatibility
26777 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26778 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26779 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26780
26781 Our motto is:
26782 @quotation
26783 @cartouche
26784 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26785 @end cartouche
26786 @end quotation
26787
26788 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26789 their names.
26790
26791 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26792 Articles}.
26793
26794 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26795 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26796 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26797 important variables have their values copied into their global
26798 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26799 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26800
26801 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26802 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26803 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26804 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26805 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26806 peculiar results.
26807
26808 @cindex hilit19
26809 @cindex highlighting
26810 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26811 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26812 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26813 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26814 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26815 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26816 Away!
26817
26818 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26819 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26820 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26821 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26822
26823 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26824 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26825 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26826 to stop doing it the old way.
26827
26828 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26829
26830 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26831 @findex gnus-bug
26832 @cindex reporting bugs
26833 @cindex bugs
26834 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26835 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26836 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26837
26838 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26839 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26840 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26841 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26842 up at you.
26843
26844
26845 @node Conformity
26846 @subsection Conformity
26847
26848 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26849 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26850 with, of course.
26851
26852 @table @strong
26853
26854 @item RFC (2)822
26855 @cindex RFC 822
26856 @cindex RFC 2822
26857 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26858
26859 @item RFC 1036
26860 @cindex RFC 1036
26861 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26862
26863 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26864 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26865 We do have some breaches to this one.
26866
26867 @table @emph
26868
26869 @item X-Newsreader
26870 @itemx User-Agent
26871 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26872 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26873 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26874 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26875 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26876 @end table
26877
26878 @item USEFOR
26879 @cindex USEFOR
26880 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26881 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26882 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26883 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26884
26885 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
26886 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26887 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26888
26889 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
26890 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26891
26892 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26893 @cindex RFC 1991
26894 @cindex RFC 2440
26895 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26896 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26897 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26898 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26899 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26900 decryption).
26901
26902 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
26903 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26904 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26905 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26906
26907 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
26908 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26909
26910 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26911 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26912 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26913 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26914 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26915 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26916 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26917 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26918
26919 @end table
26920
26921 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26922 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26923 know.
26924
26925
26926 @node Emacsen
26927 @subsection Emacsen
26928 @cindex Emacsen
26929 @cindex XEmacs
26930 @cindex Mule
26931 @cindex Emacs
26932
26933 This version of Gnus should work on:
26934
26935 @itemize @bullet
26936
26937 @item
26938 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26939
26940 @item
26941 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26942
26943 @end itemize
26944
26945 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26946 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26947 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26948 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26949
26950 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26951 @c synced here!
26952
26953 @node Gnus Development
26954 @subsection Gnus Development
26955
26956 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26957 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26958 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26959 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26960 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26961 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26962 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26963 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26964
26965 After futzing around for 10-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26966 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26967 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26968 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26969 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26970 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26971 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26972 in Emacs.
26973
26974 @cindex Incoming*
26975 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26976 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26977 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26978 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26979 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26980
26981 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26982 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26983 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26984 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26985 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26986 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26987 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26988 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26989 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26990 can't be assumed to do so.
26991
26992 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26993 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26994 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26995
26996 @cindex Incoming*
26997 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26998 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26999 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
27000 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
27001 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
27002
27003 @node Contributors
27004 @subsection Contributors
27005 @cindex contributors
27006
27007 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
27008 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
27009 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
27010 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
27011 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
27012 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
27013 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
27014 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
27015 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
27016 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
27017
27018 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
27019 wrong show.
27020
27021 @itemize @bullet
27022
27023 @item
27024 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
27025
27026 @item
27027 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
27028 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
27029 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
27030 functionality and stuff.
27031
27032 @item
27033 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
27034 well as numerous other things).
27035
27036 @item
27037 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
27038
27039 @item
27040 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
27041
27042 @item
27043 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
27044
27045 @item
27046 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
27047
27048 @item
27049 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
27050 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
27051
27052 @item
27053 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
27054
27055 @item
27056 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
27057
27058 @item
27059 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
27060
27061 @item
27062 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
27063
27064 @item
27065 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
27066
27067 @item
27068 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
27069
27070 @item
27071 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
27072 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
27073
27074 @item
27075 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
27076
27077 @item
27078 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
27079
27080 @item
27081 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
27082
27083 @item
27084 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
27085 .newsrc files.
27086
27087 @item
27088 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
27089
27090 @item
27091 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
27092
27093 @item
27094 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
27095
27096 @item
27097 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
27098 well as autoconf support.
27099
27100 @end itemize
27101
27102 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
27103 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
27104
27105 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
27106
27107 Christopher Davis,
27108 Andrew Eskilsson,
27109 Kai Grossjohann,
27110 Kevin Greiner,
27111 Jesper Harder,
27112 Paul Jarc,
27113 Simon Josefsson,
27114 David K@aa{}gedal,
27115 Richard Pieri,
27116 Fabrice Popineau,
27117 Daniel Quinlan,
27118 Michael Shields,
27119 Reiner Steib,
27120 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
27121 Jack Vinson,
27122 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
27123 and
27124 Teodor Zlatanov.
27125
27126 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
27127
27128 Jari Aalto,
27129 Adrian Aichner,
27130 Vladimir Alexiev,
27131 Russ Allbery,
27132 Peter Arius,
27133 Matt Armstrong,
27134 Marc Auslander,
27135 Miles Bader,
27136 Alexei V. Barantsev,
27137 Frank Bennett,
27138 Robert Bihlmeyer,
27139 Chris Bone,
27140 Mark Borges,
27141 Mark Boyns,
27142 Lance A. Brown,
27143 Rob Browning,
27144 Kees de Bruin,
27145 Martin Buchholz,
27146 Joe Buehler,
27147 Kevin Buhr,
27148 Alastair Burt,
27149 Joao Cachopo,
27150 Zlatko Calusic,
27151 Massimo Campostrini,
27152 Castor,
27153 David Charlap,
27154 Dan Christensen,
27155 Kevin Christian,
27156 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
27157 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
27158 Laura Conrad,
27159 Michael R. Cook,
27160 Glenn Coombs,
27161 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
27162 Neil Crellin,
27163 Frank D. Cringle,
27164 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
27165 Andre Deparade,
27166 Ulrik Dickow,
27167 Dave Disser,
27168 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
27169 Joev Dubach,
27170 Michael Welsh Duggan,
27171 Dave Edmondson,
27172 Paul Eggert,
27173 Mark W. Eichin,
27174 Karl Eichwalder,
27175 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
27176 Michael Ernst,
27177 Luc Van Eycken,
27178 Sam Falkner,
27179 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
27180 Sigbjorn Finne,
27181 Sven Fischer,
27182 Paul Fisher,
27183 Decklin Foster,
27184 Gary D. Foster,
27185 Paul Franklin,
27186 Guy Geens,
27187 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
27188 David S. Goldberg,
27189 Michelangelo Grigni,
27190 Dale Hagglund,
27191 D. Hall,
27192 Magnus Hammerin,
27193 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
27194 Raja R. Harinath,
27195 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
27196 P. E. Jareth Hein,
27197 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
27198 Scott Hofmann,
27199 Tassilo Horn,
27200 Marc Horowitz,
27201 Gunnar Horrigmo,
27202 Richard Hoskins,
27203 Brad Howes,
27204 Miguel de Icaza,
27205 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
27206 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
27207 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
27208 Lee Iverson,
27209 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
27210 Rajappa Iyer,
27211 Andreas Jaeger,
27212 Adam P. Jenkins,
27213 Randell Jesup,
27214 Fred Johansen,
27215 Gareth Jones,
27216 Greg Klanderman,
27217 Karl Kleinpaste,
27218 Michael Klingbeil,
27219 Peter Skov Knudsen,
27220 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
27221 Petr Konecny,
27222 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
27223 Thor Kristoffersen,
27224 Jens Lautenbacher,
27225 Martin Larose,
27226 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
27227 Joerg Lenneis,
27228 Carsten Leonhardt,
27229 James LewisMoss,
27230 Christian Limpach,
27231 Markus Linnala,
27232 Dave Love,
27233 Mike McEwan,
27234 Tonny Madsen,
27235 Shlomo Mahlab,
27236 Nat Makarevitch,
27237 Istvan Marko,
27238 David Martin,
27239 Jason R. Mastaler,
27240 Gordon Matzigkeit,
27241 Timo Metzemakers,
27242 Richard Mlynarik,
27243 Lantz Moore,
27244 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
27245 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
27246 Hrvoje Niksic,
27247 Andy Norman,
27248 Fred Oberhauser,
27249 C. R. Oldham,
27250 Alexandre Oliva,
27251 Ken Olstad,
27252 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
27253 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
27254 Ettore Perazzoli,
27255 William Perry,
27256 Stephen Peters,
27257 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
27258 Ulrich Pfeifer,
27259 Matt Pharr,
27260 Andy Piper,
27261 John McClary Prevost,
27262 Bill Pringlemeir,
27263 Mike Pullen,
27264 Jim Radford,
27265 Colin Rafferty,
27266 Lasse Rasinen,
27267 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
27268 Joe Reiss,
27269 Renaud Rioboo,
27270 Roland B. Roberts,
27271 Bart Robinson,
27272 Christian von Roques,
27273 Markus Rost,
27274 Jason Rumney,
27275 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
27276 Jay Sachs,
27277 Dewey M. Sasser,
27278 Conrad Sauerwald,
27279 Loren Schall,
27280 Dan Schmidt,
27281 Ralph Schleicher,
27282 Philippe Schnoebelen,
27283 Andreas Schwab,
27284 Randal L. Schwartz,
27285 Danny Siu,
27286 Matt Simmons,
27287 Paul D. Smith,
27288 Jeff Sparkes,
27289 Toby Speight,
27290 Michael Sperber,
27291 Darren Stalder,
27292 Richard Stallman,
27293 Greg Stark,
27294 Sam Steingold,
27295 Paul Stevenson,
27296 Jonas Steverud,
27297 Paul Stodghill,
27298 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
27299 Kurt Swanson,
27300 Samuel Tardieu,
27301 Teddy,
27302 Chuck Thompson,
27303 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
27304 Philippe Troin,
27305 James Troup,
27306 Trung Tran-Duc,
27307 Jack Twilley,
27308 Aaron M. Ucko,
27309 Aki Vehtari,
27310 Didier Verna,
27311 Vladimir Volovich,
27312 Jan Vroonhof,
27313 Stefan Waldherr,
27314 Pete Ware,
27315 Barry A. Warsaw,
27316 Christoph Wedler,
27317 Joe Wells,
27318 Lee Willis,
27319 and
27320 Lloyd Zusman.
27321
27322
27323 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27324 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27325 (550kB and counting).
27326
27327 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27328 sure.
27329
27330 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27331 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27332
27333
27334 @node New Features
27335 @subsection New Features
27336 @cindex new features
27337
27338 @menu
27339 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27340 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27341 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27342 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27343 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27344 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
27345 * No Gnus:: Very punny.
27346 @end menu
27347
27348 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27349 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27350 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27351
27352 @node ding Gnus
27353 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27354
27355 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27356
27357 @itemize @bullet
27358
27359 @item
27360 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27361 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27362
27363 @item
27364 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27365 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27366
27367 @item
27368 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27369
27370 @item
27371 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27372 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27373 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27374
27375 @item
27376 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27377 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27378 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27379 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27380
27381 @item
27382 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27383 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27384
27385 @item
27386 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27387 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27388 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27389
27390 @item
27391 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27392 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27393
27394 @item
27395 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27396 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27397 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27398
27399 @item
27400 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27401 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27402 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27403
27404 @item
27405 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27406 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27407
27408 @item
27409 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27410 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27411
27412 @item
27413 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
27414 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
27415
27416 @item
27417 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27418 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27419
27420 @item
27421 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27422 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27423
27424 @item
27425 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27426 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27427
27428 @item
27429 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27430
27431 @item
27432 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27433 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27434
27435 @item
27436 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27437 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27438
27439 @item
27440 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27441 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27442
27443 @item
27444 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27445
27446 @item
27447 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27448 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27449
27450 @item
27451 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27452 Articles}).
27453
27454 @item
27455 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27456 Buttons}).
27457
27458 @item
27459 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27460 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27461
27462 @item
27463 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
27464 (@pxref{Buttons}).
27465
27466 @end itemize
27467
27468
27469 @node September Gnus
27470 @subsubsection September Gnus
27471
27472 @iftex
27473 @iflatex
27474 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27475 @end iflatex
27476 @end iftex
27477
27478 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27479
27480 @itemize @bullet
27481
27482 @item
27483 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27484 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27485 now obsolete.
27486
27487 @item
27488 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27489 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27490 Threading}).
27491
27492 @lisp
27493 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27494 @end lisp
27495
27496 @item
27497 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27498 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27499
27500 @item
27501 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27502 referred.
27503
27504 @item
27505 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27506
27507 @item
27508 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27509
27510 @item
27511 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27512
27513 @lisp
27514 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27515 @end lisp
27516
27517 @item
27518 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27519 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27520
27521 @lisp
27522 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27523 @end lisp
27524
27525 @item
27526 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27527 Groups}).
27528
27529 @item
27530 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27531 Topics}).
27532
27533 @lisp
27534 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27535 @end lisp
27536
27537 @item
27538 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27539
27540 @item
27541 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27542 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27543
27544 @lisp
27545 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27546 @end lisp
27547
27548 @item
27549 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27550 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27551
27552 @item
27553 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27554
27555 @item
27556 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27557 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27558 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27559
27560 @item
27561 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
27562 (@pxref{SOUP}).
27563
27564 @item
27565 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27566
27567 @item
27568 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27569 Groups}).
27570
27571 @item
27572 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27573 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27574
27575 @item
27576 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27577 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27578
27579 @item
27580 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27581 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27582
27583 @item
27584 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27585 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27586 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27587
27588 @item
27589 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27590 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27591
27592 @item
27593 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27594
27595 @item
27596 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27597
27598 @item
27599 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27600
27601 @item
27602 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27603
27604 @item
27605 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27606 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27607
27608 @item
27609 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27610 Layout}).
27611
27612 @item
27613 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27614 @iftex
27615 @iflatex
27616 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27617 @end iflatex
27618 @end iftex
27619
27620 @item
27621 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
27622
27623 @lisp
27624 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
27625 @end lisp
27626
27627 @item
27628 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27629
27630 @lisp
27631 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27632 @end lisp
27633
27634 @item
27635 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27636
27637 @item
27638 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27639
27640 @item
27641 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27642 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27643
27644 @lisp
27645 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27646 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27647 @end lisp
27648
27649 @item
27650 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27651 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27652
27653 @lisp
27654 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27655 @end lisp
27656
27657 @item
27658 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27659 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27660
27661 @item
27662 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27663
27664 @item
27665 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27666 Articles}).
27667
27668 @lisp
27669 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27670 @end lisp
27671
27672 @item
27673 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27674 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27675
27676 @lisp
27677 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27678 @end lisp
27679
27680 @item
27681 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27682 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27683
27684 @item
27685 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27686 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27687
27688 @lisp
27689 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27690 @end lisp
27691
27692 @item
27693 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27694
27695 @item
27696 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27697
27698 @item
27699 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27700
27701 @end itemize
27702
27703
27704 @node Red Gnus
27705 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27706
27707 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27708
27709 @iftex
27710 @iflatex
27711 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27712 @end iflatex
27713 @end iftex
27714
27715 @itemize @bullet
27716
27717 @item
27718 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27719
27720 @item
27721 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27722 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27723
27724 @item
27725 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27726 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27727 Scoring}).
27728
27729 @item
27730 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27731 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27732
27733 @item
27734 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27735
27736 @item
27737 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27738 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27739
27740 @lisp
27741 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27742 @end lisp
27743
27744 @item
27745 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27746 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27747 been added.
27748
27749 @item
27750 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
27751 Server Internals}).
27752
27753 @item
27754 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27755 Parameters}).
27756
27757 @item
27758 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27759
27760 @item
27761 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27762 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27763
27764 @item
27765 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27766 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27767 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27768
27769 @item
27770 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27771 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27772
27773 @item
27774 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27775 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27776
27777 @item
27778 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27779 (@pxref{Undo}).
27780
27781 @item
27782 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27783 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27784
27785 @item
27786 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27787 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27788
27789 @lisp
27790 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27791 @end lisp
27792
27793 @item
27794 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27795
27796 @lisp
27797 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27798 @end lisp
27799
27800 @item
27801 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27802 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27803
27804 @item
27805 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27806 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27807
27808 @item
27809 A new command for reading collections of documents
27810 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27811 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27812
27813 @item
27814 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27815 Marks}).
27816
27817 @item
27818 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27819 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27820
27821 @item
27822 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27823 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27824 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27825
27826 @item
27827 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27828 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27829 Sorting}).
27830
27831 @item
27832 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27833 Groups}).
27834
27835 @item
27836 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27837 Commands}).
27838 @iftex
27839 @iflatex
27840 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27841 @end iflatex
27842 @end iftex
27843
27844 @item
27845 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27846 Variables}).
27847
27848 @item
27849 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27850 Mail}).
27851
27852 @item
27853 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27854 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27855
27856 @item
27857 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27858
27859 @end itemize
27860
27861
27862 @node Quassia Gnus
27863 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27864
27865 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27866
27867 @itemize @bullet
27868
27869 @item
27870 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27871 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27872 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27873
27874 @item
27875 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27876 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27877 group, which is created automatically.
27878
27879 @item
27880 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27881 values.
27882
27883 @item
27884 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
27885
27886 @item
27887 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27888 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27889
27890 @item
27891 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27892 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27893
27894 @item
27895 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27896
27897 @item
27898 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27899 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27900
27901 @item
27902 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27903
27904 @item
27905 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27906 details.
27907
27908 @item
27909 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27910 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27911
27912 @item
27913 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27914 control over simplification.
27915
27916 @item
27917 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27918
27919 @item
27920 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27921 limit.
27922
27923 @item
27924 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27925
27926 @item
27927 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27928
27929 @item
27930 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27931 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27932 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27933
27934 @item
27935 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27936 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27937
27938 @item
27939 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27940 text---@kbd{W d}.
27941
27942 @item
27943 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27944 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27945
27946 @item
27947 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27948 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27949
27950 @item
27951 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27952 has been added.
27953
27954 @item
27955 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27956
27957 @item
27958 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27959
27960 @item
27961 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27962 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27963
27964 @item
27965 A new function for citing in Message has been
27966 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27967
27968 @item
27969 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27970
27971 @item
27972 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27973 been added.
27974
27975 @item
27976 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27977 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27978
27979 @item
27980 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27981 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27982
27983 @item
27984 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27985
27986 @item
27987 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27988
27989 @end itemize
27990
27991 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27992 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27993
27994 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27995
27996 @itemize @bullet
27997
27998 @item
27999 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
28000 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
28001
28002 If you used procmail like in
28003
28004 @lisp
28005 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
28006 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
28007 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
28008 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
28009 @end lisp
28010
28011 this now has changed to
28012
28013 @lisp
28014 (setq mail-sources
28015 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
28016 :suffix ".in")))
28017 @end lisp
28018
28019 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
28020
28021 @item
28022 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
28023 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
28024
28025 @item
28026 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
28027 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
28028
28029 @item
28030 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
28031 called to position point.
28032
28033 @item
28034 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
28035 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
28036
28037 @item
28038 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
28039 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
28040
28041 @item
28042 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
28043 subtly different manner.
28044
28045 @item
28046 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
28047 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
28048 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
28049
28050 @item
28051 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
28052
28053 @end itemize
28054
28055 @node Oort Gnus
28056 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
28057 @cindex Oort Gnus
28058
28059 New features in Gnus 5.10:
28060
28061 @itemize @bullet
28062
28063 @item Installation changes
28064 @c ***********************
28065
28066 @itemize @bullet
28067 @item
28068 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
28069
28070 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
28071 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
28072 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
28073 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
28074 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
28075 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
28076 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
28077 isn't save in general.
28078
28079 @item
28080 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
28081 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
28082 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
28083 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
28084 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
28085 remove-installed-shadows}.
28086
28087 @item
28088 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
28089
28090 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
28091 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
28092 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
28093 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
28094 the second parameter.
28095
28096 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
28097 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
28098 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
28099 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
28100 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
28101 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
28102 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
28103 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
28104 cycle used under Unix systems.
28105
28106 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
28107 superfluous, so they have been removed.
28108
28109 @item
28110 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
28111
28112 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
28113 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
28114 hierarchy.
28115
28116 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
28117 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
28118 @item
28119 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
28120
28121 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
28122 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
28123 lisp directory into load-path.
28124
28125 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
28126 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
28127
28128 @end itemize
28129
28130 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
28131 @c *****************************************
28132
28133 @itemize @bullet
28134
28135 @item
28136 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
28137 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
28138
28139 @item
28140 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
28141
28142 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
28143 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
28144 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
28145 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
28146
28147 @item
28148 Improved anti-spam features.
28149
28150 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
28151 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
28152 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
28153 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
28154 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
28155 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
28156
28157 @item
28158 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
28159
28160 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
28161 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
28162 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
28163 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
28164 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
28165
28166 @end itemize
28167
28168 @item Changes in group mode
28169 @c ************************
28170
28171 @itemize @bullet
28172
28173 @item
28174 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
28175 using @kbd{G M}.
28176
28177 @item
28178 Retrieval of charters and control messages
28179
28180 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
28181 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
28182
28183 @item
28184 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
28185
28186 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
28187 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
28188 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
28189 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
28190 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
28191 parameters, a'la:
28192 @lisp
28193 (setq gnus-parameters
28194 '(("mail\\..*"
28195 (gnus-show-threads nil)
28196 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
28197 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
28198 (to-group . "\\1"))))
28199 @end lisp
28200
28201 @item
28202 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
28203
28204 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
28205 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
28206 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
28207 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
28208 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
28209 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
28210 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
28211 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
28212 when getting new mail, remove the function.
28213
28214 @item
28215 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
28216
28217 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
28218 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
28219 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
28220
28221 @item
28222 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
28223 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
28224
28225 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
28226 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
28227 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
28228 @lisp
28229 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
28230 @end lisp
28231
28232 @item
28233 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
28234 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
28235 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
28236
28237 @end itemize
28238
28239 @item Changes in summary and article mode
28240 @c **************************************
28241
28242 @itemize @bullet
28243
28244 @item
28245 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
28246 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
28247 region if the region is active.
28248
28249 @item
28250 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
28251 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
28252
28253 @item
28254 Article Buttons
28255
28256 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
28257 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
28258 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
28259 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
28260
28261 @item
28262 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
28263
28264 @item
28265 Picons
28266
28267 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
28268 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
28269
28270 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
28271 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
28272 @xref{Picons}.
28273
28274 @item
28275 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
28276 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
28277
28278 @item
28279 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
28280
28281 @item
28282 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
28283 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
28284
28285 @item
28286 Warn about email replies to news
28287
28288 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
28289 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
28290 you.
28291
28292 @item
28293 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
28294 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
28295 built.
28296
28297 @item
28298 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
28299 opposed to old but unread messages).
28300
28301 @item
28302 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
28303 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
28304
28305 @item
28306 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
28307 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
28308
28309 @item
28310 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
28311 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
28312
28313 @item
28314 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
28315
28316 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
28317 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
28318 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
28319 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
28320 citations.
28321
28322 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
28323 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
28324 Outlook (Express) articles.
28325
28326 @item
28327 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
28328
28329 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
28330 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
28331 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
28332 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
28333
28334 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
28335 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
28336 message cited below.
28337
28338 @item
28339 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
28340 Emacs too.
28341
28342 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28343 disable it.
28344
28345 @item
28346 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28347
28348 @item
28349 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28350 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28351
28352 @item
28353 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28354
28355 @item
28356 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28357
28358 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28359 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28360 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28361 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28362 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28363 groups.
28364
28365 @item
28366 Deleting of attachments.
28367
28368 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28369 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28370 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28371 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28372 that support editing.
28373
28374 @item
28375 @code{gnus-default-charset}
28376
28377 The default value is determined from the
28378 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28379 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28380 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28381
28382 @item
28383 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28384
28385 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28386 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28387 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28388
28389 @item
28390 Extended format specs.
28391
28392 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28393 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28394 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28395 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28396 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28397 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28398
28399 @item
28400 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28401 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28402
28403 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28404 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28405 out other articles.
28406
28407 @item
28408 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28409
28410 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28411 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28412 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28413 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28414
28415 @item
28416 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28417
28418 @end itemize
28419
28420 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28421 @c ****************************************************
28422
28423 @itemize @bullet
28424
28425 @item
28426 Delayed articles
28427
28428 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28429 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28430 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28431
28432 @item
28433 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28434 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28435
28436 @item
28437 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28438 Gcc articles as read.
28439
28440 @item
28441 Externalizing of attachments
28442
28443 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28444 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28445 local files as external parts.
28446
28447 @item
28448 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28449 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28450
28451 @item
28452 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28453
28454 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28455 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28456 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28457 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28458 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28459 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28460 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28461 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28462 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28463
28464 @item
28465 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28466
28467 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28468 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28469 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28470 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28471 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28472 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28473
28474 @item
28475 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28476 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28477 @code{nil}.
28478
28479 @item
28480 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28481
28482 @item
28483 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28484
28485 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28486 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28487 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28488 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28489 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28490 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28491 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28492 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28493 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28494 was inserted directly.
28495
28496 @item
28497 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28498
28499 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28500 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28501 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28502 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28503
28504 @item
28505 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28506
28507 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28508 @lisp
28509 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28510 'bbdb-complete-name)
28511 @end lisp
28512
28513 @item
28514 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28515
28516 Add a new format of match like
28517 @lisp
28518 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28519 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28520 @end lisp
28521 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28522 @lisp
28523 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28524 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28525 @end lisp
28526
28527 @item
28528 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28529
28530 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28531 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28532 need add those two headers too.
28533
28534 @item
28535 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28536 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28537 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28538 versions.
28539
28540 @item
28541 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28542 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28543 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28544 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28545 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28546
28547 @item
28548 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28549
28550 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28551
28552 @item
28553 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28554
28555 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28556 the valid values.
28557
28558 @item
28559 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28560
28561 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28562 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28563 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28564 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28565 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28566 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28567 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28568 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28569
28570 @item
28571 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28572 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
28573
28574 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28575 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28576 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28577 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28578
28579 @item
28580 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28581 C-m}.
28582
28583 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28584 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28585
28586 @item
28587 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28588 @code{best}.
28589
28590 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28591 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28592 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28593 invalidate the digital signature.
28594
28595 @item
28596 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28597 decompressed when activated.
28598 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28599
28600 @item
28601 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28602
28603 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28604 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28605 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28606 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28607 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28608 controls this.
28609
28610 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28611 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28612 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28613 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 21.1)
28614
28615 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28616 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28617 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28618 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28619
28620 @end itemize
28621
28622 @item Changes in back ends
28623 @c ***********************
28624
28625 @itemize @bullet
28626 @item
28627 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28628
28629 @item
28630 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28631
28632 @item
28633 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28634
28635 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28636
28637 @item
28638 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28639
28640 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28641 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28642 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28643 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
28644 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28645 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28646 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28647 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28648 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28649 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28650 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28651
28652 @end itemize
28653
28654 @item Appearance
28655 @c *************
28656
28657 @itemize @bullet
28658
28659 @item
28660 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28661 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28662
28663 @item
28664 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28665 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28666 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28667 message, Message Manual}).
28668
28669 @item
28670 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28671 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28672 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28673 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28674
28675 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28676 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28677 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28678 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28679 @end itemize
28680
28681
28682 @item Miscellaneous changes
28683 @c ************************
28684
28685 @itemize @bullet
28686
28687 @item
28688 @code{gnus-agent}
28689
28690 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28691 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28692 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28693 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28694 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28695 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28696 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28697 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28698 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28699 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28700 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28701 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28702 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28703 is not needed any more.
28704
28705 @item
28706 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28707
28708 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28709 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28710 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28711
28712 @item
28713 Dired integration
28714
28715 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28716 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28717 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28718 entry.
28719
28720 @item
28721 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28722
28723 @item
28724 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28725
28726 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28727
28728 @end itemize
28729
28730 @end itemize
28731
28732 @node No Gnus
28733 @subsubsection No Gnus
28734 @cindex No Gnus
28735
28736 New features in No Gnus:
28737 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28738
28739 @include gnus-news.texi
28740
28741 @iftex
28742
28743 @page
28744 @node The Manual
28745 @section The Manual
28746 @cindex colophon
28747 @cindex manual
28748
28749 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28750 either @code{texi2dvi}
28751 @iflatex
28752 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28753 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28754 @end iflatex
28755 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28756
28757 The following conventions have been used:
28758
28759 @enumerate
28760
28761 @item
28762 This is a @samp{string}
28763
28764 @item
28765 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28766
28767 @item
28768 This is a @file{file}
28769
28770 @item
28771 This is a @code{symbol}
28772
28773 @end enumerate
28774
28775 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28776 mean:
28777
28778 @lisp
28779 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28780 @end lisp
28781
28782 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28783
28784 @lisp
28785 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28786 @end lisp
28787
28788 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28789 ever get them confused.
28790
28791 @iflatex
28792 @c @head
28793 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28794 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28795 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28796 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28797 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28798 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28799 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28800 @end iflatex
28801
28802 @end iftex
28803
28804
28805 @node On Writing Manuals
28806 @section On Writing Manuals
28807
28808 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28809 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28810 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28811 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28812 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28813 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28814 in hand.
28815
28816 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28817 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28818 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28819 started with Gnus.
28820
28821 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28822 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28823
28824
28825 @page
28826 @node Terminology
28827 @section Terminology
28828
28829 @cindex terminology
28830 @table @dfn
28831
28832 @item news
28833 @cindex news
28834 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28835 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28836 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28837 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28838 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28839
28840 @item mail
28841 @cindex mail
28842 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28843 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28844 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28845 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28846
28847 @item reply
28848 @cindex reply
28849 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28850
28851 @item follow up
28852 @cindex follow up
28853 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28854 are reading.
28855
28856 @item back end
28857 @cindex back end
28858 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28859 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28860 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28861 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28862 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28863 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28864 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28865 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28866 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28867 number 4711''.
28868
28869 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28870 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28871 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28872 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28873 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28874 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28875
28876 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28877 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28878 access the articles.
28879
28880 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28881 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28882 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28883 confusing.
28884
28885 @item native
28886 @cindex native
28887 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28888 default, way of getting news.
28889
28890 @item foreign
28891 @cindex foreign
28892 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
28893 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
28894 news.
28895
28896 @item secondary
28897 @cindex secondary
28898 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
28899 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
28900
28901 @item article
28902 @cindex article
28903 A message that has been posted as news.
28904
28905 @item mail message
28906 @cindex mail message
28907 A message that has been mailed.
28908
28909 @item message
28910 @cindex message
28911 A mail message or news article
28912
28913 @item head
28914 @cindex head
28915 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28916 put.
28917
28918 @item body
28919 @cindex body
28920 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28921 body.
28922
28923 @item header
28924 @cindex header
28925 A line from the head of an article.
28926
28927 @item headers
28928 @cindex headers
28929 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28930 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28931
28932 @item @acronym{NOV}
28933 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28934 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28935 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28936 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28937 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28938 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28939
28940 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28941 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28942 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28943 normal @sc{head} format.
28944
28945 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28946 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28947 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28948 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28949 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28950 references, etc.
28951
28952 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28953 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28954 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28955 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28956 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28957 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28958 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28959
28960 @item level
28961 @cindex levels
28962 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
28963 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28964 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
28965 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28966 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28967 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28968
28969 @item killed groups
28970 @cindex killed groups
28971 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28972 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28973
28974 @item zombie groups
28975 @cindex zombie groups
28976 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28977
28978 @item active file
28979 @cindex active file
28980 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28981 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28982 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28983
28984 @item bogus groups
28985 @cindex bogus groups
28986 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28987 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28988 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28989
28990 @item activating
28991 @cindex activating groups
28992 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28993 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28994 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28995
28996 @item spool
28997 @cindex spool
28998 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28999 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
29000 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
29001
29002 @item server
29003 @cindex server
29004 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
29005
29006 @item select method
29007 @cindex select method
29008 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
29009 server settings.
29010
29011 @item virtual server
29012 @cindex virtual server
29013 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
29014 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
29015 whole is a virtual server.
29016
29017 @item washing
29018 @cindex washing
29019 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
29020 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
29021 original.
29022
29023 @item ephemeral groups
29024 @cindex ephemeral groups
29025 @cindex temporary groups
29026 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
29027 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
29028 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
29029
29030 @item solid groups
29031 @cindex solid groups
29032 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
29033 group buffer are solid groups.
29034
29035 @item sparse articles
29036 @cindex sparse articles
29037 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
29038 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
29039
29040 @item threading
29041 @cindex threading
29042 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
29043 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
29044
29045 @item root
29046 @cindex root
29047 @cindex thread root
29048 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
29049 articles in the thread.
29050
29051 @item parent
29052 @cindex parent
29053 An article that has responses.
29054
29055 @item child
29056 @cindex child
29057 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
29058
29059 @item digest
29060 @cindex digest
29061 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
29062 specified by RFC 1153.
29063
29064 @item splitting
29065 @cindex splitting, terminology
29066 @cindex mail sorting
29067 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
29068 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
29069 incorrectly called mail filtering.
29070
29071 @end table
29072
29073
29074 @page
29075 @node Customization
29076 @section Customization
29077 @cindex general customization
29078
29079 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
29080 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
29081 for some quite common situations.
29082
29083 @menu
29084 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
29085 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
29086 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
29087 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
29088 @end menu
29089
29090
29091 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
29092 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
29093
29094 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
29095 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
29096 Gnus has to get from the server.
29097
29098 @table @code
29099
29100 @item gnus-read-active-file
29101 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
29102 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
29103 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
29104 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
29105 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
29106
29107 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
29108 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
29109 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
29110 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
29111 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
29112 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
29113 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
29114 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
29115 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
29116 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
29117 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
29118
29119 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
29120 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
29121 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
29122 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}, and
29123 @code{nnwarchive-nov-is-evil}. Note that a non-@code{nil} value for
29124 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those variables.@footnote{Although
29125 the back ends @code{nnkiboze}, @code{nnslashdot}, @code{nnultimate}, and
29126 @code{nnwfm} don't have their own nn*-nov-is-evil.}
29127 @end table
29128
29129
29130 @node Slow Terminal Connection
29131 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
29132
29133 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
29134 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
29135 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
29136
29137 @table @code
29138
29139 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
29140 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
29141 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
29142 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
29143 horizontal and vertical recentering.
29144
29145 @item gnus-visible-headers
29146 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
29147 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
29148 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
29149 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
29150
29151 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
29152 @lisp
29153 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
29154 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
29155 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
29156 @end lisp
29157
29158 @item gnus-use-full-window
29159 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
29160 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
29161 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
29162 want to read them anyway.
29163
29164 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
29165 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
29166 hidden initially.
29167
29168
29169 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
29170 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
29171 lines, which might save some time.
29172 @end table
29173
29174
29175 @node Little Disk Space
29176 @subsection Little Disk Space
29177 @cindex disk space
29178
29179 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
29180 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
29181
29182 @table @code
29183
29184 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
29185 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
29186 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
29187 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
29188 default.
29189
29190 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
29191 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
29192 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
29193 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
29194 default.
29195
29196 @item gnus-save-killed-list
29197 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
29198 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
29199 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
29200 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
29201
29202 @end table
29203
29204
29205 @node Slow Machine
29206 @subsection Slow Machine
29207 @cindex slow machine
29208
29209 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
29210 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
29211
29212 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
29213 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
29214
29215 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
29216 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
29217 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
29218
29219
29220 @page
29221 @node Troubleshooting
29222 @section Troubleshooting
29223 @cindex troubleshooting
29224
29225 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
29226 problems, really.
29227
29228 Ahem.
29229
29230 @enumerate
29231
29232 @item
29233 Make sure your computer is switched on.
29234
29235 @item
29236 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
29237 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
29238 Gnus will work.
29239
29240 @item
29241 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
29242 like @c
29243 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
29244 @c
29245 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
29246 files lying around. Delete these.
29247
29248 @item
29249 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
29250 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
29251
29252 @item
29253 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
29254 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
29255 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
29256 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
29257 something like that.
29258 @end enumerate
29259
29260 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
29261
29262 @cindex bugs
29263 @cindex reporting bugs
29264
29265 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
29266 @findex gnus-bug
29267 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
29268 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
29269 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
29270 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
29271
29272 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
29273 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
29274 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
29275 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
29276 time.
29277
29278 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
29279 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
29280 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
29281 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
29282 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
29283 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
29284
29285 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
29286 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
29287 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
29288 the bug report.
29289
29290 @cindex patches
29291 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
29292 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
29293
29294 @cindex edebug
29295 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
29296 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
29297 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
29298 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
29299 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
29300 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
29301 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
29302 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
29303 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
29304 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
29305 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
29306 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
29307 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
29308 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
29309
29310 @cindex elp
29311 @cindex profile
29312 @cindex slow
29313 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
29314 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
29315 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
29316 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
29317 helps isolating the real problem areas).
29318
29319 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
29320 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
29321 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
29322 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
29323 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
29324 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
29325 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
29326 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
29327 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
29328 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
29329 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
29330 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
29331 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
29332 work perfectly.
29333
29334 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29335 @cindex ding mailing list
29336 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29337 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29338 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29339 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29340
29341
29342 @page
29343 @node Gnus Reference Guide
29344 @section Gnus Reference Guide
29345
29346 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29347 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29348 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29349 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29350 it.
29351
29352 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29353 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29354 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29355 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29356 and general methods of operation.
29357
29358 @menu
29359 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29360 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29361 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29362 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29363 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29364 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29365 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29366 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29367 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29368 @end menu
29369
29370
29371 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29372 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29373 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29374 @cindex utility functions
29375 @cindex functions
29376 @cindex internal variables
29377
29378 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29379 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29380 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29381
29382 @table @code
29383
29384 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29385 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29386 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29387
29388 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29389 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29390 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29391
29392 @item gnus-group-real-name
29393 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29394 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29395 name.
29396
29397 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29398 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29399 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29400 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29401
29402 @item gnus-get-info
29403 @findex gnus-get-info
29404 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
29405
29406 @item gnus-group-unread
29407 @findex gnus-group-unread
29408 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29409 unknown.
29410
29411 @item gnus-active
29412 @findex gnus-active
29413 The active entry for @var{group}.
29414
29415 @item gnus-set-active
29416 @findex gnus-set-active
29417 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29418
29419 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29420 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29421 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29422 exit.
29423
29424 @item gnus-continuum-version
29425 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29426 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29427 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29428 versions.
29429
29430 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29431 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29432 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29433
29434 @item gnus-news-group-p
29435 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29436 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29437
29438 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29439 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29440 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29441
29442 @item gnus-server-to-method
29443 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29444 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29445
29446 @item gnus-server-equal
29447 @findex gnus-server-equal
29448 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
29449
29450 @item gnus-group-native-p
29451 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29452 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29453
29454 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29455 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29456 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29457
29458 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29459 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29460 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29461
29462 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29463 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29464 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
29465 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
29466
29467 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29468 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29469 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29470
29471 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29472 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29473 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29474
29475 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29476 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29477 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29478 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29479
29480 @lisp
29481 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29482 @result{} t
29483 @end lisp
29484
29485 @item gnus-read-method
29486 @findex gnus-read-method
29487 Prompts the user for a select method.
29488
29489 @end table
29490
29491
29492 @node Back End Interface
29493 @subsection Back End Interface
29494
29495 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29496 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29497 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29498 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29499 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29500 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29501
29502 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29503 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29504 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29505 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29506 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29507 been opened, the function should fail.
29508
29509 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29510 name. Take this example:
29511
29512 @lisp
29513 (nntp "odd-one"
29514 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29515 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29516 @end lisp
29517
29518 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29519 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29520
29521 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29522 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29523 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29524
29525 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29526 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29527 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29528
29529 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29530 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29531 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29532 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29533 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29534 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29535 return value.
29536
29537 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29538 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29539 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
29540 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29541 more.
29542
29543 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29544 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29545 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29546 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29547 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29548 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29549 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29550 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29551 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29552 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29553
29554 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29555 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29556 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29557 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29558 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29559 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29560 of numbers as long as possible.
29561
29562 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29563 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29564 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29565
29566 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29567 @code{nnchoke}.
29568
29569 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29570
29571 @menu
29572 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29573 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29574 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29575 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29576 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29577 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29578 @end menu
29579
29580
29581 @node Required Back End Functions
29582 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29583
29584 @table @code
29585
29586 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29587
29588 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29589 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29590 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29591 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29592
29593 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29594 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29595 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29596 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29597
29598 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29599 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29600 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29601 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29602 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29603 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29604 number, do maximum fetches.
29605
29606 Here's an example HEAD:
29607
29608 @example
29609 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29610 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29611 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29612 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29613 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29614 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29615 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29616 Lines: 26
29617 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29618 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29619 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29620 .
29621 @end example
29622
29623 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29624 these in the data buffer.
29625
29626 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29627
29628 @example
29629 headers = *head
29630 head = error / valid-head
29631 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29632 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29633 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29634 header = <text> eol
29635 @end example
29636
29637 @cindex BNF
29638 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29639
29640 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29641 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29642 separated by tabs.
29643
29644 @example
29645 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29646 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29647 field = <text except TAB>
29648 @end example
29649
29650 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29651 @pxref{Headers}.
29652
29653
29654 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29655
29656 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29657 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29658
29659 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29660 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29661 server. In fact, it should do so.
29662
29663 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29664 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29665
29666
29667 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29668
29669 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29670 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29671 reason.
29672
29673 There should be no data returned.
29674
29675
29676 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29677
29678 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29679 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29680 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29681 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29682
29683 There should be no data returned.
29684
29685
29686 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29687
29688 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29689 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29690 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29691 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29692
29693 There should be no data returned.
29694
29695
29696 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29697
29698 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29699
29700 There should be no data returned.
29701
29702
29703 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29704
29705 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29706 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29707 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29708 it would be nice if that were possible.
29709
29710 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29711 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29712 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29713 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29714 into its article buffer.
29715
29716 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29717 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29718 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29719 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29720 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29721 on successful article retrieval.
29722
29723
29724 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
29725
29726 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29727 making @var{group} the current group.
29728
29729 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29730 the current group.
29731
29732 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29733
29734 @example
29735 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29736 @end example
29737
29738 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29739 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29740 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29741 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29742 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29743 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29744 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29745 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29746 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29747 highest as 0.
29748
29749 @example
29750 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29751 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29752 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29753 @end example
29754
29755
29756 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29757
29758 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29759 a no-op on most back ends.
29760
29761 There should be no data returned.
29762
29763
29764 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29765
29766 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29767 @emph{all}.
29768
29769 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29770
29771 @example
29772 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29773 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29774 @end example
29775
29776 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29777 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29778 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29779 and the highest as 0.
29780
29781 @example
29782 active-file = *active-line
29783 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29784 name = <string>
29785 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29786 @end example
29787
29788 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29789 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29790 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29791
29792
29793 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29794
29795 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29796 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29797 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29798 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29799 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29800 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29801
29802 There should be no result data from this function.
29803
29804 @end table
29805
29806
29807 @node Optional Back End Functions
29808 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29809
29810 @table @code
29811
29812 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29813
29814 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29815 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29816 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29817
29818 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29819 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29820 former is in the same format as the data from
29821 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29822 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29823
29824 @example
29825 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29826 @end example
29827
29828
29829 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29830
29831 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29832 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29833 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29834 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29835 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29836 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29837 the network resources).
29838
29839 There should be no result data from this function.
29840
29841
29842 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29843
29844 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29845 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29846 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29847 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29848 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29849 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29850 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29851 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29852
29853 There should be no result data from this function.
29854
29855
29856 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29857
29858 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29859 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29860 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29861 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29862 propagate the mark information to the server.
29863
29864 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29865
29866 @example
29867 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29868 @end example
29869
29870 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29871 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29872 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29873 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29874 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29875 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
29876 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
29877 possible, not limit itself to these.
29878
29879 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29880 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29881 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29882 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29883
29884 An example action list:
29885
29886 @example
29887 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29888 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29889 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29890 @end example
29891
29892 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29893 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29894
29895 There should be no result data from this function.
29896
29897 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29898
29899 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29900 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29901 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29902 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29903 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29904
29905 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29906 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29907 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29908 expirable.
29909
29910 There should be no result data from this function.
29911
29912
29913 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29914
29915 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29916 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29917 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29918 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29919 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29920 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29921 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29922 local if that's practical.
29923
29924 There should be no result data from this function.
29925
29926
29927 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29928
29929 The result data from this function should be a description of
29930 @var{group}.
29931
29932 @example
29933 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29934 name = <string>
29935 description = <text>
29936 @end example
29937
29938 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29939
29940 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29941 groups available on the server.
29942
29943 @example
29944 description-buffer = *description-line
29945 @end example
29946
29947
29948 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29949
29950 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29951 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29952 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29953 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29954 in the active buffer format.
29955
29956 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29957 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29958 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29959 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29960 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29961 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29962 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29963
29964
29965 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29966
29967 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29968
29969 There should be no return data.
29970
29971
29972 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29973
29974 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29975 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29976 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29977 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29978 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29979 they are.
29980
29981 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29982 able to delete.
29983
29984 There should be no result data returned.
29985
29986
29987 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29988
29989 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29990 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29991
29992 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29993 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29994 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29995 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29996 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29997 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29998
29999 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
30000 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
30001 optimizations.
30002
30003 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
30004 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
30005
30006 There should be no data returned.
30007
30008
30009 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
30010
30011 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
30012 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
30013 this function in short order.
30014
30015 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
30016 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
30017
30018 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
30019 article for that group.
30020
30021 There should be no data returned.
30022
30023
30024 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
30025
30026 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
30027 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
30028
30029 There should be no data returned.
30030
30031
30032 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
30033
30034 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
30035 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
30036 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
30037
30038 There should be no data returned.
30039
30040
30041 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
30042
30043 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
30044 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
30045
30046 There should be no data returned.
30047
30048 @end table
30049
30050
30051 @node Error Messaging
30052 @subsubsection Error Messaging
30053
30054 @findex nnheader-report
30055 @findex nnheader-get-report
30056 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
30057 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
30058 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
30059 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
30060 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
30061 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
30062
30063 @lisp
30064 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
30065
30066 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
30067 @end lisp
30068
30069 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
30070 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
30071 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
30072 takes one argument---the server symbol.
30073
30074 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
30075 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
30076 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
30077
30078
30079 @node Writing New Back Ends
30080 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
30081
30082 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
30083 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
30084 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
30085 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
30086 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
30087 editing articles.
30088
30089 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
30090 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
30091 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
30092
30093 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
30094 package called @code{nnoo}.
30095
30096 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
30097 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
30098 following macros:
30099
30100 @table @code
30101
30102 @item nnoo-declare
30103 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
30104 parameters. For instance:
30105
30106 @lisp
30107 (nnoo-declare nndir
30108 nnml nnmh)
30109 @end lisp
30110
30111 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
30112 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
30113
30114 @item defvoo
30115 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
30116 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
30117 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
30118
30119 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
30120 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
30121 a function in those back ends.
30122
30123 @lisp
30124 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
30125 "Where nndir will look for groups."
30126 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
30127 @end lisp
30128
30129 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
30130 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
30131 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
30132
30133 @item nnoo-define-basics
30134 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
30135 have.
30136
30137 @lisp
30138 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
30139 @end lisp
30140
30141 @item deffoo
30142 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
30143 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
30144 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
30145
30146 @item nnoo-map-functions
30147 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
30148 functions from the parent back ends.
30149
30150 @lisp
30151 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
30152 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
30153 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
30154 @end lisp
30155
30156 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
30157 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
30158 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
30159 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
30160
30161 @item nnoo-import
30162 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
30163 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
30164 haven't already been defined.
30165
30166 @lisp
30167 (nnoo-import nndir
30168 (nnmh
30169 nnmh-request-list
30170 nnmh-request-newgroups)
30171 (nnml))
30172 @end lisp
30173
30174 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
30175 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
30176 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
30177 defined now.
30178
30179 @end table
30180
30181 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
30182
30183 @lisp
30184 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
30185 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
30186
30187 ;;; @r{Code:}
30188
30189 (require 'nnheader)
30190 (require 'nnmh)
30191 (require 'nnml)
30192 (require 'nnoo)
30193 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
30194
30195 (nnoo-declare nndir
30196 nnml nnmh)
30197
30198 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
30199 "Where nndir will look for groups."
30200 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
30201
30202 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
30203 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
30204 nnml-nov-is-evil)
30205
30206 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
30207 nil
30208 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
30209 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
30210 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
30211
30212 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
30213 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
30214
30215 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
30216
30217 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
30218
30219 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
30220 (setq nndir-directory
30221 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
30222 server))
30223 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
30224 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
30225 (push `(nndir-current-group
30226 ,(file-name-nondirectory
30227 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
30228 defs)
30229 (push `(nndir-top-directory
30230 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
30231 defs)
30232 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
30233
30234 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
30235 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
30236 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
30237 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
30238 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
30239
30240 (nnoo-import nndir
30241 (nnmh
30242 nnmh-status-message
30243 nnmh-request-list
30244 nnmh-request-newgroups))
30245
30246 (provide 'nndir)
30247 @end lisp
30248
30249
30250 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30251 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30252
30253 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
30254 @findex gnus-declare-backend
30255 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
30256 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
30257 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
30258
30259 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
30260 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
30261
30262 Here's an example:
30263
30264 @lisp
30265 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
30266 @end lisp
30267
30268 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
30269
30270 The abilities can be:
30271
30272 @table @code
30273 @item mail
30274 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
30275 @item post
30276 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
30277 @item post-mail
30278 This back end supports both mail and news.
30279 @item none
30280 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
30281 different.
30282 @item respool
30283 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
30284 articles and groups.
30285 @item address
30286 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
30287 true for almost all back ends.
30288 @item prompt-address
30289 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
30290 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
30291 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
30292 @end table
30293
30294
30295 @node Mail-like Back Ends
30296 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
30297
30298 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
30299 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
30300 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
30301 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
30302
30303 @lisp
30304 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
30305 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
30306 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
30307 @end lisp
30308
30309 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
30310 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
30311 mail.
30312
30313 This function takes four parameters.
30314
30315 @table @var
30316 @item method
30317 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
30318 the call.
30319
30320 @item exit-function
30321 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
30322
30323 @item temp-directory
30324 Where the temporary files should be stored.
30325
30326 @item group
30327 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30328 performed for one group only.
30329 @end table
30330
30331 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30332 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30333 find the article number assigned to this article.
30334
30335 The function also uses the following variables:
30336 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30337 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30338 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30339 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30340 this:
30341
30342 @example
30343 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
30344 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30345 @end example
30346
30347
30348 @node Score File Syntax
30349 @subsection Score File Syntax
30350
30351 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
30352 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30353 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30354
30355 Here's a typical score file:
30356
30357 @lisp
30358 (("summary"
30359 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
30360 ("Gnus"))
30361 ("from"
30362 ("Lars" -1000))
30363 (mark -100))
30364 @end lisp
30365
30366 BNF definition of a score file:
30367
30368 @example
30369 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30370 element = rule / atom
30371 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30372 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30373 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30374 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30375 quote = <ascii 34>
30376 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30377 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30378 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30379 date-header = "date"
30380 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30381 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30382 score = "nil" / <integer>
30383 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30384 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30385 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30386 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30387 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30388 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30389 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30390 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30391 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30392 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30393 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30394 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30395 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30396 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30397 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30398 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30399 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30400 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30401 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30402 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30403 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30404 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30405 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30406 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30407 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30408 eval = "eval" space <form>
30409 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30410 @end example
30411
30412 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30413 discarded.
30414
30415 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30416 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30417 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30418 one looong line, then that's ok.
30419
30420 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30421 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30422
30423
30424 @node Headers
30425 @subsection Headers
30426
30427 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30428 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30429 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30430 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30431
30432 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30433 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30434 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30435 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30436 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30437 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30438 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30439
30440 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30441 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30442 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30443 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30444 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30445
30446 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30447 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30448
30449
30450 @node Ranges
30451 @subsection Ranges
30452
30453 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30454 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30455
30456 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30457 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30458 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30459 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30460
30461 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30462 sequence.
30463
30464 @example
30465 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30466 @end example
30467
30468 is transformed into
30469
30470 @example
30471 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30472 @end example
30473
30474 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30475 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30476
30477 @example
30478 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30479 @end example
30480
30481 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30482 is slightly tricky:
30483
30484 @example
30485 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30486 @end example
30487
30488 and
30489
30490 @example
30491 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30492 @end example
30493
30494 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30495
30496 @example
30497 (1 2 3 4 5)
30498 @end example
30499
30500 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30501 also valid:
30502
30503 @example
30504 (1 . 5)
30505 @end example
30506
30507 and is equal to the previous range.
30508
30509 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30510 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30511 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30512 range handling.)
30513
30514 @example
30515 range = simple-range / normal-range
30516 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30517 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30518 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30519 number *[ " " contents ]
30520 @end example
30521
30522 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30523 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30524 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30525 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30526 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30527 sequences.)
30528
30529
30530 @node Group Info
30531 @subsection Group Info
30532
30533 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30534 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30535 describes the group.
30536
30537 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30538 second is a more complex one:
30539
30540 @example
30541 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30542
30543 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30544 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30545 (nnml "")
30546 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30547 @end example
30548
30549 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30550 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30551 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30552 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30553 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30554 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30555 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30556 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30557 this section is about.
30558
30559 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30560 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30561 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30562
30563 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30564
30565 @example
30566 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30567 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30568 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30569 group = quote <string> quote
30570 ralevel = rank / level
30571 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30572 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30573 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30574 read = range
30575 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30576 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30577 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30578 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30579 @end example
30580
30581 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30582 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30583 in pseudo-BNF.
30584
30585 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30586 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30587
30588 @table @code
30589 @item gnus-info-group
30590 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30591 @findex gnus-info-group
30592 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30593 Get/set the group name.
30594
30595 @item gnus-info-rank
30596 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30597 @findex gnus-info-rank
30598 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30599 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30600
30601 @item gnus-info-level
30602 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30603 @findex gnus-info-level
30604 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30605 Get/set the group level.
30606
30607 @item gnus-info-score
30608 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30609 @findex gnus-info-score
30610 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30611 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30612
30613 @item gnus-info-read
30614 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30615 @findex gnus-info-read
30616 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30617 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30618
30619 @item gnus-info-marks
30620 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30621 @findex gnus-info-marks
30622 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30623 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30624
30625 @item gnus-info-method
30626 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30627 @findex gnus-info-method
30628 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30629 Get/set the group select method.
30630
30631 @item gnus-info-params
30632 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30633 @findex gnus-info-params
30634 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30635 Get/set the group parameters.
30636 @end table
30637
30638 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30639 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30640
30641 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30642 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30643 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30644 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30645
30646
30647 @node Extended Interactive
30648 @subsection Extended Interactive
30649 @cindex interactive
30650 @findex gnus-interactive
30651
30652 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30653 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30654 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30655
30656 @lisp
30657 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30658 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30659 ...
30660 )
30661 @end lisp
30662
30663 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30664 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30665 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30666 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30667 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30668 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30669 @code{interactive}.
30670
30671 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30672 adds a few more.
30673
30674 @table @samp
30675 @item y
30676 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30677 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30678 variable.
30679
30680 @item Y
30681 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30682 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30683 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30684
30685 @item A
30686 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30687 function.
30688
30689 @item H
30690 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30691 function.
30692
30693 @item g
30694 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30695 function.
30696
30697 @end table
30698
30699
30700 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30701 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30702 @cindex XEmacs
30703 @cindex Emacsen
30704
30705 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30706 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30707 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30708
30709 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30710 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30711 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30712 Gnus, that's very useful.
30713
30714 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30715 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30716 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30717 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30718 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30719 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30720 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30721 following function:
30722
30723 @lisp
30724 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30725 (start-itimer
30726 "gnus-run-at-time"
30727 `(lambda ()
30728 (,function ,@@args))
30729 time repeat))
30730 @end lisp
30731
30732 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30733 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30734 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30735 all over.
30736
30737 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30738 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30739 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30740
30741 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30742 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30743 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30744
30745
30746 @node Various File Formats
30747 @subsection Various File Formats
30748
30749 @menu
30750 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30751 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30752 @end menu
30753
30754
30755 @node Active File Format
30756 @subsubsection Active File Format
30757
30758 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30759 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30760 in each group.
30761
30762 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30763
30764 @example
30765 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30766 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30767 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30768 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30769 no.general 1000 900 y
30770 @end example
30771
30772 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30773
30774 @example
30775 active = *group-line
30776 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30777 group = <non-white-space string>
30778 spc = " "
30779 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30780 low-number = <positive integer>
30781 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30782 @end example
30783
30784 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30785 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30786
30787
30788 @node Newsgroups File Format
30789 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30790
30791 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30792 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30793 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30794 the user.
30795
30796 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30797 Here's the definition:
30798
30799 @example
30800 newsgroups = *line
30801 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30802 group = <non-white-space string>
30803 tab = <TAB>
30804 description = <string>
30805 @end example
30806
30807
30808 @page
30809 @node Emacs for Heathens
30810 @section Emacs for Heathens
30811
30812 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30813 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30814 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30815 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30816 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30817 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30818 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30819 cat instead.
30820
30821 @menu
30822 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30823 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30824 @end menu
30825
30826
30827 @node Keystrokes
30828 @subsection Keystrokes
30829
30830 @itemize @bullet
30831 @item
30832 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30833
30834 @item
30835 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30836 @end itemize
30837
30838 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30839 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30840 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30841 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30842 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30843 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30844
30845 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30846 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30847 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30848 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30849 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30850 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30851 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30852
30853 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30854 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30855 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30856 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30857 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30858 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30859 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30860
30861 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30862 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30863 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30864 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30865 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30866 it.
30867
30868
30869
30870 @node Emacs Lisp
30871 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30872
30873 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30874 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30875 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30876 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30877
30878 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30879 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30880 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30881 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30882 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30883 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30884 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30885 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30886 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30887 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30888
30889 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30890 write the following:
30891
30892 @lisp
30893 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30894 @end lisp
30895
30896 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30897 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30898 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30899 change how Gnus works.
30900
30901 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30902 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30903 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30904 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30905 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30906
30907 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30908 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30909 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30910
30911 Some pitfalls:
30912
30913 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30914 that means:
30915
30916 @lisp
30917 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30918 @end lisp
30919
30920 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
30921 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
30922
30923 @lisp
30924 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
30925 @end lisp
30926
30927 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30928 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30929
30930 @page
30931 @include gnus-faq.texi
30932
30933 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30934 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30935 @include doclicense.texi
30936
30937 @node Index
30938 @chapter Index
30939 @printindex cp
30940
30941 @node Key Index
30942 @chapter Key Index
30943 @printindex ky
30944
30945 @summarycontents
30946 @contents
30947 @bye
30948
30949 @iftex
30950 @iflatex
30951 \end{document}
30952 @end iflatex
30953 @end iftex
30954
30955 @c Local Variables:
30956 @c mode: texinfo
30957 @c coding: iso-8859-1
30958 @c End:
30959
30960 @ignore
30961 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
30962 @end ignore